Home
Buick Rendezvous 2005 User's Manual
Contents
1. ceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeee 2 39 Overhead Console ceceeeeeeeeeceeeeeeeeeees 2 39 Floor Console Storage Area ceeeeeeeee eee 2 39 2 1 Section 2 Features and Controls Front Armrest Storage Area Rear Storage Area Roof Rack System Convenience Net Cargo Cover Rear Convenience Center HERE SERENE TE eet 2 40 Memory Seat R 2 40 SUNF O 52 arne Set i ik Si iii iil Sih i n i a a 2 40 Vehicle Personalization EE EA ITET PET EEE 2 44 Keys Leaving children in a vehicle with the ignition key is dangerous for many reasons They could operate the power windows or other controls or even make the vehicle move The children or others could be badly injured or even killed Do not leave the keys in a vehicle with children Your vehicle s key can be used for the ignition as well as the driver s door lock the floor console and the glove box If you need a new key contact your dealer who can obtain the correct key code Your vehicle has the PASS Key III vehicle theft system The key has a transponder in the key head that matches a decoder in the vehicle s steering column If a replacement key or any additional key is needed you must purchase this key from your dealer The key will have PK3 stamped on it Keep the bar code tag that came with the original keys Give this tag to your dealer if you need a new key made Any new PASS Key III key must be programmed before it will start your
2. eceeeeeeeeeeeeeees 5 68 Section 5 Tite CAINS rannen e 5 70 Accessory Inflator ccceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeee ents 5 70 If a Tire Goes Flat cee ere NEDRE 5 72 Changing a Flat Tire 0 0 0 0 cceeeeeeeeeee teeter eee 5 72 Removing the Spare Tire and Tools 5 74 Removing the Flat Tire and Installing the Spare WhO asec clacacctinnnsusnchneansihmeaslins aaa 5 80 Secondary Latch System eeeeeeeeeeee eee 5 84 Storing a Flat or Spare Tire and Tools 5 88 Compact Spare Tire c ceeeeeeeeeeeeeee erences 5 94 Appearance Care c ceeeeeeeeeeeeeeneeeeee ees 5 95 Fabric GCatpet aceiasi aaide 5 95 MIMNY I aa aa E EE 5 97 Leather 252555 so einni anaE ea Ee 5 97 Instrument Panel 2 aar ani 5 97 Interior Plastic Components ssseseerereee 5 97 Glass Surfaces asoratni sarani 5 98 Care of Safety Belts W u u u dsseeeeeererenerereee 5 98 WeatherstripS s c i tec densedeicctess e ridiani 5 98 Washing Your Vehicle 2 eres 5 98 Cleaning Exterior Lamps Lenses 0008 5 99 Finish Cane aldre AES 5 99 Service and Appearance Care Windshield Backglass and Wiper Blades 5 99 Aluminum or Chrome Plated Wheels 5 100 TeS sedeateteat nage sea nace ic E a alateaaie 5 100 Sheet Metal Damage seeeeeeeeeeeeeee ees 5 101 Finish Damage en seere 5 101 Underbody Maintenance a se 5 101 Chemical Paint Sp
3. To make the belt shorter pull its free end as shown until the belt is snug 4 Buckle position and release the lap shoulder belt the same way as the other lap shoulder belts If the belt is not long enough see Safety Belt Extender on page 1 42 Make sure the release button on the buckle is positioned so you would be able to unbuckle the safety belt quickly if you ever had to 1 40 Rear Safety Belt Comfort Guides for Children and Small Adults Rear safety belt comfort guides will provide added safety belt comfort for older children who have outgrown booster seats and for small adults When installed on a shoulder belt the comfort guide better positions the belt away from the neck and head There is a guide available for the center passenger position in the second row rear seat To provide added safety belt comfort for children who have outgrown child restraints and booster seats and for smaller adults the comfort guides may be installed on the shoulder belts Here is how to install a comfort guide and use the safety belt 2 Attach the elastic cord to the comfort guide on the center passenger shoulder belt Second Row Center Position For second row center position do the following 1 Remove the elastic cord from under the head restraint of the second row driver s side position 1 41 3 Be sure that the belt is not twisted and it lies flat The guide must be on top of the belt 4 Buckle posit
4. Example 2 Vehicle Capacity Weight for Example 2 1 000 Ibs 453 kg Subtract Occupant 750 Ibs 340 kg 250 Ibs 113 kg Weight 150 Ibs 68 kg x 5 Available Cargo 4 34 Example 3 Vehicle Capacity Weight for Example 3 1 000 Ibs 453 kg Subtract Occupant Weight 200 Ibs 1 000 Ibs 453 kg 0 Ibs 0 kg 91 kg x5 C Available Cargo Weight Refer to your vehicle s tire and loading information label for specific information about your vehicle s capacity weight and seating positions The combined weight of the driver passengers and cargo should never exceed your vehicle s capacity weight Certification Tire Label GAWR FRT GAWR RR COLD TIRE PRESSURE Ll I SEE OWNER S MANUAL FOR ADDITIONAL INFORMATION United States version shown Canada similar The Certification Tire label is found on the rear edge of the driver s door The label shows the gross weight capacity of your vehicle This is called the Gross Vehicle Weight Rating GVWR The GVWR includes the weight of the vehicle all occupants fuel and cargo The Certification Tire label also tells you the maximum weights for the front and rear axles called the Gross Axle Weight Rating GAWR To find out the actual loads on your front and rear axles you need to go to a weigh station and weigh your vehicle Your dealer can help you with this Be sure to spread out your load equally on both sides of the centerline Never
5. W W u ssseeeeererere renerne 1 4 Split Bench Seats W sssseseeeee reen rrnerennee 1 8 Stowable Seal adderes egene 1 17 Secondary Latch System W u ssseeeeeererererereee 5 84 Securing a Child Restraint Center Rear Seat Position sssseeeereee 1 62 Designed for the LATCH System iaccess 1 60 Rear Outside Seat Position c ceeeeeeeeee 1 60 Right Front Seat Position 0 00 ee 1 64 Security Message PASS Key Ill 1 3 57 SENGE E E EA 5 3 Adding Equipment to the Outside of Your VENTE in rr Angr S ER 5 5 Doing Your Own Work ccceeeeeeeeeeeeeee renee 5 4 Engine Soon ight asinsi 3 46 Publications Ordering Information 1W 1 1W 1 1 7 12 Traction System Warning Message 5 3 51 Vehicle Soon Message esceeeeeeeeeeeee tenes 3 59 Servicing Your Airbag Equipped Vehicle 1 82 Setting the Time ccceceececeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeees 3 76 Sheet Metal Damage eeceeeeeeeeeeeeeeee ees 5 101 Shifting Into Park P sfassa oboe ataun 2 27 Shifting Out of Park P 36 ry renerne 2 28 Shoulder Belt Height Adjuster W ssseneee 1 33 Signals Turn and Lane Change 1 eeeeee 3 7 Spare Tire Installing csccsiioenidet a dedewkwaicneaiestneieds 5 80 REMOVING sonarra andea eE 5 74 SLOMMO ena ea E EEE E aE 5 88 13 Specifications Capacities u sssseeerererrree 5 112 Speedometer sr
6. 7 10 Finish Care 222 buer gegen eee 5 99 Airbag SYSteM 426233 kr hakke hh a a 1 67 Finish Damage 0cccccceeeccceeeeeeeeeeeeeees 5 101 Adding Equipment to Your Airbag Equipped Glass SUMACES rdn arr parere pE oniani 5 98 Vehicle seias roa a E 1 82 Instrument Panel cccccccccccccccccuccccececceeues 5 97 How Does an Airbag Restrain 0 1 75 Interior Plastic Component c c0cccceeees 5 97 Passenger Sensing System 0seee 1564 Leathers Aatah cates ntl whe 5 97 Servicing Your Airbag Equipped Vehicle 1 82 Sheet Metal Damage c sscccssscsssseeees 5 101 What Makes an Airbag Inflate 1 75 TIKES saneret a tocar eA tren er seede 5 100 What Will You See After an Airbag Inflates 1 76 Underbody Maintenance 2 5 101 When Should an Airbag Inflate 2 1 73 Vehicle Care Appearance Materials 5 102 Where Are the Airbags 2 1 70 Vinyl ata casita aerga a saene eiin DEEE E 5 97 All Wheel Drive 5 an rer reale 5 47 Washing Your Vehicle 0ccceeeeeeeeeeeeeees 5 98 Appearance Care cont Weatherstrips ssion nresnani 5 98 Windshield Backglass and Wiper Blades 5 99 ASMrayS eana a R 3 27 Audio System S sssi iiuenosinesisi nsss Fona SENERE 3 75 Audio Steering Wheel Controls 3 133 Care of Your Cassette Tape Player 3 134 Care of Your CD and DVD Player 3 135
7. Using Song List Mode The six disc CD changer has a feature called song list This feature is capable of saving 20 track selections To save tracks into the song list feature perform the following steps 1 Turn the CD player on and load it with at least one CD See LOAD CD listed previously in this section for more information 2 Check to see that the CD changer is not in song list mode S LIST should not appear in the display If S LIST is present press the SONG LIST button to turn it off 3 Select the desired CD by pressing the numbered pushbutton and then use the SEEK SCAN right arrow to locate the track to be saved The track will begin to play 4 Press and hold the SONG LIST button to save the track into memory When SONG LIST is pressed one beep will be heard immediately After two seconds of continuously pressing the SONG LIST button two beeps will be heard to confirm that the track has been saved 5 Repeat Steps 3 and 4 for saving other selections S LIST FULL will appear on the display if you try to save more than 20 selections To play the song list press the SONG LIST button One beep will be heard and S LIST will appear on the display The recorded tracks will begin to play in the order they were saved Seek through the song list by using the SEEK SCAN arrows Seeking past the last saved track will return to the first saved track 3 113 To delete tracks from the song list perform the fol
8. 7 5 Reporting Safety Defects to General Motors 7 12 Reporting Safety Defects to the Canadian GOVEMMENE sicicsceseiolsiveesssieeasncdinapesannavers 7 12 Reporting Safety Defects to the United States Government 2 ee cee eee ee eee eeceeeeeeeeeeeeeeaees 7 11 Roadside Assistance Program secerneren 7 6 Service Publications Ordering Information 7 12 D Daytime Running Lamps c eeeeeeeeeeeeeeeee 3 14 Defensive Driving eceeeceeeneeeeeeeeee ener eens 4 3 Delayed Lighting eeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeees 3 18 Delayed Locking eceeeeeeeneeeeeeeeeeeeeeeenees 2 9 Doing Your Own Service Work 6 ceeeeeeeee ees 5 4 Door Ajar Warning Message eseeeeeeeeeee eens 3 56 Delayed LOCKING suicsccicecesectetenaeediedneseietedae bets 2 9 LOCKS cionin r nn hen ne E E Lin 2 8 Power Door Locks W ssseeeeeeeereerre rer rnrrnner 2 9 Door cont Programmable Automatic Door Locks 2 10 Rear Door Security LOCKS ceeeeeeeeee ees 2 10 Driver Four Way Manual Seat i e 1 3 Position Safety Belt ceeeeeeeeeee teeter ees 1 25 Driver Behavior ciyivencicgeest cenvietd ties cast ke borge 4 2 Driver Information Center DIC eeeeeeeeees 3 62 DIC Controls and Displays eeeeeeeee eee 3 64 DIC Vehicle Personalization eeeeeees 3 66 Driving At NIGA san nd hh eden 4 17 CI
9. If your vehicle is equipped with the Driver Information 4 Repeat Steps 1 through 3 for the other rear Center DIC see DIC Vehicle Personalization on door lock page 3 66 to program the automatic door lock feature The rear doors on your vehicle cannot be opened from i inside the vehicle when this feature is in use If you Rear Door Security Locks want to open the rear door when the security lock is on unlock the door from the inside and then open the Your vehicle is equipped with rear door security locks door from the outside that help prevent passengers from opening the rear doors on your vehicle from the inside To use one of these locks do the following 1 Open one of the rear doors Canceling the Rear Door Security Locks 1 Unlock and open the rear door from the outside 2 Push the lever down to disengage the safety lock 3 Close the door 4 Repeat Steps 1 through 3 for the other rear door lock The rear door locks will now work normally Lockout Protection The lockout protection feature may prevent you from locking your key in your vehicle Pressing the power door lock switch will lock all doors then unlock the driver s door if the key is in the ignition when a door is opened If you leave the key in your vehicle but not in the ignition or if you use the manual door lock you could still lock the key in the vehicle Always remember to take the key with you Liftgate It can be dangerous to drive
10. driver s seat Lift the lid to use the storage compartment The compartment has an accessory power outlet for charging the cell phone Overhead Console If your vehicle has an overhead console it may contain a storage compartment a sunglasses storage compartment and HomeLink Transmitter buttons See HomeLink Transmitter on page 2 34 for more information If your vehicle has the OnStar System the OnStar buttons will replace the storage compartment See OnStar System on page 2 33 for more information If your vehicle has a sunroof the mini console contains the HomeLink Transmitter buttons and the OnStar buttons Storage Compartment To open the storage compartment located at the front of the overhead console press the release latch forward Then pull the compartment down to the full open position Sunglasses Storage Compartment To open the sunglasses storage compartment in the overhead console press the release button Then pull the compartment down to the full open position Floor Console Storage Area The floor console storage area contains two cupholders an ashtray and a cellular phone storage compartment with a cigarette lighter accessory power outlet Below the floor console storage there is another storage area with two integrated convenience nets 2 39 Front Armrest Storage Area Your vehicle has a front armrest storage compartment which contains two storage compartments To unlock
11. if someone plans to drive It is a lot less than many might think Although it depends on each person and situation here is some general information on the problem The Blood Alcohol Concentration BAC of someone who is drinking depends upon four things The amount of alcohol consumed The drinker s body weight The amount of food that is consumed before and during drinking The length of time it has taken the drinker to consume the alcohol According to the American Medical Association a 180 Ib 82 kg person who drinks three 12 ounce 355 ml bottles of beer in an hour will end up with a BAC of about 0 06 percent The person would reach the same BAC by drinking three 4 ounce 120 ml glasses of wine or three mixed drinks if each had 1 1 2 ounces 45 ml of liquors like whiskey gin or vodka It is the amount of alcohol that counts For example if the same person drank three double martinis 3 ounces or 90 ml of liquor each within an hour the person s BAC would be close to 0 12 percent A person who consumes food just before or during drinking will have a somewhat lower BAC level There is a gender difference too Women generally have a lower relative percentage of body water than men Since alcohol is carried in body water this means that a woman generally will reach a higher BAC level than a man of her same body weight will when each has the same number of drinks The law in most U S states and througho
12. 3 Tune in the desired station 4 Press EQ to select the equalization 5 Press and hold one of the six numbered pushbuttons until you hear a beep Whenever that numbered pushbutton is pressed the station that was set will return and the equalization that was selected will be stored for that pushbutton 6 Repeat the steps for each pushbutton 3 90 Setting the Tone Bass Treble AUDIO Push and release AUDIO until BASS MID or TREBLE appears on the display Then turn the AUDIO knob to increase or to decrease If a station is weak or noisy decrease the treble To adjust bass midrange or treble to the middle position select BASS MID or TREBLE Then push and hold AUDIO for more than two seconds until you hear a beep BASS and a zero MID and a zero or TREBLE and a zero will appear on the display To adjust both tone controls and both speaker controls to the middle position end out of audio mode by waiting five seconds without making any changes Then push and hold AUDIO for more than two seconds until you hear a beep ALL CENTERED will appear on the display EQ Equalizer Press this button to select customized equalization settings designed for country western jazz talk pop rock and classical Adjusting the Speakers Balance Fade AUDIO To adjust the balance between the right and the left speakers push and release AUDIO until BAL appears on the display Then turn the AUDIO knob to move the sound toward
13. About Driving Your Vehicle As with other vehicles of this type failure to operate this vehicle correctly may result in loss of control or an accident See Your Driving the Road and Your Vehicle on page 4 2 How to Use This Manual Many people read the owner manual from beginning to end when they first receive their new vehicle If this is done it can help you learn about the features and controls for the vehicle Pictures and words work together in the owner manual to explain things 2004 General Motors Corporation All Rights Reserved Index A good place to quickly locate information about the vehicle is the Index in the back of the manual It is an alphabetical list of what is in the manual and the page number where it can be found Safety Warnings and Symbols There are a number of safety cautions in this book We use a box and the word CAUTION to tell about things that could hurt you if you were to ignore the warning These mean there is something that could hurt you or other people In the caution area we tell you what the hazard is Then we tell you what to do to help avoid or reduce the hazard Please read these cautions If you do not you or others could be hurt You will also find a circle with a slash through it in this book This safety symbol means Do Not Do Not do this or Do Not let this happen Vehicle Damage Warnings Also in this manual you will find these notices
14. Cruise Control With cruise control you can maintain a speed of about 25 mph 40 km h or more without keeping your foot on the accelerator This can really help on long trips Cruise control does not work at speeds below about 25 mph 40 km h When you apply your brakes the cruise control disengages The cruise controls are located on the end of the turn signal multifunction CRUISE amp lever OFF ON R A on am eee ON Move the switch to this position to turn the cruise control system on R A Move the switch to this position to resume a set speed or to accelerate SET Press this button located at the end of the lever to set a speed OFF This position turns the cruise control system off and cancels memory of a set speed Cruise control can be dangerous where you cannot drive safely at a steady speed So do not use your cruise control on winding roads or in heavy traffic Cruise control can be dangerous on slippery roads On such roads fast changes in tire traction can cause needless wheel spinning and you could lose control Do not use cruise control on slippery roads If your vehicle is in cruise control when the traction control system begins to limit wheel spin the cruise control will automatically disengage See Traction Control System TCS on page 4 10 When road conditions allow you to safely use it again you may turn the cruise control back on Setting Cruise Control If you leave y
15. Eject the disc again to take it out but it was pulled back into the slot The language in the audio Press the main menu or on the screen is wrong The remote control does not work How do get subtitles on or off button on the DVD player or the remote control and change the audio or language selection on the DVD menu Point the remote control directly at the transmitter window The batteries could be weak or put in wrong The parental control button might have been pressed The power indicator light will flash Press the subtitle button on the remote control to go to the DVDs main menu Then follow the screen prompts After stopping the player I push the play button but sometimes the DVD starts where I left off and sometimes at the beginning The DVD is playing but there is no picture or sound The auxiliary source is running but there is no picture or sound The audio or video skips or jumps Recommended Action Press the stop button on the remote control to resume where the DVD left off Press the stop button twice to start the DVD at the beginning If the power is off and the DVD is still in the player press the play button Press and release the SRCE button on the remote control or the DVD player to get to auxiliary input Check to make sure that the auxiliary source is connected to the inputs properly The DVD could be dirty or scratched Try cleaning the DVD Whe
16. ccccccceeeeceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeees 1 62 Securing a Child Restraint in the Right Front Seat Position isiat n FE 1 64 Airbag System ocscercsinirrsiineiisisiiisrsiisaea 1 67 Where Are the Airbags ceeeeeeeeeeeeeeees 1 70 When Should an Airbag Inflate 1 73 What Makes an Airbag Inflate 1 75 How Does an Airbag Restrain eee 1 75 1 1 Section 1 Seats and Restraint Systems What Will You See After an Airbag Inflates 1 76 Restraint System Check ceeeeeeeeeeees 1 83 Passenger Sensing System eeeeeeeeeeees 1 77 Checking Your Restraint Systems 0 1 83 Servicing Your Airbag Equipped Vehicle 1 82 Replacing Restraint System Parts After Adding Equipment to Your Airbag Equipped a Crash vwcttsocedisedaciworecis cinevesanmayecnesarhicinds 1 83 Vehicle seret taea EA Le el eres 1 82 Front Seats Manual Passenger Seat Pull up on the lever located on the front of the seat to unlock and move the seat Slide the seat to where you want it and release the lever To make sure the seat is locked into place try to move the seat back and forth with your body Four Way Manual Driver Seat You can lose control of the vehicle if you try to adjust a manual driver s seat while the vehicle is moving The sudden movement could startle and confuse you or make you push a pedal when you do not want to Adjust the driver s
17. later in this section for more information DVD Player The DVD player is located in the overhead console The DVD player can be controlled by the buttons on the DVD player and or by the buttons on the remote control See Remote Control later in this section for more information The RSE system DVD player is only compatible with DVDs of the appropriate region code for the country that the vehicle was sold in The DVD region code is printed on the jacket of most DVDs Standard audio CDs CD R CD RW Video CD and Photo CD CD R media are fully supported by this DVD player DVD R and DVD RW media is supported if formatted as DVD Video DVD R and DVD RW media may or may not be supported by the DVD player The DVD player does not support DVD RAM DVD ROM and DVD Audio media An error message will appear on the display if this type of media is inserted into the DVD player If an error message appears on the video screen see DVD Messages later in this section 3 119 DVD Player Buttons l Eject Press this button to eject a DVD or CD b Power Press this button to turn the DVD player on and off SRCE Source Press this button to switch the system between the DVD player and an auxiliary source L Stop Press this button to stop playing rewinding or fast forwarding Press this button twice to return to the beginning of the DVD 3 120 gt Play Pause Press
18. s manual United States only Keep track of your vehicle s service history and maintenance schedule Find GM dealers for service nationwide Receive special promotions and privileges only available to members United States only Refer to the web for updated information To register your vehicle visit www MyGMLink com United States or My GM Canada within www gmcanada com Canada Customer Assistance for Text Telephone TTY Users To assist customers who are deaf hard of hearing or speech impaired and who use Text Telephones TTYs Buick has TTY equipment available at its Customer Assistance Center Any TTY user can communicate with Buick by dialing 1 800 83 BUICK TTY users in Canada can dial 1 800 263 3830 Customer Assistance Offices Buick encourages customers to call the toll free number for assistance If a U S customer wishes to write to Buick the letter should be addressed to Buick s Customer Assistance Center United States Customer Assistance Buick Customer Assistance Center P O Box 33136 Detroit MI 48232 5136 1 800 521 7300 1 800 832 8425 For Text Telephone devices TTYs Roadside Assistance 1 800 252 1112 Fax Number 313 381 0022 From Puerto Rico 1 800 496 9992 English 1 800 496 9993 Spanish Fax Number 313 381 0022 From U S Virgin Islands 1 800 496 9994 Fax Number 313 381 0022 Canada Customer Assistance General Motors of Canada Limited Customer Comm
19. 1 69 There is an airbag Where Are the Airbags readiness light on the e instrument panel cluster r which shows the airbag symbol The system checks the airbag electrical system for malfunctions The light tells you if there is an electrical problem See Airbag Readiness Light on page 3 41 for more information The driver s frontal airbag is in the middle of the steering wheel 1 70 The right front passenger s frontal airbag is in the If your vehicle has one the driver s side impact airbag instrument panel on the passenger s side is in the side of the driver s seatback closest to the door If your vehicle has one the right front passenger s side impact airbag is in the side of the passenger s seatback closest to the door 1 72 If something is between an occupant and an airbag the airbag might not inflate properly or it might force the object into that person causing severe injury or even death The path of an inflating airbag must be kept clear Do not put anything between an occupant and an airbag and do not attach or put anything on the steering wheel hub or on or near any other airbag covering Do not let seat covers block the inflation path of a side impact airbag When Should an Airbag Inflate The driver s and right front passenger s frontal airbags are designed to inflate in moderate to severe frontal or near frontal crashes But they are designed to inflate only if the impact exceeds a pr
20. Care of Your CDs and DVDs 00 3 135 Integrated Windshield Antenna 006 3 135 Navigation Radio System cceeeeeeeeeeeees 3 130 Radio with Cassette and CD l 3 87 Radio with CD eeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeen unser 3 76 Radio with Six Disc CD 3 100 Rear Seat Audio RSA ceeeeeeeeeneee renee 3 130 Setting the Time c cceeeeeneeeeeneeeeeneees 3 76 Theft Deterrent Feature seeeeeeneee ee 3 132 Understanding Radio Reception 3 134 XM Satellite Radio Antenna System 3 135 Automatic Headlamp System 3 15 Automatic Transaxle PIG NDRE ES SE EL SE Es SERENE LER dene seecuuecetneaties 5 22 Operaatio siconr na anaa e ia E 2 23 Battery senina a E 5 41 Run Down Protection 226 vens venne res 3 20 Before Leaving on a Long Trip eee 4 23 Bench Seat Split cc ceeceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeees 1 8 Brake Anti Lock Brake System ABS a a 4 7 Emergencies scsi forr kanran a E EE geen 4 9 Low Fluid Warning Message scce 3 59 Par kind aus rer nannaa E 2 26 System Warning Light eseeeeeeeeeee eens 3 44 Brakes seminair ere a er ni 5 38 Braking an erena AE 4 6 Braking in Emergencies 1 sssssesevereeserr serene 4 9 Break In New Vehicle cccccceeeeeeee esses 2 19 Bulb Replacement eceeeeeeeneceeeeeeeeeeeees 5 49 Front Turn Signal Sidemarker and Parking Lamps ance
21. Doing Your Own Service Work If you want to do some of your own service work you will want to use the proper service manual It tells you much more about how to service your vehicle than this manual can To order the proper service manual see Service Publications Ordering Information on page 7 12 Your vehicle has an airbag system Before attempting to do your own service work see Servicing Your Airbag Equipped Vehicle on page 1 82 You should keep a record with all parts receipts and list the mileage and the date of any service work you perform See Maintenance Record on page 6 14 You can be injured and your vehicle could be damaged if you try to do service work on a vehicle without knowing enough about it Be sure you have sufficient knowledge experience the proper replacement parts and tools before you attempt any vehicle maintenance task Be sure to use the proper nuts bolts and other fasteners English and metric fasteners can be easily confused If you use the wrong fasteners parts can later break or fall off You could be hurt Adding Equipment to the Outside of Your Vehicle Things you might add to the outside of your vehicle can affect the airflow around it This may cause wind noise and affect windshield washer performance Check with your dealer before adding equipment to the outside of your vehicle Fuel Use of the recommended fuel is an important part of the proper maintenance of your vehicle
22. Gasoline Octane lf your vehicle has the 3400 V6 engine use regular unleaded gasoline with a posted octane of 87 or higher lf the octane is less than 87 you may get a heavy knocking noise when you drive If this occurs use a gasoline rated at 87 octane or higher as soon as possible Otherwise you might damage your engine A little pinging noise when you accelerate or drive uphill is considered normal This does not indicate a problem exists or that a higher octane fuel is necessary If you are using 87 octane or higher octane fuel and hear heavy knocking your engine needs service If your vehicle has the 3 6L V6 engine use regular unleaded gasoline with a posted octane of 87 or higher However for best performance and for trailer towing you may wish to use middle grade or premium unleaded gasoline If the octane is less than 87 you may get a heavy knocking noise when you drive If this occurs use a gasoline rated at 87 octane or higher as soon as possible Otherwise you might damage your engine Gasoline Specifications It is recommended that gasoline meet specifications which were developed by automobile manufacturers around the world and contained in the World Wide Fuel Charter which is available from the Alliance of Automobile Manufacturers at www autoalliance org fuel_charter htm Gasoline meeting these specifications could provide improved driveability and emission control system performance compared to other gasoline
23. If the light stops flashing and remains on steady see If the Light Is On Steady following If the light continues to flash when it is safe to do so stop the vehicle Find a safe place to park your vehicle Turn the key off wait at least 10 seconds and restart the engine If the light remains on steady see If the Light Is On Steady following If the light is still flashing follow the previous steps and see your dealer for service as soon as possible 3 47 If the Light Is On Steady You may be able to correct the emission system malfunction by considering the following Did you recently put fuel into your vehicle If so reinstall the fuel cap making sure to fully install the cap See Filling Your Tank on page 5 8 The diagnostic system can determine if the fuel cap has been left off or improperly installed A loose or missing fuel cap will allow fuel to evaporate into the atmosphere A few driving trips with the cap properly installed should turn the light off Did you just drive through a deep puddle of water If so your electrical system may be wet The condition will usually be corrected when the electrical system dries out A few driving trips should turn the light off 3 48 Have you recently changed brands of fuel If so be sure to fuel your vehicle with quality fuel See Gasoline Octane on page 5 5 Poor fuel quality will cause your engine not to run as efficiently as designed You may notice
24. Latch the hooks to secure the panel in place If the panel moves easily check that the tabs are seated correctly in the slots 7 Put the duct back on and reinstall the clamps Operating the engine with the air cleaner filter off can cause you or others to be burned The air cleaner not only cleans the air it helps to stop flame if the engine backfires If it is not there and the engine backfires you could be burned Do not drive with it off and be careful working on the engine with the air cleaner filter off 5 22 Notice If the air cleaner filter is off a backfire can cause a damaging engine fire And dirt can easily get into your engine which will damage it Always have the air cleaner filter in place when you are driving Automatic Transaxle Fluid When to Check and Change Automatic Transaxle Fluid A good time to check your automatic transaxle fluid level is when the engine oil is changed Change both the fluid and filter every 50 000 miles 83 000 km if the vehicle is mainly driven under one or more of these conditions In heavy city traffic where the outside temperature regularly reaches 90 F 32 C or higher In hilly or mountainous terrain When doing frequent trailer towing Uses such as found in taxi police or delivery service If you do not use your vehicle under any of these conditions change the fluid and filter at 100 000 miles 166 000 km See Scheduled Maintenance on page 6 4 f
25. Notice Using a tool to force the key from the ignition switch could cause damage or break the key Use the correct key and turn the key only with your hand Make sure the key is all the way in If none of this works then your vehicle needs service 2 20 B ACCESSORY This position allows you to use things like the radio and the windshield wipers while the engine is off This position will also allow you to turn off the engine Use ACCESSORY if you must have your vehicle in motion while the engine is off for example if your vehicle is being pushed or towed C ON This is the position that the switch returns to after you start your engine and release the key The switch stays in ON when the engine is running But even when the engine is not running you can use ON to operate your electrical power accessories and to display some instrument panel warning lights D START This position starts the engine When the engine starts release the key The ignition switch will return to ON for normal driving Retained Accessory Power RAP With RAP the power windows the audio system the sunroof and the automatic level control will continue to work for up to 10 minutes after the ignition key is turned to OFF or until one of the doors is opened Starting Your Engine Move your shift lever to PARK P or NEUTRAL N Your engine will not start in any other position that is a safety feature To restart when you are already
26. Satellite Radio Service Notice Do not store the headphones in heat or direct sunlight This could damage the headphones and repairs would not be covered by your warranty Keep the headphones stored in a cool dry place If there is a decreased audio signal during CD or DVD play there may be a low hissing noise through the speakers and or headphones If the hissing sound in the wireless headphones seems excessive make sure that the headphone batteries are fully charged Some amount of hissing is normal Battery Replacement To change the batteries do the following 1 Loosen the screw on the battery compartment door located on the left side of the headphone earpiece 2 Replace the two AAA batteries in the compartment Make sure that they are installed correctly using the diagram on the inside of the battery compartment 3 Tighten the screw on the battery compartment door lf the headphones are to be stored for a long period of time remove the batteries and keep them in a cool dry place Stereo RCA Jacks The RCA jacks are located behind the video screen on the DVD console The RCA jacks allow audio and video signals to be connected from an auxiliary device such as a camcorder or a video game unit to the RSE The yellow RCA jack is used for video inputs the red RCA jack for right audio inputs and the white RCA jack for left audio inputs The system requires standard RCA cables not included to connect the auxili
27. Under warning conditions the CHECK GAGES message will illuminate in the HUD Look at the instrument panel cluster for more information Notice If you try to use the HUD image as a parking aid you may misjudge the distance and damage your vehicle Do not use the HUD image as When the HUD is on the speedometer reading will a parking aid always be displayed The current audio system information will only be displayed for three seconds after the radio tape or CD track status changes This will happen whenever one of the radio controls is pressed either on the radio or on the audio steering wheel controls if equipped 3 22 To adjust the HUD so you can see it properly do the following 1 Start your engine and turn the dimmer knob to the desired HUD image brightness The brightness of the HUD image is determined by the ambient light conditions in the direction your vehicle is facing and where you have the HUD dimmer knob set If you are facing a dark object or a heavily shaded area your HUD may anticipate that you are entering a dark area and may begin to dim 2 Adjust the driver s seat If you change your seat position you may have to readjust your HUD 3 Press the UP or DN buttons until the HUD image is easy to see and then press the DN button until the HUD image is as low as possible but remains in full view straight ahead near the front bumper The HUD image can only be adjusted up and down not side to sid
28. and Passenger Airbag Status Indicator on page 3 42 for more information on this including important safety information A label on your sun visor says Never put a rear facing child seat in the front This is because the risk to the rear facing child is so great if the airbag deploys 1 64 A child in a rear facing child restraint can be seriously injured or killed if the right front passenger s airbag inflates This is because the back of the rear facing child restraint would be very close to the inflating airbag Even though the passenger sensing system is designed to turn off the passenger s frontal airbag if the system detects a rear facing child restraint no system is fail safe and no one can guarantee that an airbag will not deploy under some unusual circumstance even though it is turned off General Motors recommends that rear facing child restraints be secured in the rear seat even if the airbag is off If you need to secure a forward facing child restraint in the right front seat position move the seat as far back as it will go before securing the forward facing child restraint See Manual Passenger Seat on page 1 3 or Six Way Power Seats on page 1 4 If your child restraint is equipped with the LATCH system see Lower Anchorages and Top Tethers for Children LATCH System on page 1 58 You will be using the lap shoulder belt to secure the child restraint in this position See Top Strap on page 1 53 if you
29. and the HUD display if equipped will also be on Flash to Pass When the headlamps are off pull the lever toward you to momentarily turn on the high beams This will signal that you are going to pass When you release the lever they will turn off Windshield Wipers WIPER SY Turn the band marked WIPER to control the windshield wipers MIST For a single wiping cycle turn the band to MIST Hold it there until the wipers start then let go The wipers will stop after one cycle If you want more cycles hold the band on MIST longer Delay For delayed wiping cycles you can set the wiper speed for a long or short delay between wipes This can be very useful in light rain or snow Turn the band to choose the delay time The closer to LO the shorter the delay time LO For steady wiping cycles at low speed turn the band away from you to the LO position HI For high speed wiping turn the band away from you to the HI position OFF To stop the wipers turn the band to OFF Remember that damaged wiper blades may prevent you from seeing well enough to drive safely To avoid damage clear ice and snow from the wiper blades before using them If they are frozen to the windshield carefully loosen or thaw them If your blades do become damaged get new blades or blade inserts Heavy snow or ice can overload your wipers A circuit breaker will stop them until the motor cools Clear away snow or ice to prevent an overloa
30. or other vehicles and raindrops dimple the water s surface there could be hydroplaning Hydroplaning usually happens at higher speeds There just is not a hard and fast rule about hydroplaning The best advice is to slow down when it is raining Driving Through Deep Standing Water Notice If you drive too quickly through deep puddles or standing water water can come in through your engine s air intake and badly damage your engine Never drive through water that is slightly lower than the underbody of your vehicle If you cannot avoid deep puddles or standing water drive through them very slowly 4 20 Driving Through Flowing Water Flowing or rushing water creates strong forces If you try to drive through flowing water as you might at a low water crossing your vehicle can be carried away As little as six inches of flowing water can carry away a smaller vehicle If this happens you and other vehicle occupants could drown Do not ignore police warning signs and otherwise be very cautious about trying to drive through flowing water Some Other Rainy Weather Tips Besides slowing down allow some extra following distance And be especially careful when you pass another vehicle Allow yourself more clear room ahead and be prepared to have your view restricted by road spray Have good tires with proper tread depth See Tires on page 5 55 City Driving One of the biggest problems with city streets is t
31. plate and pulling it along the belt 2 Put the restraint on the seat 3 Run the vehicle s safety belt through or around the restraint The child restraint instructions will show you how Buckle the belt Make sure the release button is positioned so you would be able to unbuckle the safety belt quickly if you ever had to To tighten the belt pull its free end while you push down on the child restraint If you are using a forward facing child restraint you may find it helpful to use your knee to push the child restraint as you tighten the belt Push and pull the child restraint in different directions to be sure it is secure 1 63 To remove the child restraint just unbuckle the vehicle s safety belt When you remove the child restraint be sure to reconnect the lap and shoulder parts of the belt so they will be ready to work for an adult or larger child passenger Securing a Child Restraint in the Right Front Seat Position Your vehicle has a right front passenger airbag A rear seat is a safer place to secure a forward facing child restraint See Where to Put the Restraint on page 1 52 In addition your vehicle has the passenger sensing system The passenger sensing system is designed to turn off the right front passenger s frontal airbag when an infant in a rear facing infant seat or a small child in a forward facing child restraint or booster seat is detected See Passenger Sensing System on page 1 77
32. programming mode by following the instructions later in this section or program the next feature available on your vehicle Seat Recall The seat recall feature can be programmed to one of the following modes ON The previously programmed memory seat position will be recalled when the UNLOCK button is pressed on the remote keyless entry transmitter OFF No memory seat position will be recalled when you press the UNLOCK button on the remote keyless entry transmitter To determine the mode to which your vehicle is programmed or to program your vehicle to a different mode do the following 1 Follow the instructions for Entering Programming Mode listed previously 2 Press the MODE button until SEAT RECALL appears on the DIC 3 Press the SET button until the arrow is before ON or OFF 3 73 If the seat recall feature has been programmed to ON the seat recall feature can also be programmed to one of the following modes MEMORY The position recalled will be the memory driving position EXIT The position recalled will be the previously programmed exit position To determine the mode to which your vehicle is programmed or to program your vehicle to a different mode do the following 1 Follow the instructions for Entering Programming Mode listed previously 2 Follow the instructions for programming SEAT RECALL to ON listed previously 3 Press the MODE button until RECALL POSITION appears on the
33. seat only when the vehicle is not moving Use the lever located on the front left side of the seat to adjust the seat forward or rearward Pull up the lever to unlock the seat Slide the seat to where you want it and release the lever To make sure the seat is locked into place try to move Six Way Power Seats the seat back and forth with your body Your vehicle may have this feature If it does the six way power seat control is located on the outboard sides of the driver s and front passenger s seats To raise the seat pull up on the lever located on the front right side of the seat Move the front of the control up or down to adjust the front portion of the cushion up or down To lower the seat push the lever down Adjust the seat e Move the rear of the control up or down to adjust the and release the lever rear portion of the cushion up or down Lift up or push down on the whole control to move the entire seat up or down To move the whole seat forward or rearward slide the control forward or rearward Manual Lumbar The knob that controls this feature is located on the outboard sides of the driver s and front passenger s seats Turn the knob toward the front of the vehicle to increase lumbar support Turn the knob toward the rear of the vehicle to decrease lumbar support Heated Seats wo Your vehicle may have heated seats If it does the heated seat switches are located in the in
34. select one of the following 7s Vent This mode directs air to the instrument panel outlets Wi Bi Level This mode directs approximately half of the air to the instrument panel outlets then directs the remaining air to the floor outlets and the defroster and side window outlets Cooler air is directed to the upper outlets and warmer air to the floor outlets td Floor This mode directs most of the air to the floor outlets Use this mode to send air to the rear of the vehicle Keep the area under the front seats free of objects that could obstruct airflow to the rear of the vehicle The MODE button can also be used to select defog For more information see Defogging and Defrosting later in this section 3 34 Fan Press this button to increase to decrease the fan speed keep pressing the up or down arrow until the desired fan speed appears on the display VENT Press this button to turn the outside air mode on or off When this mode is on outside air will be circulated throughout your vehicle VENT can be used with all modes but it cannot be used with the recirculation mode lt amp Recirculation This mode keeps outside air from coming in the vehicle It can be used to prevent outside air and odors from entering your vehicle or help heat or cool the air inside your vehicle more quickly Press this button to turn the recirculation mode on or off When the button is pressed an indicator light will
35. 20 Climate Controls See Climate Control System on page 3 28 Dual Climate Control System on page 3 30 or Dual Automatic Climate Control System on page 3 33 Instrument Panel Switchbank See nstrument Panel Switchbank on page 3 20 Front Armrest Storage See Front Armrest Storage Area on page 2 40 Ashtray Cigarette Lighter Accessory Power Outlet Cell Phone Storage Cupholders See Ashtrays and Cigarette Lighter on page 3 27 Accessory Power Outlets on page 3 26 Cell Phone Storage Area on page 2 39 Floor Console Storage Area on page 2 39 and Cupholder s on page 2 39 Floor Console Fuse Block See Floor Console Fuse Block on page 5 105 Glove Box See Glove Box on page 2 38 Hazard Warning Flashers Your hazard warning flashers let you warn others They also let police know you have a problem Your front and rear turn signal lamps will flash on and off The hazard warning flasher button is located on top of the steering column Your hazard warning flashers work no matter what position your key is in and even if the key is not in the ignition Press the button to make the front and rear turn signal lamps flash on and off Press the button again to turn the flashers off When the hazard warning flashers are on your turn signals will not work Other Warning Devices If you carry reflective triangles you can set them up at the side of the road about 300 feet 100 m behind your vehicle 3
36. 5 Push the release clip from Step 3 down to secure the wiper blade into place Tires Your new vehicle comes with high quality tires made by a leading tire manufacturer If you ever have questions about your tire warranty and where to obtain service Poorly maintained and improperly used tires see your GM Warranty booklet for details For additional are dangerous information refer to the tire manufacturer s booklet included with your vehicle s Owner s Manual Overloading your tires can cause overheating as a result of too much friction You could have an air out and a serious accident See Loading Your Vehicle on page 4 31 Underinflated tires pose the same danger as overloaded tires The resulting accident could cause serious injury Check all tires frequently to maintain the recommended pressure Tire pressure should be checked when your tires are cold See Inflation Tire Pressure on page 5 61 Overinflated tires are more likely to be cut punctured or broken by a sudden impact such as when you hit a pothole Keep tires at the recommended pressure Worn old tires can cause accidents If your tread is badly worn or if your tires have been damaged replace them 5 55 Tire Sidewall Labelling Useful information about a tire is molded into its sidewall The examples below show a typical passenger vehicle tire and a compact spare tire sidewall y Bayo exme co X v S LS Nouv oge wo Passenger P
37. Approved for the H Specification may damage your vehicle and the damages may not be covered by your warranty Always use automatic transaxle fluid labeled DEXRON III Approved for the H Specification 3 After adding fluid recheck the fluid level as described under How to Check Automatic Transaxle Fluid earlier in this section 4 When the correct fluid level is obtained push the dipstick back in all the way Engine Coolant The cooling system in your vehicle is filled with DEX COOL engine coolant This coolant is designed to remain in your vehicle for 5 years or 150 000 miles 240 000 km whichever occurs first if you add only DEX COOL extended life coolant The following explains your cooling system and how to add coolant when it is low If you have a problem with engine overheating see Engine Overheating on page 5 28 A 50 50 mixture of clean drinkable water and DEX COOL coolant will Give freezing protection down to 34 F 37 C Give boiling protection up to 265 F 129 C Protect against rust and corrosion Help keep the proper engine temperature Let the warning messages and gages work as they should Notice Using coolant other than DEX COOL may cause premature engine heater core or radiator corrosion In addition the engine coolant may require changing sooner at 30 000 miles 50 000 km or 24 months whichever occurs first Any repairs would not be covered by your warranty
38. At times you may notice a decrease in range This is normal for any remote keyless entry system If the transmitter does not work or if you have to stand closer to your vehicle for the transmitter to work try this Check the distance You may be too far from your vehicle You may need to stand closer during rainy or snowy weather Check the location Other vehicles or objects may be blocking the signal Take a few steps to the left or right hold the transmitter higher and try again Check to determine if battery replacement is necessary See Battery Replacement under Remote Keyless Entry System Operation on page 2 6 Ifyou are still having trouble see your dealer or a qualified technician for service Remote Keyless Entry System Operation With this feature you can lock and unlock your doors from about 3 feet 1 m up to 30 feet 9 m away using the remote keyless entry transmitter supplied with your vehicle UNLOCK Press UNLOCK to unlock only the driver s door If you press UNLOCK again within five seconds the passengers doors and the liftgate will unlock See Liftgate Release under Liftgate on page 2 11 for more information The UNLOCK button on the remote keyless entry transmitter will disarm the content theft deterrent system See Content Theft Deterrent on page 2 15 for more information If you would like to program the way the headlamps and parking lamps operate with remote unlock
39. California Fuel lf your vehicle is certified to meet California Emission Standards see the underhood emission control label it is designed to operate on fuels that meet California specifications If this fuel is not available in states adopting California emissions standards your vehicle will operate satisfactorily on fuels meeting federal specifications but emission control system performance may be affected The malfunction indicator lamp may turn on and your vehicle may fail a smog check test See Malfunction Indicator Lamp on page 3 46 If this occurs return to your authorized GM dealer for diagnosis If it is determined that the condition is caused by the type of fuel used repairs may not be covered by your warranty Additives To provide cleaner air all gasolines in the United States are now required to contain additives that will help prevent engine and fuel system deposits from forming allowing your emission control system to work properly In most cases you should not have to add anything to your fuel However some gasolines contain only the minimum amount of additive required to meet U S Environmental Protection Agency regulations General Motors recommends that you buy gasolines that are advertised to help keep fuel injectors and intake valves clean If your vehicle experiences problems due to dirty injectors or valves try a different brand of gasoline Also your GM dealer has additives that will help correct and p
40. DIC 4 Press the SET button until the arrow is before MEMORY or EXIT The mode you selected is now set You can either exit programming mode by following the instructions later in this section or program the next feature available on your vehicle 3 74 Tilt Mirror The tilt mirror feature can be programmed to one of the following modes ON The passengers side outside rearview mirror will tilt down towards the curb when the vehicle is shifted to REVERSE R and returns to its previous position when the vehicle is shifted out of REVERSE R OFF The mirror will not tilt To determine the mode to which your vehicle is programmed or to program your vehicle to a different mode do the following 1 Follow the instructions for Entering Programming Mode listed previously 2 Press the MODE button until TILT MIRROR appears on the DIC 3 Press the SET button until the arrow is before ON or OFF The mode you selected is now set You can exit programming mode by following the instructions next in this section Exiting Programming Mode To exit programming mode do one of the following Shift out of PARK P Turn the ignition key out of ON Do not program any commands for one minute while in the programming mode The programming mode message will turn off to let you know that you are no longer in the programming mode Once you have reached the end of the personalization features PERSONALIZATION SELECT
41. NERE a A n EE 1 53 Top Strap Anchor Location 1 54 Towing Recreational Vehicle ceceeeeeeeeeeeereeees 4 36 Towing a Trailer 0 cceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeereeees 4 38 Nour Vehicle is2tete ea ae eee sell 4 36 Traction Active Message 3 aa sod 3 52 Control System TCS asaan 4 10 Control System Warning Light 08 3 45 Service Traction System Warning Message 3 51 Transaxle Fluid Automatic cc ec cee ee eee eee eeeeeeeeenees 5 22 Transaxle Operation Automatic 2 23 Trip OdOMetel avis reel iexieseineeenesasstenshes ceeee sed 3 39 Turn and Lane Change Signals 0 eeeeeeeee 3 7 Turn Signal Multifunction Lever eeeeee 3 7 U Ultrasonic Rear Parking Assist URPA 3 24 Understanding Radio Reception 1 3 134 Uniform Tire Quality Grading assecca 5 67 Vehicle COMMON rean a a cede 4 6 Damage WarningS 0 ccecceeeeeeceeeeeeeeenereees iv Desig tic steunite civic eecieineieetateiemeateeas 4 2 Service Soon Message ecceeeeeeeeeeeeaeees 3 59 Sy MDOlS piierne ananasa a ea A Ea iv Vehicle Data Collection and Event Data Recorders sss snsssnnnnnsssrrnnnrsrrrerrrerrrrrnerrrre 7 10 Vehicle Identification Number WIN sscccewssaceciweebelesvecsieie ives Leceueedd 5 103 Service Parts Identification Label 5 103 15 Vehicle Personalization DIC ra ne eatae ri dette 3 66 Memory Seat tscsccsves
42. Notice These mean there is something that could damage your vehicle A notice tells about something that can damage the vehicle Many times this damage would not be covered by your vehicle s warranty and it could be costly But the notice will tell what to do to help avoid the damage When you read other manuals you might see CAUTION and NOTICE warnings in different colors or in different words There are also warning labels on the vehicle They use the same words CAUTION or NOTICE Vehicle Symbols The vehicle has components and labels that use symbols instead of text Symbols are shown along with the text describing the operation or information relating to a specific component control message gage or indicator If you need help figuring out a specific name of a component gage or indicator reference the following topics Seats and Restraint Systems in Section 1 Features and Controls in Section 2 Instrument Panel Overview in Section 3 e Climate Controls in Section 3 Warning Lights Gages and Indicators in Section 3 Audio System s in Section 3 Engine Compartment Overview in Section 5 These are some examples of symbols that may be found on the vehicle CAUTION POSSIBLE INJURY PROTECT EYES BY SHIELDING CAUSTIC BATTERY ACID COULD CAUSE BURNS AVOID SPARKS OR FLAMES SPARK OR FLAME COULD EXPLODE BATTERY LATCH BOTH LAP AND SHOULDER BELTS TO PROTECT OCCUPANT DO NOT TWIST
43. Once a Month 0cceceeeeeeeeeees 6 9 Your Vehicle and the Environment 6 2 At Least Once a Year cccccceceeeeeeceeeeeeeeeees 6 9 Using Your Maintenance Schedule 6 2 Recommended Fluids and Lubricants 6 12 Scheduled Maintenance ceseeeeeeeneeeeen eens 6 4 Normal Maintenance Replacement Parts 6 13 Additional Required Services 0ceeeee ee 6 6 Maintenance Record cececeeeeeeeeeeeeeees 6 14 Maintenance Footnotes 0c ececeeeeeeeeeees 6 7 6 1 Maintenance Schedule Introduction Important Keep engine oil at the proper level and change as recommended Protection Plan Have you purchased the GM Protection Plan The Plan supplements your new vehicle warranties See your Warranty and Owner Assistance booklet or your dealer for details Maintenance Requirements Notice Maintenance intervals checks inspections replacement parts and recommended fluids and lubricants as prescribed in this manual are necessary to keep your vehicle in good working condition Any damage caused by failure to follow scheduled maintenance may not be covered by warranty 6 2 Your Vehicle and the Environment Proper vehicle maintenance not only helps to keep your vehicle in good working condition but also helps the environment All recommended maintenance is important Improper vehicle maintenance can even affe
44. Press this button while a DVD is playing to pause it Press it again to continue playing the DVD or CD gt Next Chapter Track Press this button to go to the beginning of the next chapter or track This button may not work when the DVD is playing the copyright information or the previews Setup Menu To access the setup menu ensure that a DVD is in the player and the video is stopped Press the main menu button Once the menu is activated use the directional arrows and the enter button to navigate the screen The setup menu allows the user to select default preferences for Menu Language Subtitle Language Audio Language TV Aspect TV Mode and Dynamic Range Compression Not all DVDs support all the feature defaults in the setup menus In the event a particular feature is not supported defaults will be provided by the DVD media Exit the setup menu by pressing the return button on the remote control or the DVD player If changes are made to the system setup defaults the disc will resume play from the beginning and not where it previously left off Battery Replacement To change the remote control batteries do the following 1 Unclip the battery door located on the back of the remote control 2 Replace the two AA batteries in the compartment Make sure that they are installed correctly using the diagram on the inside of the battery compartment 3 Close the battery door If the remote control is to be store
45. See Bulb high beam headlamp bulbs needs replacement See Replacement on page 5 49 for bulb replacement Bulb Replacement on page 5 49 for more information instructions Driver Information Center DIC DRIVER INFO CENTER NE AVG ECON 5 9 65 F L 100 KM United States shown Canada similar If your vehicle is equipped with the Driver Information Center DIC the display is located on the instrument panel cluster in the tachometer gage The DIC will show information about the vehicle and the surroundings The DIC is capable of displaying English or French To change the language press and hold the MODE button until the language you want is displayed The MODE button is located on the instrument panel to the left of the steering column Release the button to set your choice See DIC Controls and Displays on page 3 64 to change the display from English to metric The DIC contains a compass display to show you which direction the vehicle is driving 3 62 Compass Variance Compass variance is the difference between magnetic north and geographic north In some areas of the country the difference is great enough to cause the compass to give false readings If this occurs the compass must be recalibrated Compass Calibration If the calibration required symbol or C appears in the compass you must manually put the compass into the calibration mode To enter this mode do the following 1 Turn the ignition on and press th
46. The DRL system will make your reduced intensity high beam headlamps come on in daylight when the following conditions are met e The ignition is on e The exterior lamps control is in AUTO The shift lever is not in PARK P When the DRL are on only your reduced intensity high beam headlamps will be on Your instrument panel will not be lit up When it is dark enough outside the exterior lamps will come on automatically When it is bright enough outside the exterior lamps will go out and the DRL will turn on Of course you may still turn on the headlamps any time you need to As with any vehicle you should turn on the regular headlamp system when you need it Automatic Headlamp System When the exterior lamp control is turned to AUTO and it is dark enough outside the headlamps and parking lamps will automatically come on The lamps will also come on automatically if the following conditions are met The ignition is in ON The parking brake is released Fog Lamps The fog lamp button is located on the exterior lamp control Press the FOG PUSH button to turn the fog lamps on The FOG light located next to the fog lamp button will come on to indicate when the fog lamps are on To turn off the fog lamps press the fog lamp button or turn the ignition off If you turn on the fog lamps while the DRL are on the parking lamps will turn on automatically Your fog lamps will go off when you switch to hi
47. XMIM if equipped press the DISP button while in XMIM mode to retrieve four different categories of information related to the current song or channel Artist Song Title Category or PTY Channel Number Channel Name To change the default on the display press the DISP button until you see the display you want then hold the button until the display flashes The selected display will now be the default 3 78 Finding a Station BAND Press this button to switch between FM1 FM2 or AM or XM1 or XM2 if equipped The display will show the selection TUNE Turn this knob to select radio stations K SEEK Press the right or the left arrow to go to the next or to the previous station and stay there To scan stations press and hold either SEEK arrow for two seconds until SCAN appears on the display The radio will go to a station play for a few seconds then go on to the next station Press either SEEK arrow again to stop scanning To scan preset stations press and hold either SEEK arrow for more than four seconds until PSCAN and the preset number appear on the display You will hear a double beep The radio will go to the first preset station stored on your pushbuttons play for a few seconds then go on to the next preset station Press either SEEK arrow again to stop scanning presets The radio will only seek and scan stations with a strong signal that are in the selected band Setting Preset Stations Up to 30 st
48. a good idea to review these sections before you start your trip Check periodically to see that all hitch nuts and bolts are tight Trailer Wiring Harness Your vehicle may have a trailer wiring harness located at the rear of your vehicle To use the trailer wiring harness you need a converter kit Contact your dealer for more information 4 45 4 NOTES 4 46 Section 5 Service and Appearance Care SEVICE eniinn a a eain i 5 3 Windshield Washer Fluid eeeeeeeeeeeee es 5 37 Doing Your Own Service Work 2e 5 4 Brakes Areria bate akse Eko Reese Ends GE 5 38 Adding Equipment to the Outside of Your Battery si rande Gi aniase Ran EENEG EE 5 41 Vehicle icsichssis ass rninn nrn aa Ea 5 5 JUMP Stain inari ananin SEES SEES ana 5 42 Fuel SEE LES SEE Eee rr ener 5 5 All Wheel Drive ssssseeerererrere nerne 5 47 Gasoline Octane Gu scenerne 5 5 Bulb Replacement 0 0 c0cccccscesecseseeeeseees 5 49 Gasoline Specifications ss 5 5 Halogen BUIbS vsiussvsdersvedsncasiurse aavecionatendon 5 49 California FUG aeieea SEE e EEG FREE SE SE 5 6 Headlamps Front Turn Signal Sidemarker Additives Serre preneren SETE E ELLE LEE FEE E REEL EEEEEEEEEE ERE 5 6 and Parking Lamps scener 5 49 Fuels in Foreign Countries cceeeeeeeeeeeeeee 5 7 Front Turn Signal Sidemarker and Parking Filling Your TANK aa sonarer dba menatt ean 5 8 Lamps Sascha SEE REE RE ERRA 5 51 Filling a Portabl
49. and install or remove the compact spare Do not reset the check tire pressure system without first correcting the cause of the problem and checking and adjusting the pressure in all four tires If you reset the system when the tire pressures are incorrect the check tire pressure system will not work properly and may not alert you when a tire is low or high To reset the system do the following 1 With the engine off turn the ignition to ON 2 Press the MODE button until the DIC reads LOW TIRE PRESSURE HOLD SET TO RESET 3 Press and hold the SET button until you hear a chime and TIRE PRESSURE RESET is displayed You will hear three chimes then the LOW TIRE PRESSURE message will go off and the DIC will return to TIRE PRESSURE NORMAL If the LOW TIRE PRESSURE message comes back on the check tire pressure system has not reset Repeat the procedure The system completes the calibration process during driving The system learns the pressure at each tire throughout the operating speed range of your vehicle The system normally takes between 30 and 60 minutes of driving to learn the tire pressures The system normally takes 10 to 20 minutes of driving in each speed range to learn tire pressures The speed ranges are 20 to 40 mph 32 to 64 km h 40 to 60 mph 64 to 96 km h and above 60 mph 96 km h This time may be longer depending on your individual driving habits The learning process does not need to be completed during a sin
50. and radiator are hot can allow steam cleaner filter See Engine and scalding liquids to blow out and burn you Compartment Overview badly With the coolant recovery tank you will DEX COOL on page 5 12 for more almost never have to add coolant at the information on location radiator Never turn the radiator pressure cap even a little when the engine and radiator are hot The vehicle must be on a level surface When your engine is cold the coolant level should be at the FULL COLD mark or a little higher When your engine is warm the level should be above the FULL COLD mark or a little higher You can be burned if you spill coolant on hot Adding Coolant engine parts Coolant contains ethylene glycol and it will burn if the engine parts are hot enough Do not spill coolant on a hot engine If you need more coolant add the proper DEX COOL coolant mixture at the coolant recovery tank but be careful not to spill it Occasionally check the coolant level in the radiator For information on how to add coolant to the radiator see Cooling System on page 5 30 5 27 Radiator Pressure Cap Notice The radiator cap on your vehicle is a pressure type cap and must be tightly installed to prevent coolant loss and possible engine damage from overheating Be sure the arrows on the cap line up with the overflow tube on the radiator filler neck The radiator pressure cap for the 3400 V6 engine and the 3 6L V6 engin
51. are towing a trailer and are parking on any hill see Towing a Trailer on page 4 38 Shifting Into Park P It can be dangerous to get out of your vehicle if the shift lever is not fully in PARK P with the parking brake firmly set Your vehicle can roll If you have left the engine running the vehicle can move suddenly You or others could be injured To be sure your vehicle will not move even when you are on fairly level ground use the steps that follow If you are pulling a trailer see Towing a Trailer on page 4 38 1 Hold the brake pedal down with your right foot and set the parking brake 2 Move the shift lever into PARK P by pulling the shift lever toward you and moving it up as far as it will go 3 Turn the ignition key to OFF 4 Remove the key and take it with you If you can leave your vehicle with the ignition key in your hand your vehicle is in PARK P Leaving Your Vehicle With the Engine Running It can be dangerous to leave your vehicle with the engine running Your vehicle could move suddenly if the shift lever is not fully in PARK P with the parking brake firmly set And if you leave the vehicle with the engine running it could overheat and even catch fire You or others could be injured Do not leave your vehicle with the engine running If you have to leave your vehicle with the engine running be sure your vehicle is in PARK P and the parking brake is firmly set before you leave
52. be corrected contact your dealer XM Radio Messages Radio Display sus i XL Explicit Language XL on the radio display These channels or any others can be blocked at a Channels after the channel name customer s request by calling 1 800 852 XMXM 9696 indicates content with explicit language Updating Updating encryption The encryption code in the receiver is being updated and code no action is required This process should take no longer than 30 seconds No Signal Loss of signal The system is functioning correctly but the vehicle is in a location that is blocking the XM signal When you move into an open area the signal should return Loading XM Acquiring channel audio The audio system is acquiring and processing audio and after 4 second delay text data No action is needed This message should disappear shortly CH Off Air Channel not in service This channel is not currently in service Tune to another channel CH Unavail Channel no longer This previously assigned channel is no longer assigned available Tune to another station If this station was one of the presets choose another station for that preset button No Info Artist Name Feature not No artist information is available at this time on this channel available The system is working properly 3 83 XMIM Radio Messages cont d Radio Display oF Z No Info Song Program Title not No song title information is available at this time on this availa
53. beep will sound when the memory seat and mirror position have been stored To store the seat and outside rearview mirror positions for a second driver follow the previous steps but press button 2 instead To recall your stored positions your vehicle must be in PARK P Press and release the memory button 1 or 2 corresponding to the desired driving position The seat and the outside rearview mirrors will move to the position previously stored for the identified driver You will hear one beep 2 48 To store an exit position for each driver do the following 1 Move the seat to the desired exit position 2 Hold the button with the exit symbol located below the memory buttons for more than three seconds The exit position stored will be for the most recently selected driving position 1 or 2 A double beep will sound when the exit position is stored To use the exit feature your vehicle must be in PARK P Press and release the button with the exit symbol and the seat will move to the exit position stored for the most recently selected driver You will hear one beep To stop recall movement of the seat at any time press one of the three memory buttons or one of the power seat controls located on the outboard side of the driver s seat If your vehicle is equipped with a Driver Information Center DIC you can use it to program certain functions of the memory seats See DIC Vehicle Personalization on page 3 66 S
54. chafing etc Inspect disc brake pads for wear and rotors for surface condition Inspect other brake parts including calipers parking brake etc Check parking brake adjustment b Visually inspect front and rear suspension and steering system for damaged loose or missing parts or signs of wear Inspect power steering lines and hoses for proper hook up binding leaks cracks chafing etc c Visually inspect hoses and have them replaced if they are cracked swollen or deteriorated Inspect all pipes fittings and clamps replace with genuine GM parts as needed To help ensure proper operation a pressure test of the cooling system and pressure cap and cleaning the outside of the radiator and air conditioning condenser is recommended at least once a year d Visually inspect wiper blades for wear or cracking Replace blade inserts that appear worn or damaged or that streak or miss areas of the windshield e Make sure the safety belt reminder light and all your belts buckles latch plates retractors and anchorages are working properly Look for any other loose or damaged safety belt system parts If you see anything that might keep a safety belt system from doing its job have it repaired Have any torn or frayed safety belts replaced Also look for any opened or broken airbag coverings and have them repaired or replaced The airbag system does not need regular maintenance f Lubricate all key lock cylinders hood latch a
55. compact spare can get caught on the rails That can damage the tire and wheel and maybe other parts of your vehicle Don t use your compact spare on other vehicles 5 94 And don t mix your compact spare tire or wheel with other wheels or tires They won t fit Keep your spare tire and its wheel together Notice Tire chains will not fit your compact spare Using them can damage your vehicle and can damage the chains too Do not use tire chains on your compact spare All Wheel Drive After installing a compact spare tire on a vehicle with all wheel drive you will need to drive with light to moderate acceleration for 10 seconds in a straight line This action will allow the vehicle to detect the compact spare tire and disable the all wheel drive system The AWD DISABLE message will come on in the message center indicating that the all wheel drive system is off You may detect a slight pull during this time but this is normal Notice You may damage your vehicle s all wheel drive system if your vehicle is driven for an extended period with a compact spare tire installed and the all wheel drive system in operations See All Wheel Drive AWD System on page 4 11 for more information Appearance Care Cleaning products can be hazardous Some are toxic Other cleaning products can burst into flames if a match is struck near them or if they get on a hot part of the vehicle Some are dangerous if their fumes are inhaled in a clos
56. ctaestwcinenceacheet och aecanMectenectonecntaates 5 51 Halogen BUDS sanne nna 5 49 Headlamps Front Turn Signal Sidemarker and Parking Lamps 25 2 blee ne eks 5 49 Replacement Bulbs seeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeees 5 53 Taillamps and Back Up Lamps 8 5 52 Taillamps Turn Signal and Stoplamps 5 51 Buying New Tires nergis nadine 5 66 California Fuel 2 ammer serierne 5 6 Canadian Owners irske sesten tennises niio iske nina ji Capacities and Specifications eeeee 5 112 Captain Chairs Rear 0cceceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeees 1 13 Carbon Monoxide 0 2 11 2 29 4 26 4 38 Care of Safety Bells 222 ere ea tea 5 98 Your Cassette Tape Player W W ssseeeeree 3 134 Your CD and DVD Player aaiae 3 135 Your CDs and DVDS isesi 3 135 Cargo Cover assessor mindedes 2 43 Cargo Lamp cceceeeeeeeneeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeseeeeenes 3 19 Cell Phone Storage Area eeeeeeeeeeeeeeeee eens 2 39 Center Rear Passenger Position Safety Belts 1 38 Chains Tire cccccccecec ceca ceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeaees 5 70 Change Engine Oil Message 6 eeeeeeeeeee 3 55 Charging System Indicator Message 04 3 53 Check Engine Light 4228 sis des nevetsasndidensaiencay eis ates iene 3 46 Tire Pressure System cceeeeeeeeeeeeee eee es 5 62 Checking Things Under the Hood 0 08 5 10 Chemical Paint Spotting ceeeee
57. cycle your hand held transmitter until the frequency signal has been successfully accepted by HomeLink The indicator light will flash slowly at first and then rapidly Proceed with Step 4 under Programming HomeLink to complete Using HomeLink Press and hold the appropriate HomeLink button for at least half of a second The indicator light will come on while the signal is being transmitted 2 37 Erasing HomeLink Buttons To erase programming from the three buttons do the following 1 Press and hold down the two outside buttons until the indicator light begins to flash after 20 seconds Do not hold the two outside buttons for longer than 30 seconds 2 Release both buttons HomeLink is now in the train learning mode and can be programmed at any time beginning with Step 2 under Programming HomeLink shown earlier in this section Individual buttons cannot be erased but they can be reprogrammed See Reprogramming a Single HomeLink Button following this section Reprogramming a Single HomeLink Button To program a device to HomeLink using a HomeLink button previously trained follow these steps 1 Press and hold the desired HomeLink button Do not release the button 2 The indicator light will begin to flash after 20 seconds While still holding the HomeLink button proceed with Step 2 under Programming HomeLink shown earlier in this section 2 38 Resetting Defa
58. does not apply for XM Satellite Radio Service RDS Messages ALERT Alert warns of local or national emergencies When an alert announcement comes on the current radio station ALERT will appear on the display You will hear the announcement even if the volume is low or a CD is playing If a CD is playing play will stop during the announcement Alert announcements cannot be turned off ALERT will not be affected by tests of the emergency broadcast system This feature is not supported by all RDS stations INFO Information If the current station has a message INFO will appear on the display Press this button to see the message The message may display the artist song title call in phone numbers etc If the entire message is not displayed parts of the message will appear every three seconds To scroll through the message press and release the INFO button A new group of words will appear on the display after each press of the button Once the complete message has been displayed INFO will disappear from the display until another new message is received The last message can be displayed by pressing the INFO button You can view the last message until a new message is received or a different station is tuned to 3 81 TRAF Traffic If TRAF appears on the display the tuned station broadcasts traffic announcements Press this button to receive the traffic announcement from the station and brackets will be displayed
59. driver s seat It also makes things appear farther away than they really are Outside Heated Mirrors If the vehicle has this feature the outside rearview mirrors are heated when the rear window defogger is turned on See Rear Window Defogger under Climate Control System on page 3 28 Dual Climate Control System on page 3 30 or Dual Automatic Climate Control System on page 3 33 OnStar System OnStar uses global positioning system GPS satellite technology wireless communications and call centers to provide you with a wide range of safety security information and convenience services A complete OnStar user s guide and the terms and conditions of the OnStar Subscription Service Agreement are included in the vehicle s glove box literature For more information visit www onstar com or www onstarcanada com Contact OnStar at 1 888 4 ONSTAR 1 888 466 7827 or press the OnStar button to speak to an OnStar advisor 24 hours a day 7 days a week Terms and conditions of the Subscription Service Agreement can be found at www onstar com or www onstarcanada com OnStar Services For new vehicles equipped with OnStar the Safe and Sound Plan is included for the first year You can extend this plan beyond the first year or upgrade to the Directions and Connections Plan to meet your needs For more information press the OnStar button to speak with an advisor Safe and Sound Plan Automatic Notificatio
60. driver position Driver Position Lap Shoulder Belt The driver has a lap shoulder belt Here is how to wear it properly 1 Close and lock the door 2 Adjust the seat so you can sit up straight To see how see Seats in the Index 1 25 3 Pick up the latch plate and pull the belt across you Do not let it get twisted The shoulder belt may lock if you pull the belt across you very quickly If this happens let the belt go back slightly to unlock it Then pull the belt across you more slowly 4 Push the latch plate into the buckle until it clicks 1 26 If the belt stops before it reaches the buckle tilt the latch plate and keep pulling until you can buckle it Pull up on the latch plate to make sure it is secure If the belt is not long enough see Safety Belt Extender on page 1 42 Make sure the release button on the buckle is positioned so you would be able to unbuckle the safety belt quickly if you ever had to 5 To make the lap part tight pull down on the buckle end of the belt as you pull up on the shoulder belt NAG Ss 4 The lap part of the belt should be worn low and snug on the hips just touching the thighs In a crash this applies force to the strong pelvic bones And you would be less likely to slide under the lap belt If you slid under it the belt would apply force at your abdomen This could cause serious or even fatal injuries The shoulder belt should
61. emission control components to optimize fuel economy to monitor conditions for airbag deployment and if so equipped to provide anti lock braking and to help the driver control the vehicle in difficult driving situations Some information may be stored during regular operations to facilitate repair of detected malfunctions other information is stored only in a crash event by computer systems such as those commonly called event data recorders EDR In a crash event computer systems such as the Airbag Sensing and Diagnostic Module SDM in your vehicle may record information about the condition of the vehicle and how it was operated such as data related to engine speed brake application throttle position vehicle speed safety belt usage airbag readiness airbag performance and the severity of a collision This information has been used to improve vehicle crash performance and may be used to improve crash performance of future vehicles and driving safety Unlike the data recorders on many airplanes these on board systems do not record sounds such as conversation of vehicle occupants To read this information special equipment is needed and access to the vehicle or the device that stores the data is required GM will not access information about a crash event or share it with others other than with the consent of the vehicle owner or if the vehicle is leased with the consent of the lessee e in response to an official re
62. engine after the 5 Rinse or wipe any spilled coolant from the engine engine cools open the coolant air bleed valves and the compartment There are two bleed valves One is located on the thermostat housing The other is located on the thermostat bypass tube 6 Start the engine and let it run until you can feel the upper radiator hose getting hot Watch out for the engine cooling fans 4 Fill the radiator with the proper DEX COOL 7 By this time the coolant level inside the radiator coolant mixture up to the base of the filler filler neck may be lower If the level is lower add neck See Engine Coolant on page 5 25 for more more of the proper DEX COOL coolant mixture information about the proper coolant mixture through the filler neck until the level reaches If you see a stream of coolant coming from an air the base of the filler neck bleed valve if equipped close the valve Otherwise close the valves after the radiator is filled 5 35 8 Then replace the pressure cap At any time during this procedure if coolant begins to flow out of the filler neck reinstall the pressure cap Be sure the arrows on the pressure cap line up properly 9 Then fill the coolant recovery tank to the FULL COLD mark 10 Put the cap back on the coolant recovery tank 5 36 Power Steering Fluid See Engine Compartment Overview on page 5 12 for reservoir location When to Check Power Steering Fluid It is not necessar
63. first 500 miles 800 km that you tow a trailer do not drive over 50 mph 80 km h and do not make starts at full throttle This helps your engine and other parts of your vehicle wear in at the heavier loads You can use THIRD 3 or as you need to a lower gear when towing a trailer Operating your vehicle in THIRD 3 when towing a trailer will minimize heat buildup and extend the life of your transaxle Three important considerations have to do with weight e Weight of the trailer e Weight of the trailer tongue e Weight on your vehicle s tires 4 39 Weight of the Trailer How heavy can a trailer safely be It should never weigh more than 1 400 Ibs 630 kg with up to five occupants in the vehicle or more than 2 000 Ibs 900 kg with up to two occupants If you have the optional trailer towing package your vehicle can tow up to 2 900 Ibs 1 300 kg with up to five occupants or up to 3 500 Ibs 1 575 kg with up to two occupants But even that can be too heavy It depends on how you plan to use your rig For example speed altitude road grades outside temperature and how much your vehicle is used to pull a trailer are all important And it can also depend on any special equipment that you have on your vehicle You can ask your dealer for our trailering information or advice or you can write us at Buick Customer Assistance Center P O Box 33136 Detroit MI 48232 5136 In Canada write to General Motors of
64. for GM transmissions transaxles and transfer cases Service Bulletins Service Bulletins give technical service information needed to knowledgeably service General Motors cars and trucks Each bulletin contains instructions to assist in the diagnosis and service of your vehicle In Canada information pertaining to Product Service Bulletins can be obtained by contacting your General Motors dealer or by calling 1 800 GM DRIVE 1 800 463 7483 Owner s Information Owner publications are written specifically for owners and intended to provide basic operational information about the vehicle The owner s manual will include the Maintenance Schedule for all models In Portfolio Includes a Portfolio Owner s Manual and Warranty Booklet RETAIL SELL PRICE 35 00 Without Portfolio Owner s Manual only RETAIL SELL PRICE 25 00 Current and Past Model Order Forms Service Publications are available for current and past model GM vehicles To request an order form please specify year and model name of the vehicle ORDER TOLL FREE 1 800 551 4123 Monday Friday 8 00 AM 6 00 PM Eastern Time For Credit Card Orders Only VISA MasterCard Discover visit Helm Inc on the World Wide Web at www helminc com Or you can write to Helm Incorporated P O Box 07130 Detroit MI 48207 Prices are subject to change without notice and without incurring obligation Allow ample time for delivery Note to Canadian Customers All li
65. high speed Never turn the cap when the cooling system including the radiator pressure When the coolant in the coolant recovery tank is at or i above the full cold mark start your vehicle Cap IS hot Wait for the cooling system and radiator pressure cap to cool if you ever have to turn the pressure cap If the overheat warning continues there is one more thing you can try You can add the proper coolant mixture directly to the radiator but be sure the cooling system is cool before you do it 5 33 How to Add Coolant to the Radiator 2 Then keep turning the pressure cap but now push down as you turn it Remove the pressure cap Notice Your engine has a specific radiator fill procedure Failure to follow this procedure could cause your engine to overheat and be severely damaged You can be burned if you spill coolant on hot engine parts Coolant contains ethylene glycol and it will burn if the engine parts are hot amp enough Do not spill coolant on a hot engine A 15 PS A 1 You can remove the radiator pressure cap when the cooling system including the radiator pressure cap and upper radiator hose is no longer hot Housing Bypass Tube Turn the pressure cap slowly counterclockwise until it first stops Do not press down while turning the pressure cap If you hear a hiss wait for that to stop A hiss means there is still some pressure left 5 34 3 If your vehicle has the 3400 V6
66. in Is your vehicle ready for a long trip If you keep it serviced and maintained it is ready to go If it needs service have it done before starting out Of course you will find experienced and able service experts in GM dealerships all across North America They will be ready and willing to help if you need it Here are some things you can check before a trip e Windshield Washer Fluid s the reservoir full Are all windows clean inside and outside e Wiper Blades Are they in good shape e Fuel Engine Oil Other Fluids Have you checked all levels Lamps Are they all working Are the lenses clean e Tires They are vitally important to a safe trouble free trip Is the tread good enough for long distance driving Are the tires all inflated to the recommended pressure Weather Forecasts What is the weather outlook along your route Should you delay your trip a short time to avoid a major storm system Maps Do you have up to date maps 4 23 Highway Hypnosis Is there actually such a condition as highway hypnosis Or is it just plain falling asleep at the wheel Call it highway hypnosis lack of awareness or whatever There is something about an easy stretch of road with the same scenery along with the hum of the tires on the road the drone of the engine and the rush of the wind against the vehicle that can make you sleepy Do not let it happen to you If it does your vehicle can leave the road in l
67. is at or below freezing The recirculation mode cannot be selected while in the defog mode W Defrost This mode directs most of the air to the windshield and the side window outlets with some air directed to the floor outlets In this mode the system will automatically turn off recirculation and run the air conditioning compressor unless the outside temperature is at or below freezing Recirculation cannot be selected while in the defrost mode Do not drive the vehicle until all the windows are clear 3 32 Rear Window Defogger The rear window defogger uses a warming grid to remove fog from the rear window GW REAR Press this button to turn the rear window defogger on or off An indicator light in the button will come on to let you know that the rear window defogger is activated The rear window defogger will turn off approximately 10 minutes after the button is pressed If turned on again the defogger will only run for approximately five minutes before turning off The defogger can also be turned off by pressing the button again or by turning off the engine Notice Don t use anything sharp on the inside of the rear window If you do you could cut or damage the warming grid and the repairs wouldn t be covered by your warranty Do not attach a temporary vehicle license tape a decal or anything similar to the defogger grid Dual Automatic Climate Control Automatic Operation System AUTO Automatic When the d
68. is required for your vehicle Have your vehicle serviced as soon as possible within the next 600 miles 1 000 km It is possible that if you are driving under the best conditions the engine oil life system may not indicate that vehicle service is necessary for over a year However your engine oil and filter must be changed at least once a year and at this time the system must be reset Your GM Goodwrench dealer has GM trained service technicians who will perform this work using genuine GM parts and reset the system If the engine oil life system is ever reset accidentally you must service your vehicle within 3 000 miles 5 000 km since your last service Remember to reset the oil life system whenever the oil is changed See Engine Oil Life System on page 5 19 for information on the Engine Oil Life System and resetting the system When the CHANGE ENGINE OIL message appears certain services checks and inspections are required Required services are described in the following for Maintenance I and Maintenance II Generally it is recommended that your first service be Maintenance I your second service be Maintenance II and that you alternate Maintenance I and Maintenance II thereafter However in some cases Maintenance II may be required more often Maintenance I Use Maintenance I if the CHANGE ENGINE OIL message comes on within 10 months since the vehicle was purchased or Maintenance II was performed Mainten
69. label on the seatback The labels are located at each lower anchor position near the base of the second row outside passenger positions A Lower Anchorage B Lower Anchorage If a LATCH type child restraint is not attached to its anchorage points the restraint will not be able to protect the child correctly Ina crash the child could be seriously injured or killed Make sure that a LATCH type child restraint is properly installed using the anchorage points or use the vehicle s safety belts to secure the restraint following the instructions that came with that restraint and also the instructions in this manual 1 59 Securing a Child Restraint Designed for the LATCH System 1 Find the LATCH anchorages for the seating position you want to use where the bottom of the seatback meets the back of the seat cushion See Lower Anchorages and Top Tethers for Children LATCH System on page 1 58 2 Put the child restraint on the seat 3 Attach and tighten the LATCH attachments on the child restraint to the LATCH anchorages in the vehicle The child restraint instructions will show you how 4 If the child restraint is forward facing attach and tighten the top tether to the top tether anchorage The child restraint instructions will show you how Also see Top Strap on page 1 53 5 Push and pull the child restraint in different directions to be sure it is secure To remove the child restraint simply unhook
70. loaded with the ignition and radio off if you press this button first CD Messages CHECK CD If this message appears on the radio display and or the CD comes out it could be for one of the following reasons You are driving on a very rough road When the road becomes smoother the CD should play e The CD is dirty scratched wet or upside down The air is very humid If so wait about an hour and try again There may have been a problem while burning the CD The label may be caught in the CD player If the CD is not playing correctly for any other reason try a known good CD If any error occurs repeatedly or if an error cannot be corrected contact your GM dealer If the radio displays an error message write it down and provide it to your GM dealer when reporting the problem 3 99 Listening to a DVD Your vehicle may have a Rear Seat Entertainment System see Rear Seat Entertainment System on page 3 115 for more information If your vehicle has this system and a DVD is playing the DVD symbol will appear on the radio display indicating that the DVD is available and can be listened to through your vehicles speakers To listen to the DVD press the CD TAPE button until RSE appears on the radio display The current source will stop playing and the DVD sound will come through the speakers To stop listening to the DVD press the CD TAPE button to listen to a CD or a tape or press the BAND button to listen
71. moisture from the air SO you may sometimes notice a small amount of water dripping underneath your vehicle while idling or after turning off the engine This is normal Defogging and Defrosting Fog on the inside of windows is a result of high humidity or moisture condensing on the cool window glass This can be minimized if the climate controls system is used properly There are two modes to clear fog or frost from your windshield Use the defog mode to clear the windows of fog or moisture and warm the passengers Use the defrost mode to remove fog or frost from the windshield more quickly Turn the right knob to select the defog or defrost mode 5 Defog This mode directs air to the windshield and the floor outlets When you select this mode the system turns off recirculation and runs the air conditioning compressor unless the outside temperature is at or below freezing The recirculation mode cannot be selected while in the defog mode W Defrost Pressing this button directs most of the air to the windshield and the side window outlets with some air directed to the floor outlets In this mode the system will automatically turn off recirculation and run the air conditioning compressor unless the outside temperature is at or below freezing Recirculation cannot be selected while in the defrost mode Do not drive the vehicle until all the windows are clear 3 29 Rear Window Defogger The rear window defogger uses a wa
72. move around in a collision or sudden stop and injure people in the vehicle Be sure to properly secure any child restraint in your vehicle even when no child is in it Top Strap Some child restraints have a top strap or top tether It can help restrain the child restraint during a collision For it to work a top strap must be properly anchored to the vehicle Some top strap equipped child restraints are designed for use with or without the top strap being anchored Others require the top strap always to be anchored Be sure to read and follow the instructions for your child restraint If yours requires that the top strap be anchored do not use the restraint unless it is anchored properly If the child restraint does not have a top strap one can be obtained in kit form for many child restraints Ask the child restraint manufacturer whether or not a kit is available In Canada the law requires that forward facing child restraints have a top strap and that the strap be anchored In the United States some child restraints also have a top strap If your child restraint has a top strap it should be anchored Anchor the top strap to one of the following anchor points Be sure to use an anchor point located on the same side of the vehicle as the seating position where the child restraint will be placed If you have an adjustable head restraint route the top strap under it 1 53 If you are using a top strap equippe
73. moving use NEUTRAL N only Notice Shifting into PARK P with the vehicle moving could damage the transaxle Shift into PARK P only when your vehicle is stopped 1 With your foot off the accelerator pedal turn your ignition key to START When the engine starts let go of the key The idle speed will go down as your engine warms up Notice Holding your key in START for longer than 15 seconds at a time will cause your battery to be drained much sooner And the excessive heat can damage your starter motor Wait about 15 seconds between each try to help avoid draining your battery or damaging your starter 2 If the engine does not start in 10 seconds push the accelerator pedal about one quarter of the way down while you turn the key to START Do this until the engine starts As soon as it does let go of the key 3 If your engine still will not start or starts but then stops it could be flooded with too much gasoline Try pushing your accelerator pedal all the way to the floor and holding it there as you hold the key in START for a maximum of 15 seconds This clears the extra gasoline from the engine If the engine still will not start or starts briefly but then stops again repeat Step 1 or 2 depending on the temperature When the engine starts release the key and the accelerator pedal Notice Your engine is designed to work with the electronics in your vehicle If you add electrical parts or accessories you could c
74. on page 7 6 If you want to tow your vehicle behind another vehicle for recreational purposes such as behind a motorhome see Recreational Vehicle Towing following Recreational Vehicle Towing Recreational vehicle towing means towing your vehicle behind another vehicle such as behind a motorhome The two most common types of recreational vehicle towing are known as dinghy towing towing your vehicle with all four wheels on the ground and dolly towing towing your vehicle with two wheels on the ground and two wheels up on a device know as a dolly With the proper preparation and equipment many vehicles can be towed in these ways See Dinghy Towing and Dolly Towing following Here are some important things to consider before you do recreational vehicle towing What s the towing capacity of the towing vehicle Be sure you read the tow vehicle manufacturer s recommendations e How far will you tow Some vehicles have restrictions on how far and how long they can tow Do you have the proper towing equipment See your dealer or trailering professional for additional advice and equipment recommendations Is your vehicle ready to be towed Just as you would prepare your vehicle for a long trip you ll want to make sure your vehicle is prepared to be towed See Before Leaving on a Long Trip on page 4 23 Dinghy Towing Your vehicle was not designed to be towed with all of its wheels o
75. on the Certification Tire Label at the rear edge of the driver s door or see Loading Your Vehicle on page 4 31 Do not go over the GVW limit for your vehicle including the weight of the trailer tongue Hitches It is important to have the correct hitch equipment Crosswinds large trucks going by and rough roads are a few reasons why you will need the right hitch Here are some rules to follow e If you will be pulling a trailer that when loaded will weigh more than 2 000 Ibs 900 kg use a properly mounted weight carrying hitch and sway control of the proper size This equipment is very important for proper vehicle loading and good handling while driving Will you have to make any holes in the body of your vehicle when you install a trailer hitch If you do remember to seal the holes when you remove the hitch If you do not seal them deadly carbon monoxide CO from your exhaust can get into your vehicle See Engine Exhaust on page 2 29 Dirt and water can too 4 41 Safety Chains You should always attach chains between your vehicle and your trailer Cross the safety chains under the tongue of the trailer to help prevent the tongue from contacting the road if it becomes separated from the hitch Instructions about safety chains may be provided by the hitch manufacturer or by the trailer manufacturer Follow the manufacturer s recommendation for attaching safety chains and do not attach them to the bumper Always lea
76. on the recliner lever located on the outboard side of the seatback Base Level To recline the seatback on up level split bench seats push forward on the recliner lever located on the outboard side of the seatback Up Level Move the seatback to the desired position It is easier to raise or lower the seatback if you lean forward and take the weight off the seatback The seatbacks on each section also fold forward to put items behind the seats Lift up or push forward on the recliner lever and fold the seatback forward The seatback will lock into place when you push it back to the upright position After raising a seatback to an upright position push and pull on the seatback to check that it is locked upright Removing the Split Bench Seat Each section of the split bench seat can be flipped forward or removed individually 1 Unlatch the shoulder belt from the lap belt 2 Make sure that the seatback is in the upright position 3 Lift up or push forward on the seatback recliner lever to fold the seatback forward PERTE Eee E gt rl Base Level 5 To release the front latches squeeze the angled 4 For base level split bench seats pull the lever at latch release bar toward the straight crossbar the base of the seat on the outboard side to 6 Remove the seat by rocking it slightly toward the release the rear latches from the floor pins and flip rear of the vehicle and then pulling it out therseat
77. only at very low speeds less than 3 mph 5 km h URPA can help make parking easier and to help you avoid colliding with objects such as parked vehicles The URPA system can detect objects up to 5 feet 1 5 m behind the vehicle and tell you how close these objects are from your rear bumper Your vehicle s URPA operates when the shift lever is moved into REVERSE R and the vehicle speed is less than 3 mph 5 km h Four ultrasonic sensors located at the rear bumper are used to detect the distance to the object The URPA display is located inside the vehicle near the rear window It has three color coded lights used to provide distance and system information to the driver 3 24 Even with the Ultrasonic Rear Park Assist system the driver must check carefully before backing up The system does not operate above typical backing speeds of 3 mph 5 km h while parking And the system does not detect objects that are more than 5 feet 1 5 meters behind the vehicle So unless you check carefully behind you before and when you back up you could strike children pedestrians bicyclists or pets behind you and they could be injured or killed Whether or not you are using rear park assist always check carefully behind your vehicle before you back up and then watch closely as you do URPA can be turned off by pressing the rear park aid disable switch located in the instrument panel PARK switchbank When AID the system is disa
78. open road you will want to get to know your rig Acquaint yourself with the feel of handling and braking with the added weight of the trailer And always keep in mind that the vehicle you are driving is now a good deal longer and not nearly as responsive as your vehicle is by itself Before you start check all trailer hitch parts and attachments safety chains electrical connector lamps tires and mirror adjustment If the trailer has electric brakes start your vehicle and trailer moving and then apply the trailer brake controller by hand to be sure the brakes are working This lets you check your electrical connection at the same time During your trip check occasionally to be sure that the load is secure and that the lamps and any trailer brakes are still working Following Distance Stay at least twice as far behind the vehicle ahead as you would when driving your vehicle without a trailer This can help you avoid situations that require heavy braking and sudden turns Passing You will need more passing distance up ahead when you are towing a trailer And because you are a good deal longer you will need to go much farther beyond the passed vehicle before you can return to your lane Backing Up Hold the bottom of the steering wheel with one hand Then to move the trailer to the left just move that hand to the left To move the trailer to the right move your hand to the right Always back up slowly and if possib
79. panel cluster and the HUD display will flash in the direction of the turn or lane change To signal a lane change just raise or lower the lever until the arrow starts to flash Hold it there until you complete your lane change The lever will return by itself when you release it As you signal a turn or a lane change if the arrow flashes faster than normal a signal bulb may be burned out and other drivers will not see your turn signal If a bulb is burned out replace it to help avoid an accident If the arrows do not go on at all when you signal a turn check for burned out bulbs and check the fuse See Fuses and Circuit Breakers on page 5 105 If you have a trailer towing option with added wiring for the trailer lamps the signal indicator will flash at a normal rate even if a turn signal bulb is burned out Check the front and rear turn signal lamps regularly to make sure they are working Turn Signal On Chime If either turn signal is left on for more than 3 4 mile 1 2 km a chime will sound to let the driver know to turn it off If you need to leave the signal on for more than 3 4 mile 1 2 km turn off the signal and then turn it back on Headlamp High Low Beam Changer To change the headlamps from low to high push the turn signal lever away from you then release it To change the headlamps from high to low pull the lever toward you When the high beams are on this light on the instrument panel cluster
80. parked cars and stops right in front of you You can avoid these problems by braking if you can stop in time But sometimes you cannot there is not room That is the time for evasive action steering around the problem Your vehicle can perform very well in emergencies like these First apply your brakes See Braking on page 4 6 It is better to remove as much speed as you can from a possible collision Then steer around the problem to the left or right depending on the space available An emergency like this requires close attention and a quick decision If you are holding the steering wheel at the recommended 9 and 3 o clock positions you can turn it a full 180 degrees very quickly without removing either hand But you have to act fast steer quickly and just as quickly straighten the wheel once you have avoided the object The fact that such emergency situations are always possible is a good reason to practice defensive driving at all times and wear safety belts properly Off Road Recovery You may find that your right wheels have dropped off the edge of a road onto the shoulder while you re driving If the level of the shoulder is only slightly below the pavement recovery should be fairly easy Ease off the accelerator and then if there is nothing in the way steer so that your vehicle straddles the edge of the pavement You can turn the steering wheel up to one quarter turn until the right front tire co
81. past CAUTION Continued 1 68 Side impact airbags for the driver and right front passenger are designed to inflate only in moderate to severe crashes where something hits the side of your vehicle They are not designed to inflate in frontal in rollover or in rear crashes Everyone in your vehicle should wear a safety belt properly whether or not there is an airbag for that person Both frontal and side impact airbags inflate with great force faster than the blink of an eye If you are too close to an inflating airbag as you would be if you were leaning forward it could seriously injure you Safety belts help keep you in position for airbag inflation before and during a crash Always wear your safety belt even with frontal airbags The driver should sit as far back as possible while still maintaining control of the vehicle Front occupants should not lean on or sleep against the door Anyone who is up against or very close to any airbag when it inflates can be seriously injured or killed Airbags plus lap shoulder belts offer the best protection for adults but not for young children and infants Neither the vehicle s safety belt system nor its airbag system is designed for them Young children and infants need the protection that a child restraint system can provide Always secure children properly in your vehicle To read how see Older Children on page 1 43 or Infants and Young Children on page 1 45
82. phone numbers etc If the entire message is not displayed parts of the message will appear every three seconds To scroll through the message press and release the INFO button A new group of words will appear on the display after every press of this button Once the complete message has been displayed INFO will disappear from the display until another new message is received The last message can be displayed by pressing the INFO button You can view the last message until a new message is received or a different station is tuned to TRAF Traffic If TRAF appears on the display the tuned station broadcasts traffic announcements To receive the traffic announcement from the tuned station press this button Brackets will be displayed around TRAF and when a traffic announcement comes on the tuned radio station you will hear it lf the current tuned station does not broadcast traffic announcements press the TRAF button and the radio will seek to a station that does When a station that broadcasts traffic announcements is found the radio will stop seeking and brackets will be displayed around TRAF If no station is found NO TRAFFIC will appear on the display If the brackets are on the display and TRAF is not press the TRAF button to remove the brackets or use the TUNE knob or the SEEK arrows to go to a station that supports traffic announcements If no station is found that broadcasts traffic announcements NO TRAFFIC will ap
83. playing While the tape is playing use the VOLUME and AUDIO controls just as you do for the radio The display will show an arrow to show which side of the tape is playing Cassette tape adapter kits for portable CD players will work in the cassette tape player See CD Adapter Kits later for more information The tape bias is set automatically when a metal or chrome tape is inserted If an error appears on the display see Cassette Tape Messages later in this section 3 96 144 Reverse Press this pushbutton to quickly reverse the tape The radio will play while the tape reverses Press this pushbutton again to return to playing speed 2 D gt Forward Press this pushbutton to quickly advance the tape The radio will play while the tape advances Press this pushbutton again to return to playing speed 6 SIDE Press this pushbutton to play the other side of the tape Ki SEEK M The tape must have at least three seconds of silence between each selection for seek to work Press the left or the right arrow to go to the previous or to the next selection on the tape SEEK anda negative or positive number will appear on the display Pressing the left or right arrow multiple times will increase the number of selections to be searched up to 5 or 5 If 5 or 5 is shown on the display the cassette tape player will fast forward or rewind through the four selections and stop at the fifth selection To scan cassette
84. press and hold H and M at the same time until TIME UPDATED appears on the display If the time is not available from the station NO UPDATE will appear on the display RDS time is broadcast once a minute After tuning to an RDS broadcast station it may take a few minutes for the time to update 3 76 Radio with CD Radio Data System RDS The audio system has a Radio Data System RDS RDS features are available for use only on FM stations that broadcast RDS information With RDS your radio can do the following Seek to stations broadcasting the selected type of programming e Receive announcements concerning local and national emergencies Display messages from radio stations Seek to stations with traffic announcements This system relies upon receiving specific information from these stations and will only work when the information is available In rare cases a radio station may broadcast incorrect information that will cause the radio features to work improperly If this happens contact the radio station While the radio is tuned to an DS station the station name or call letters will appear on the display instead of the frequency RDS stations may also provide the time of day a program type PTY for current programming and the name of the program being broadcast XMIM Satellite Radio Service XMIM is a satellite radio service that is based in the 48 contiguous United States XM offers 100 coast
85. pressing lock immediately using the power door lock switch Let the delayed locking feature complete the locking of the vehicle OFF The doors will always lock immediately when you lock the doors using the power door lock switch or press LOCK on the remote keyless entry transmitter Your vehicle was originally programmed to ON The mode may have been changed since then To determine the current mode or to change the mode do the following 1 Follow the instructions for Entering Programming Mode listed previously 2 Press the MODE button until DELAYED LOCKING appears on the DIC 3 Press the SET button until the arrow is before ON or OFF The mode you selected is now set You can either exit programming mode by following the instructions later in this section or program the next feature available on your vehicle Remote Door Unlock The remote door unlock feature can be programmed to one of the following modes DRIVER ALL With the first press of UNLOCK on the remote keyless entry transmitter the driver s door will unlock and with the second press of UNLOCK within five seconds of the first press all passenger s doors will unlock ALL All doors will unlock with every press of UNLOCK on the remote keyless entry transmitter Your vehicle was originally programmed to ALL The mode may have been changed since then To determine the current mode or to change the mode do the following 1 Follow the instruc
86. purpose The terminal is located under a tethered cap at the front of the underhood fuse and relay center See Engine Compartment Overview on page 5 12 for more information on location Pull up on the cap to access the remote positive terminal You should always use the remote positive terminal instead of the positive terminal on the battery An electric fan can start up even when the engine is not running and can injure you Keep hands clothing and tools away from any underhood electric fan 5 43 Using a match near a battery can cause battery gas to explode People have been hurt doing this and some have been blinded Use a flashlight if you need more light Be sure the battery has enough water You do not need to add water to the battery installed in your new vehicle But if a battery has filler caps be sure the right amount of fluid is there If it is low add water to take care of that first If you do not explosive gas could be present Battery fluid contains acid that can burn you Do not get it on you If you accidentally get it in your eyes or on your skin flush the place with water and get medical help immediately 5 44 Fans or other moving engine parts can injure you badly Keep your hands away from moving parts once the engine is running 5 Check that the jumper cables do not have loose or missing insulation If they do you could get a shock The vehicles could be damaged to
87. safety dependability and emission control performance of your vehicle Your GM Goodwrench dealer can assist you with these checks and services Be sure any necessary repairs are completed at once Whenever any fluids or lubricants are added to your vehicle make sure they are the proper ones as shown in Recommended Fluids and Lubricants on page 6 12 At Each Fuel Fill It is important to perform these underhood checks at each fuel fill Engine Oil Level Check Check the engine oil level and add the proper oil if necessary See Engine Oil on page 5 16 for further details Notice It is important to check your oil regularly and keep it at the proper level Failure to keep your engine oil at the proper level can cause damage to your engine not covered by your warranty Engine Coolant Level Check Check the engine coolant level and add DEX COOL coolant mixture if necessary See Engine Coolant on page 5 25 for further details Windshield Washer Fluid Level Check Check the windshield washer fluid level in the windshield washer tank and add the proper fluid if necessary At Least Once a Month Tire Inflation Check Visually inspect your tires and make sure tires are inflated to the correct pressures Do not forget to check your spare tire See Tires on page 5 55 for further details Check to make sure the spare tire is stored securely Push pull and then try to turn the spare tire If it moves tighten it See Changing a
88. see your dealer right away Service Vehicle Soon Message SERVICE VEHICLE SOON United States Canada This light will come on if your vehicle has certain non emission related problems For example if the entire electrical system fails to send and receive messages from the vehicle s components this message will come on These problems may not be obvious and may affect vehicle performance or durability Consult a qualified dealership for necessary repairs to maintain top vehicle performance 3 59 Program Mode Message Remote Keyless Entry Transmitter Battery Low Warning Message PROGRAM KEY FOB MODE 1 BATTERY LOW a United States Canada United States Canada If you receive this message your vehicle is in program mode If your vehicle is equipped with the Driver Information Center DIC you are ready to begin programming your vehicle s customization features See DIC Vehicle Personalization on page 3 66 for more information If you receive this message the battery in the remote keyless entry needs to be replaced See Battery Replacement under Remote Keyless Entry System Operation on page 2 6 for instructions 3 60 Parking Lamp Warning Message Highbeam Out Warning Message PARK LAMP HIGHBEAM OUT OUT United States Canada United States Canada If you receive this message one or both of the vehicle s If you receive this message one or both of the vehicle s parking lamp bulbs needs replacement
89. small bag of sand a piece of old carpet or a couple of burlap bags to help provide traction Be sure you properly secure these items in your vehicle Driving on Snow or Ice Most of the time those places where your tires meet the road probably have good traction However if there is snow or ice between your tires and the road you can have a very slippery situation You will have a lot less traction or grip and will need to be very careful What is the worst time for this Wet ice Very cold snow or ice can be slick and hard to drive on But wet ice can be even more trouble because it may offer the least traction of all You can get wet ice when it is about freezing 32 F 0 C and freezing rain begins to fall Try to avoid driving on wet ice until salt and sand crews can get there Whatever the condition smooth ice packed blowing or loose snow drive with caution If you have traction control it will improve your ability to accelerate when driving on a slippery road But you can turn the traction system off if you ever need to You should turn the system off if your vehicle ever gets stuck in sand mud ice or snow See f You Are Stuck In Sand Mud Ice or Snow on page 4 30 Even though your vehicle has a traction system you will want to slow down and adjust your driving to the road conditions Under certain conditions you may want to turn the traction control system off such as when driving through deep s
90. speakers To listen to the DVD press the CD button until RSE appears on the radio display The current source will stop and the DVD sound will come through the speakers To stop listening to the DVD press the CD button to play a CD or press the BAND button to select a different source When the RSE system is turned off the radio will display RSE OFF and the radio will return to the last selected audio source that you were listening to Radio with Cassette and CD Radio Data System RDS The audio system has a Radio Data System RDS RDS features are available for use only on FM stations that broadcast RDS information With RDS the radio can do the following Seek to stations broadcasting the selected type of programming Receive announcements concerning local and national emergencies Display messages from radio stations Seek to stations with traffic announcements 3 87 This system relies upon receiving specific information from these stations and will only work when the information is available In rare cases a radio station may broadcast incorrect information that will cause the radio features to work improperly If this happens contact the radio station While the radio is tuned to an RDS station the station name or call letters will appear on the display instead of the frequency RDS stations may also provide the time of day a program type PTY for current programming and the name of the program be
91. squeeze the brakes hard without locking the wheels If you hear or feel the wheels sliding ease off the brake pedal This will help you retain steering control If you do have anti lock it is different See Anti Lock Brake System ABS on page 4 7 In many emergencies steering can help you more than even the very best braking Traction Control System TCS Your vehicle may have a traction control system that limits wheel spin This is especially useful in slippery road conditions The system operates only if it senses that one or both of the front wheels are spinning or beginning to lose traction When this happens the system works the front brakes and reduces engine power to limit wheel spin The TRACTION ACTIVE message will come on when the traction control system is limiting wheel spin See Traction Active Message on page 3 52 You may feel or hear the system working but this is normal If your vehicle is in cruise control when the traction control system begins to limit wheel spin the cruise control will automatically disengage When road conditions allow you to safely use it again you may reengage the cruise control See Cruise Control on page 3 10 SERVICE wa Ie United States Canada If this message comes on and stays on or comes on while you are driving there s a problem with your traction control system See Service Traction System Warning Message on page 3 51 When this warning message is on th
92. that the infant s head rests toward the center of the vehicle 1 48 A rear facing infant seat B provides restraint with the A forward facing child seat C E provides restraint for seating surface against the back of the infant The the child s body with the harness and also sometimes harness system holds the infant in place and in a crash with surfaces such as T shaped or shelf like shields acts to keep the infant positioned in the restraint 1 49 zQ A booster seat F G is a child restraint designed to improve the fit of the vehicle s safety belt system Some booster seats have a shoulder belt positioner and some high back booster seats have a five point harness A booster seat can also help a child to see out the window 1 50 How do child restraints work A child restraint system is any device designed for use in a motor vehicle to restrain seat or position children A built in child restraint system is a permanent part of the motor vehicle An add on child restraint system is a portable one which is purchased by the vehicle s owner For many years add on child restraints have used the adult belt system in the vehicle To help reduce the chance of injury the child also has to be secured within the restraint The vehicle s belt system secures the add on child restraint in the vehicle and the add on child restraint s harness system holds the child in place within the restraint One system the thre
93. the WDO LOCK switch for normal window operation Sun Visors To block out glare you can swing down the visors You can also remove them from the center mount and swing them to the side There may be an extension on the inboard side of the sun visors Pull the extension out to block out glare Visor Vanity Mirror Pull down the sun visor Flip up the cover to expose the vanity mirror Lighted Visor Vanity Mirrors Pull down the sun visor Flip up the cover to expose the vanity mirror The lamps will come on when you open the cover Theft Deterrent Systems Vehicle theft is big business especially in some cities Although your vehicle has a number of theft deterrent features we know that nothing we put on it can make it impossible to steal Content Theft Deterrent Your vehicle may have a theft deterrent alarm system A security light located on top of the instrument panel will flash slowly to let you know that the system has been armed While armed the doors will not unlock with the power door lock switch Once armed the alarm will go off if someone tries to enter the vehicle without using the optional remote keyless entry transmitter or the key or tries to turn the ignition on without using the correct key The horn will sound and the headlamps and parking lamps will flash any time the alarm sounds When the content theft deterrent system is armed the liftgate may be opened by pressing the REAR button on t
94. the automatic door unlock feature can also be programmed to one of the following modes PARK Unlock when the shift lever is put in PARK P KEY OUT Unlock when the ignition key is removed Your vehicle was originally programmed to PARK The mode may have been changed since then To determine the current mode or to change the mode do the following 1 Follow the instructions for Entering Programming Mode listed previously 2 Follow the instructions for programming AUTO DOOR UNLOCK to DRIVER or ALL listed previously 3 Press the MODE button until AUTO DOOR UNLOCK PARK KEYOUT appears on the DIC 4 Press the SET button until the arrow is before PARK or KEY OUT The mode you selected is now set You can either exit programming mode by following the instructions later in this section or program the next feature available on your vehicle 3 70 Delayed Locking The delayed locking feature can be programmed to one of the following modes ON Lock your vehicle using the power door lock switch or the remote keyless entry transmitter while any door is opened you will hear three chimes and the doors will not lock Five seconds after the last door is closed all doors will lock Once delayed locking is programmed to ON you can do the following Cancel the delayed locking by pressing unlock using the power door lock switch or by fully inserting the key in the ignition Override the delayed locking feature by
95. the cruise control switch to OFF Erasing Speed Memory When you turn off the cruise control or the ignition your cruise control set speed memory is erased 3 13 Exterior Lamps The control on the left side of the steering column operates the exterior lamps The exterior lamp control has three positions AUTO Automatic Headlamp Control Off Turning the control to this position will activate the automatic headlamps when it is dark enough outside and turn off all lamps and lights during the day except for the Daytime Running Lamps DRL PE Parking Lamps Turning the control to this position turns on the parking lamps together with the following Taillamps Instrument Panel Lights AD Headlamps Turning the control to this position turns on the headlamps together with the previously listed lamps and lights Lamps on Reminder If the driver s door is opened and you turn the ignition to OFF while leaving the lamps on you will hear a warning chime Daytime Running Lamps DRL Daytime Running Lamps DRL can make it easier for others to see the front of your vehicle during the day DRL can be helpful in many different driving conditions but they can be especially helpful in the short periods after dawn and before sunset Fully functional daytime running lamps are required on all vehicles first sold in Canada A light sensor on top of the instrument panel makes the DRL work so be sure it is not covered
96. the folding wrench counterclockwise Keep lowering the jack until the spare tire slides off the jack 9 Tilt the retainer and slip it through the wheel opening when the spare tire has been completely lowered 10 Turn the wrench clockwise to raise the cable back up if the cable is hanging Have the hoist assembly inspected as soon as you can You will not be able to store a spare tire using the hoist assembly until it has been repaired or replaced 8 Disconnect the wrench from the jack and carefully remove the jack Use one hand to push against the spare tire while firmly pulling the jack out from under the spare tire with the other hand 5 87 Storing a Flat or Spare Tire and Tools Storing the Flat Tire Vehicles without Stowable Seat and without Rear Convenience Center A D Ring D Valve Stem B Wing Nut E Full Size Tire C J Hook 5 88 Flip up the D ring located in the rear cargo area Lay the tire in the rear cargo area of the vehicle with the valve stem up with the center hole of the tire over the D ring For vehicles with aluminum wheels remove the center cap by tapping the back of the cap with the folding wrench Remove the J hook and the wing nut from the back of the jack access door Assemble the wing nut and the J hook Install the wing nut and the J hook to the D ring through the center hole of the tire Tighten the wing nut to secure the tire to the floor Push and pull on
97. the front armrest storage compartment put your key into the lock and turn the key counterclockwise To open the armrest squeeze the lever while lifting the top to open it To close the armrest push the lid down until you hear a click To lock the armrest put your key into the lock and turn the key clockwise Rear Storage Area There are four small storage compartments in the rear of your vehicle One is on the passenger s side two are on the driver s side and one is on the floor by the tailgate To remove the covers lift up on the tabs If your vehicle has the 10 speaker system the compartment on the passenger s side and the long compartment on the driver s side will be equipped with speakers 2 40 Roof Rack System If you try to carry something on top of your vehicle that is longer or wider than the luggage carrier like paneling plywood a mattress and so forth the wind can catch it as you drive along This can cause you to lose control What you are carrying could be violently torn off and this could cause you or other drivers to have a collision and of course damage your vehicle You may be able to carry something like this inside But never carry something longer or wider than the luggage carrier on top of your vehicle If you have the luggage carrier with crossrails you can load things on top of your vehicle If you do load things on the top of your vehicle you must load them on the luggage
98. the key that matches a decoder in your vehicle PASS Key III Operation Your vehicle is equipped with the PASS Key III Personalized Automotive Security System theft deterrent system PASS Key III is a passive theft deterrent system This means you don t have to do anything different to arm or disarm the system It works when you insert or remove the key from the ignition When the PASS Key IIl system senses that someone is using the wrong key it shuts down the vehicle s starter and fuel systems The starter will not work and fuel will stop being delivered to the engine Anyone using a trial and error method to start the vehicle will be discouraged because of the high number of electrical key codes If the SECURITY message is shown on the Message Center when trying to start the vehicle the key may have a damaged transponder See PASS Key Ill Security Message on page 3 57 Turn the ignition off and try to start the vehicle again 2 18 If the engine still does not start and the key appears to be undamaged try another ignition key At this time you may also want to check the fuse See Fuses and Circuit Breakers on page 5 105 If the engine still does not start with the other key your vehicle needs service If your vehicle does start the first key may be faulty See your dealer who can service the PASS Key III to have a new key made It is possible for the PASS Key III decoder to program the trans
99. the lamps on the bottom of the mirror The mirror may have a passenger airbag indicator See Passenger Sensing System on page 1 77 for more information Outside Power Mirror The power mirror controls are located on the driver s door armrest To choose either the left or right outside mirror press the selector switch Press any of the four arrows located on the control pad to move the mirrors in the desired direction Adjust each mirror so you can see the side of your vehicle and the area behind your vehicle 2 31 Outside Curb View Assist Mirror If the vehicle has this feature it can be helpful when parallel parking The passenger s outside rearview mirror will tilt towards the curb when the vehicle is shifted into REVERSE R and return to its previous position when the vehicle is shifted out of REVERSE R If further adjustment is needed the power mirror controls can be used See Outside Power Mirror on page 2 31 Also see DIC Vehicle Personalization on page 3 66 for information on how to turn this feature on and off Outside Convex Mirror A convex mirror can make things like other vehicles look farther away than they really are If you cut too sharply into the right lane you could hit a vehicle on your right Check your inside mirror or glance over your shoulder before changing lanes 2 32 The passenger s side mirror is convex A convex mirror s surface is curved so more can be seen from the
100. the shift lever and push the shift lever all the way up into PARK P as you maintain brake application Then move the shift lever into the gear you want If you ever hold the brake pedal down but still cannot shift out of PARK P try this 1 Turn the ignition key to OFF Apply and hold the brake until the end of Step 4 Shift the transaxle to NEUTRAL N Start the vehicle and then shift to the gear you want ap oN Have the system fixed as soon as you can Parking Over Things That Burn Engine Exhaust Engine exhaust can kill It contains the gas carbon monoxide CO which you cannot see or smell It can cause unconsciousness and death You might have exhaust coming in if Your exhaust system sounds strange or different Your vehicle gets rusty underneath Your vehicle was damaged in a collision Your vehicle was damaged when driving over high points on the road or over road debris Repairs were not done correctly Your vehicle or exhaust system had been modified improperly If you ever suspect exhaust is coming into your vehicle Things that can burn could touch hot exhaust Drive it only with all the windows down to parts under your vehicle and ignite Do not blow out any CO and park over papers leaves dry grass or other Have your vehicle fixed immediately things that can burn Running Your Engine While You Are Parked It is better not to park with the engine running But if you ever have to here a
101. the tire If the tire moves use the folding wrench to tighten the cable Put back all tools as they were stored in the jack storage compartment and put the compartment cover back on To put the cover back on slip the tabs on the side of the cover into the cover opening Push the cover in place and push down the tabs on the cover so that it rests in the groove This secures the cover in place 5 93 When you replace the compact spare with a full size tire reinstall the bolt on wheel covers or the center cap whichever your vehicle has Tighten them hand tight over the wheel nuts using the folding wrench Compact Spare Tire Although the compact spare tire was fully inflated when your vehicle was new it can lose air after a time Check the inflation pressure regularly It should be 60 psi 420 kPa After installing the compact spare on your vehicle you should stop as soon as possible and make sure your spare tire is correctly inflated The compact spare is made to perform well at speeds up to 65 mph 105 km h for distances up to 3 000 miles 5 000 km so you can finish your trip and have your full size tire repaired or replaced where you want Of course it s best to replace your spare with a full size tire as soon as you can Your spare will last longer and be in good shape in case you need it again Notice When the compact spare is installed do not take your vehicle through an automatic car wash with guide rails The
102. the tire to make sure the tire is secure and does not move Put back all tools as they were stored in the jack storage compartment and put the compartment cover back on Slip the tabs on the side of the compartment cover into the cover opening Push the cover in place and push down the tabs on the cover so that it rests in the groove This secures the cover in place Storing the Flat Tire Vehicles with a Rear Convenience Center A D Ring E Full Size Tire B Rear Convenience F Cap on Bottom of Center Storage C Wing Nut Compartment D J Hook 1 Open the center storage compartment door of the rear convenience center 2 Remove the cap on the bottom of the storage compartment and flip the D ring up Lay the tire on top of the center storage compartment with the valve stem down Make sure you can see the D ring through the center hole of the tire Remove the J hook and the wing nut from the back of the jack access door Assemble the wing nut and the J hook Install the wing nut and the J hook to the D ring through the center hole of the tire Tighten the wing nut to secure the tire to the floor Push and pull on the tire to make sure the tire is secure and does not move Put back all tools as they were stored in the jack storage compartment and put the compartment cover back on Slip the tabs on the side of the compartment cover into the cover opening Push the cover in place and pu
103. this as stalling after start up stalling when you put the vehicle into gear misfiring hesitation on acceleration or stumbling on acceleration These conditions may go away once the engine is warmed up This will be detected by the system and cause the light to turn on If you experience one or more of these conditions change the fuel brand you use It will require at least one full tank of the proper fuel to turn the light off If none of the above steps have made the light turn off your dealer can check the vehicle Your dealer has the proper test equipment and diagnostic tools to fix any mechanical or electrical problems that may have developed Emissions Inspection and Maintenance Programs Some state provincial and local governments have or may begin programs to inspect the emission control equipment on your vehicle Failure to pass this inspection could prevent you from getting a vehicle registration Here are some things you need to know in order to help your vehicle pass an inspection Your vehicle will not pass this inspection if the SERVICE ENGINE SOON or check engine light is on or not working properly Your vehicle will not pass this inspection if the OBD on board diagnostic system determines that critical emission control systems have not been completely diagnosed by the system The vehicle would be considered not ready for inspection This can happen if you have recently replaced your battery or if your ba
104. vehicle See PASS Key III on page 2 17 for more information on programming your new key Notice If you ever lock your keys in your vehicle you may have to damage the vehicle to get in Be sure you have spare keys If you ever do get locked out of your vehicle see Roadside Assistance Program on page 7 6 for more information If your vehicle is equipped with the OnStar system with an active subscription and you lock your keys inside the vehicle OnStar may be able to send a command to unlock your vehicle See OnStar System on page 2 33 for more information Remote Keyless Entry System lf equipped the keyless entry system operates on a radio frequency subject to Federal Communications Commission FCC Rules and with Industry Canada This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules Operation is subject to the following two conditions 1 This device may not cause interference 2 This device must accept any interference received including interference that may cause undesired operation of the device This device complies with RSS 210 of Industry Canada Operation is subject to the following two conditions 1 This device may not cause interference 2 This device must accept any interference received including interference that may cause undesired operation of the device Changes or modifications to this system by other than an authorized service facility could void authorization to use this equipment
105. water puddles or even windshield wiper blades are in good shape a heavy going through some car washes can cause problems rain can make it harder to see road signs and too The water may affect your brakes Try to avoid traffic signals pavement markings the edge of the road puddles But if you cannot try to slow down before you and even people walking hit them It is wise to keep your wiping equipment in good shape and keep your windshield washer tank filled with washer fluid Replace your windshield wiper inserts when they show signs of streaking or missing areas on the windshield or when strips of rubber start to separate from the inserts Wet brakes can cause accidents They will not work as well in a quick stop and may cause pulling to one side You could lose control of the vehicle After driving through a large puddle of water or a car wash apply your brake pedal lightly until your brakes work normally Hydroplaning Hydroplaning is dangerous So much water can build up under your tires that they can actually ride on the water This can happen if the road is wet enough and you are going fast enough When your vehicle is hydroplaning it has little or no contact with the road Hydroplaning does not happen often But it can if your tires do not have much tread or if the pressure in one or more is low It can happen if a lot of water is standing on the road If you can see reflections from trees telephone poles
106. weight vehicle capacity weight and production options weight 5 59 Normal Occupant Weight The number of occupants a vehicle is designed to seat multiplied by 150 Ibs 68 kg See Loading Your Vehicle on page 4 31 Occupant Distribution Designated seating positions Outward Facing Sidewall The side of an asymmetrical tire that has a particular side that faces outward when mounted on a vehicle The side of the tire that contains a whitewall bears white lettering or bears manufacturer brand and or model name molding that is higher or deeper than the same moldings on the other sidewall of the tire Passenger P Metric Tire A tire used on passenger cars and some light duty trucks and multipurpose vehicles Recommended Inflation Pressure Vehicle manufacturer s recommended tire inflation pressure and shown on the tire placard See Inflation Tire Pressure on page 5 61 and Loading Your Vehicle on page 4 31 Radial Ply Tire A pneumatic tire in which the ply cords that extend to the beads are laid at 90 degrees to the centerline of the tread Rim A metal support for a tire and upon which the tire beads are seated Sidewall The portion of a tire between the tread and the bead 5 60 Speed Rating An alphanumeric code assigned to a tire indicating the maximum speed at which a tire can operate Traction The friction between the tire and the road surface The amount of grip provided Tread The portion of a tir
107. wheel speed and controls braking pressure accordingly Remember Anti lock does not change the time you need to get your foot up to the brake pedal or always decrease stopping distance If you get too close to the vehicle in front of you you will not have time to apply your brakes if that vehicle suddenly slows or stops Always leave enough room up ahead to stop even though you have anti lock brakes Using Anti Lock Do not pump the brakes Just hold the brake pedal down firmly and let anti lock work for you You may feel a slight brake pedal pulsation or notice some noise but this is normal Braking in Emergencies At some time nearly every driver gets into a situation that requires hard braking If you have anti lock you can steer and brake at the same time However if you do not have anti lock your first reaction to hit the brake pedal hard and hold it down may be the wrong thing to do Your wheels can stop rolling Once they do the vehicle cannot respond to your steering Momentum will carry it in whatever direction it was headed when the wheels stopped rolling That could be off the road into the very thing you were trying to avoid or into traffic If you do not have anti lock use a squeeze braking technique This will give you maximum braking while maintaining steering control You can do this by pushing on the brake pedal with steadily increasing pressure In an emergency you will probably want to
108. will have steering control Driving at Night Night driving is more dangerous than day driving One reason is that some drivers are likely to be impaired by alcohol or drugs with night vision problems or by fatigue Here are some tips on night driving Drive defensively Do not drink and drive Adjust your inside rearview mirror to reduce the glare from headlamps behind you Since you cannot see as well you may need to slow down and keep more space between you and other vehicles e Slow down especially on higher speed roads Your headlamps can light up only so much road ahead e In remote areas watch for animals If you are tired pull off the road in a safe place and rest No one can see as well at night as in the daytime But as we get older these differences increase A 50 year old driver may require at least twice as much light to see the same thing at night as a 20 year old What you do in the daytime can also affect your night vision For example if you spend the day in bright sunshine you are wise to wear sunglasses Your eyes will have less trouble adjusting to night But if you are driving do not wear sunglasses at night They may cut down on glare from headlamps but they also make a lot of things invisible You can be temporarily blinded by approaching headlamps It can take a second or two or even several seconds for your eyes to re adjust to the dark When you are faced with severe
109. you will be operating your vehicle in an area where the temperature may fall below freezing use a fluid that has sufficient protection against freezing 5 37 Adding Washer Fluid Open the cap with the washer symbol on it Add washer fluid until the tank is full See Engine Compartment Overview on page 5 12 for reservoir location Notice When using concentrated washer fluid follow the manufacturer s instructions for adding water Do not mix water with ready to use washer fluid Water can cause the solution to freeze and damage your washer fluid tank and other parts of the washer system Also water does not clean as well as washer fluid Fill your washer fluid tank only three quarters full when it is very cold This allows for expansion if freezing occurs which could damage the tank if it is completely full Do not use engine coolant antifreeze in your windshield washer It can damage your washer system and paint 5 38 Brakes Brake Fluid Your brake master cylinder reservoir is filled with DOT 3 brake fluid See Engine Compartment Overview on page 5 12 for the location of the reservoir There are only two reasons why the brake fluid level in the reservoir might go down The first is that the brake fluid goes down to an acceptable level during normal brake lining wear When new linings are put in the fluid level goes back up The other reason is that fluid is leaking out of the brake sy
110. 0 Accessory Inflator Your vehicle may have an accessory inflator With it you can inflate things like air mattresses and basketballs and you can also use it to bring your tires up to the proper pressure The accessory inflator is located in the rear compartment on the driver s side To remove the cover pull the tab on the cover and pull it off This is the symbol on the accessory inflator switch There may be an accessory inflator kit stored in the glove box It includes a 20 foot 6 m hose with an air pressure gage and nozzle adapters Inflating something too much can make it explode and you or others could be injured Be sure to read the inflator instructions and inflate any object only to its recommended pressure To use your accessory inflator system do the following 1 Turn the ignition to ACCESSORY or ON 2 Attach the appropriate nozzle adapter if required to the end of the hose that has the pressure gage 3 Attach that end of the hose to the object you wish to inflate 4 Remove the protective cap covering the outlet 5 Attach the other end of the hose to the outlet 6 Press the accessory inflator switch The light in the switch will come on to show the system is working lf the accessory inflator system does not turn on or the light does not come on the fuse may be blown or installed incorrectly See Fuses and Circuit Breakers on page 5 105 or see your dealer for service Your accessory i
111. 18 To turn the vehicles speakers on and off press either the CD the CD TAPE or the CD AUX button on the radio The audio from the RSE system can be heard through the wireless headphones and the vehicles speakers at the same time The volume on the radio may vary when switching between a radio station CD DVD cassette or auxiliary device If there is a decreased audio signal during CD or DVD play there may be a low hissing noise through the speakers and or headphones If the hissing sound in the wireless headphones seems excessive make sure that the headphone batteries are fully charged Some amount of hissing is normal Video Screen The video screen is located in the overhead console To use the video screen do the following 1 Push forward on the release button and the screen will fold down 2 Push the screen away from you and adjust its position as desired When the video screen is not in use push it up into its stowed and latched position The DVD player and display will continue to operate when the video screen is in either the up or down positions The video screen contains the transmitters for the wireless headphones and the receiver for the remote control If the screen is in the closed position the signals will not be available for the operation of the headphones or the remote control Notice Directly touching the video screen may damage it Do not touch the screen See Cleaning the Video Screen
112. 2005 Buick Rendezvous Owner Manual M Message Center W W ssssssseseseerererrkrkrrnee 3 51 Seats and Restraint Systems 2 1 1 Driver Information Center DIC ow 3 62 FrOnt S ats our nen ser nonnai 1 3 Audio System S e ceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeees 3 75 Rear Seats oo eeceecesccecseccecceeeeceeecseeeeeseeeeees 1 8 Driving Your Vehicle secs 4 1 Safety Belts ccccceccecseceeceeeeeeceeeeeeeeeerees 1 20 Your Driving the Road and Your Vehicle _ 4 2 Child Restraints seisde 1 43 TOWING sperpanissienin ninae irei 4 36 Airbag System E I IE T SEE A A T AN 1 67 Service and Appearance GAO EESE 5 1 Restraint System Check sereen 1 83 Service oases ceeceeeeessecnseeeeeseeesseneseeseeeesterees 5 3 Features and Controls 2222 2 1 FUG A S E et 5 5 Keys rr E A A EN 2 3 Checking Things Under the Hood _ 5 10 Doors and LOCKS soen 2 8 All Wheel Drive 2 G W ssssssseneseeeeeeeen ennen ennen 5 47 Windows iii nar Fate ER EO ERES 2 13 Bulb Replacement ooo eee eee 5 49 Theft Deterrent Systems oo seeeeeeeeeereees 2 15 Windshield Wiper Blade Replacement _ 5 53 Starting and Operating Your Vehicle 2 19 Ties e aa E E Te 5 55 MINOS aoned aa n a a 2 31 Appearance Care uasssesscccrerirerrerrrerrren 5 95 OnStar System n se 2 33 Vehicle Identification 2 5 103 HomeLink Transmitter oo eee 2 34 Electrical System ssassn 5 104 Storage Areas aeeesescuencsigecd
113. 31 Overhead Console keirin 2 39 Overheated Engine Protection Operating Mode 5 30 Owner Checks and Services ccccceeeeeeeeees 6 8 Owners Canadian ccccccceseeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeaeenes ii Pak Ald ins naig a ale 3 24 Park Lamp Warning Message ccce 3 61 Park P Shifting JATO sasse naiaiaee a aAa 2 27 Shifting QUOT srssouinpi ianea te aaiae 2 28 Parking ASSIST arras e e E sae ENE 3 24 Brake cocecicdtevicteccis nts Rear ien E 2 26 Over Things That Burn assecc 2 29 Passenger Airbag Status Indicator 3 42 Passenger Sensing System cceeeeeeeeeeeees 1 77 PASSING aseen ea E 4 14 PASS Key E fle kr stede are 2 17 PASS Key II Operation ccccccceeeessseeeeeeees 2 18 PASS Key III Security Message 3 57 Perimeter Lighting eceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeee 3 19 Power Accessory Outlets arier 3 26 Doot LOCKS wie as mare altos Game i 2 9 Electrical System ceceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeenes 5 104 Reduced Engine Message sinnene 3 53 Retained Accessory RAP accses 2 21 Six Way Seats cccceeeeeeeeeeceeeeeee tenes tenors 1 4 Steering Fluid 2 2 sa perroner eee eeee 5 36 WIMGOWS 5 ecstscanssebactentencmaheintereatiecadiescuecbncde 2 14 Pretensioners Safety Belt ccceeeeeeeeeeneee ees 1 42 Program Mode Message sd piskes ren anke 3 60 Programmable Automatic Door Locks 2 10 Programming the HomeLink Trans
114. 6 Horn Press near or on the horn symbols on your steering wheel pad to sound the horn Tilt Wheel A tilt wheel allows you to adjust the steering wheel before you drive You can raise the steering wheel to the highest level to give your legs more room when you enter and exit the vehicle The lever that allows you to tilt the steering wheel is located on the left side of the steering column To tilt the wheel hold the wheel and pull the lever Then move the wheel to a comfortable position and release the lever to lock the wheel in place Turn Signal Multifunction Lever CRUISE OFF ON AA nS WIPER The lever on the left side of the steering column includes the following e Turn and Lane Change Signals See Turn and Lane Change Signals on page 3 7 e D Headlamp High Low Beam Changer See Headlamp High Low Beam Changer on page 3 8 e Flash to Pass See Flash to Pass on page 3 8 WIPER W Windshield Wipers See Windshield Wipers on page 3 9 e amp PUSH Windshield Washer See Windshield Washer on page 3 9 e CRUISE 8 Cruise Control See Cruise Control on page 3 10 Turn and Lane Change Signals The turn signal has two upward for right and two downward for left positions These positions allow you to signal a turn or a lane change To signal a turn move the lever all the way up or down When the turn is finished the lever will return automatically An arrow on the instrument
115. AF If no station is found that broadcasts traffic announcements NO TRAFFIC will appear on the display lf the brackets are on the display and TRAF is not press the TRAF button to remove the brackets or use the TUNE knob or the SEEK arrows to go to a station that supports traffic announcements If no station is found NO TRAFFIC will appear on the display The radio will play the traffic announcements even if the volume is low The radio will interrupt the play of a cassette tape or CD if the last tuned station broadcasts traffic announcements This function does not apply to XM Satellite Radio Service Radio Messages CAL Calibrate The audio system has been calibrated for your vehicle from the factory If CAL appears on the display it means that the radio has not been configured properly for the vehicle and must be returned to your GM dealer for service LOCKED This message is displayed when the THEFTLOCK system has locked up Return your vehicle to your GM dealer for service If any error occurs repeatedly or if an error cannot be corrected contact your GM dealer 3 93 XM Radio Messages Radio Display vig P XL Explicit Language XL on the radio display These channels or any others can be blocked at a Channels after the channel name customer s request by calling 1 800 852 XMXM 9696 indicates content with explicit language Updating Updating encryption The encryption code in the receiver
116. Aluminum or Chrome Plated Wheels The vehicle may be equipped with either aluminum or chrome plated wheels Keep the wheels clean using a soft clean cloth with mild soap and water Rinse with clean water After rinsing thoroughly dry with a soft clean towel A wax may then be applied Notice If you use strong soaps chemicals abrasive polishes cleaners brushes or cleaners that contain acid on aluminum or chrome plated wheels you could damage the surface of the wheel s The repairs would not be covered by your warranty Use only GM approved cleaners on aluminum or chrome plated wheels The surface of these wheels is similar to the painted surface of your vehicle Do not use strong soaps chemicals abrasive polishes abrasive cleaners cleaners with acid or abrasive cleaning brushes on them because you could damage the surface Do not use chrome polish on aluminum wheels Notice Using chrome polish on aluminum wheels could damage the wheels The repairs would not be covered by your warranty Use chrome polish on chrome wheels only 5 100 Use chrome polish only on chrome plated wheels but avoid any painted surface of the wheel and buff off immediately after application Notice If you drive your vehicle through an automatic car wash that has silicone carbide tire cleaning brushes you could damage the aluminum or chrome plated wheels The repairs would not be covered by your warranty Never drive a vehicle equipped w
117. Always use DEX COOL silicate free coolant in your vehicle 5 25 What Coolant to Use Use a mixture of one half clean drinkable water and one half DEX COOL coolant which will not damage aluminum parts If you use this coolant mixture you do not need to add anything else Adding only plain water to your cooling system can be dangerous Plain water or some other liquid such as alcohol can boil before the proper coolant mixture will Your vehicle s coolant warning system is set for the proper coolant mixture With plain water or the wrong mixture your engine could get too hot but you would not get the overheat warning Your engine could catch fire and you or others could be burned Use a 50 50 mixture of clean drinkable water and DEX COOL coolant 5 26 Notice If you use an improper coolant mixture your engine could overheat and be badly damaged The repair cost would not be covered by your warranty Too much water in the mixture can freeze and crack the engine radiator heater core and other parts If you have to add coolant more than four times a year have your dealer check your cooling system Notice If you use the proper coolant you do not have to add extra inhibitors or additives which claim to improve the system These can be harmful Checking Coolant The coolant recovery tank is located on the driver s side of the vehicle Turning the radiator pressure cap when the above the engine air engine
118. Block on page 5 107 Remote Positive Terminal See Jump Starting on page 5 42 Power Steering Fluid Reservoir See Power Steering Fluid on page 5 36 Automatic Transaxle Fluid Dipstick See Checking the Fluid Level under Automatic Transaxle Fluid on page 5 22 Brake Master Cylinder See Brake Fluid under Brakes on page 5 38 Windshield Washer Fluid Reservoir See Adding Washer Fluid under Windshield Washer Fluid on page 5 37 D Battery See Battery on page 5 41 Radiator Pressure Cap See Radiator Pressure Cap on page 5 28 Engine Oil Fill Cap See When to Add Engine Oil under Engine Oil on page 5 16 Engine Oil Dipstick See Checking Engine Oil under Engine Oil on page 5 16 Engine Air Cleaner Filter See Engine Air Cleaner Filter on page 5 21 Coolant Recovery Tank See Engine Coolant on page 5 25 When you lift the hood of the 3 6L V6 engine here is what you will see A ee So D gt CR N amp d S E Be ae N HED N z5 eS Qe Wi FB UV se MASSE 1 JU HANS 2 e A ERE SID rg AN ARE Eby A is DE DEDE i Oe i i a 0 E lt P ta tr ta Q gi A i R yJ a ONS Pei fit BED Sa AVN AS A Tv wy 5 5 14 Windshield Washer Fluid Reservoir See Adding Washer Fluid under Windshield Washer Fluid on page 5 37 Underhood Fuse Block See Underhood Fuse Block on page 5 107 Battery See Battery
119. Canada Limited Customer Communication Centre 163 005 1908 Colonel Sam Drive Oshawa Ontario L1H 8P7 4 40 Weight of the Trailer Tongue The tongue load A of any trailer is an important weight to measure because it affects the total or gross weight of your vehicle The Gross Vehicle Weight GVW includes the curb weight of the vehicle any cargo you may carry in it and the people who will be riding in the vehicle If you have a lot of options equipment passengers or cargo in the vehicle it will reduce the tongue weight your vehicle can carry which will also reduce the trailer weight your vehicle can tow And if you will tow a trailer you must add the tongue load to the GVW because your vehicle will be carrying that weight too See Loading Your Vehicle on page 4 31 for more information about your vehicle s maximum load capacity lf you are using a weight carrying or weight distributing hitch the trailer tongue weight A should be 10 percent to 15 percent of the total loaded trailer weight B Do not exceed the maximum allowable tongue weight for your vehicle After you have loaded your trailer weigh the trailer and then the tongue separately to see if the weights are proper If they are not you may be able to get them right simply by moving some items around in the trailer Total Weight on Your Vehicle s Tires Be sure your vehicle s tires are inflated to the upper limit for cold tires You will find these numbers
120. E DEERE ia EN 4 21 Freeway Driving ssiisinisiinne riemen niie 4 22 Before Leaving on a Long Trip ecsscsscccrcccc 4 23 Highway Hypnosis ccceeeeeeeeee eee eeeeeeeeees 4 24 Hill and Mountain Roads seeeeeeeeeee eee 4 24 Winter Driving i icissiceniecse ct abbed del ieena iaa 4 26 If You Are Stuck In Sand Mud Ice or Snow 4 30 Rocking Your Vehicle to Get It Out 4 31 Loading Your Vehicle eeeeeeeeeeeeeeee 4 31 MOWING 2083s sseetendese tee a Meee eee 4 36 Towing Your Vehicle eceseeeeeeeeeereeeee 4 36 Recreational Vehicle Towing eeeeeeeeee 4 36 Level Control rr hane erne RE 4 38 TOWING a Trailer 5 seemed breden 4 38 Your Driving the Road and Your Vehicle Whenever we drive we are taking on an important responsibility This is true for any motor vehicle passenger car van truck sport utility Driver behavior the driving environment and the vehicle s design all affect how well a vehicle performs But statistics show that the most important factor by far is how we drive Knowing how these three factors work together can help you understand how your vehicle handles and what you can do to avoid many types of crashes including a rollover crash Driver Behavior The single most important thing is this everyone in the vehicle including the driver should buckle up See Safety Belts They Are for Everyone on page 1 20 In fac
121. Flat Tire on page 5 72 At Least Once a Year Starter Switch Check When you are doing this inspection the vehicle could move suddenly If the vehicle moves you or others could be injured 1 Before you start be sure you have enough room around the vehicle 2 Firmly apply both the parking brake and the regular brake See Parking Brake on page 2 26 if necessary Do not use the accelerator pedal and be ready to turn off the engine immediately if it starts 3 Try to start the engine in each gear The starter should work only in PARK P or NEUTRAL N If the starter works in any other position contact your GM Goodwrench dealer for service Automatic Transaxle Shift Lock Control 3 With the engine off turn the ignition to ON but do System Check not start the engine Without applying the regular y brake try to move the shift lever out of PARK P with normal effort If the shift lever moves out of PARK P contact your GM Goodwrench dealer for service Ignition Transaxle Lock Check When you are doing this inspection the vehicle could move suddenly If the vehicle While parked and with the parking brake set try to turn moves you or others could be injured the ignition to OFF in each shift lever position The ignition should turn to OFF only when the shift lever is in PARK P 1 Before you start be sure you have enough room around the vehicle It should be parked on a level The key should come out on
122. ION DONE will appear briefly Then PRESS SET TO EXIT MODE TO CONTINUE will appear Pressing SET will exit you out of the DIC Pressing MODE will take you to the beginning of personalization Audio System s Notice Before adding any sound equipment to your vehicle like a tape player CB radio mobile telephone or two way radio make sure that it can be added by checking with your dealer Also check federal rules covering mobile radio and telephone units If sound equipment can be added it is very important to do it properly Added sound equipment may interfere with the operation of your vehicle s engine radio or other systems and even damage them Your vehicle s systems may interfere with the operation of sound equipment that has been added improperly Figure out which audio system is in your vehicle find out what your audio system can do and how to operate all of its controls Your vehicle has a feature called Retained Accessory Power RAP With RAP the audio system can be played even after the ignition is turned off See Retained Accessory Power RAP on page 2 21 for more information 3 75 Setting the Time Press and hold H until the correct hour appears on the display AM will appear for morning hours Press and hold M until the correct minute appears on the display The time can be set with the ignition on or off To synchronize the time with an FM station broadcasting Radio Data System RDS information
123. If the object deforms the airbag could inflate at a different crash speed than if the object does not deform e If the vehicle hits a narrow object like a pole the airbag could inflate at a different crash speed than if the vehicle hits a wide object like a wall If the vehicle goes into an object at an angle the airbag could inflate at a different crash speed than if the vehicle goes straight into the object The frontal airbags driver and right front passenger are not intended to inflate during vehicle rollovers rear impacts or in many side impacts because inflation would not likely help the occupants 1 74 Your vehicle may or may not have a side impact airbag See Airbag System on page 1 67 for more information Side impact airbags are designed to inflate in moderate to severe side crashes A side impact airbag will inflate if the crash severity is above the system s designed threshold level The threshold level can vary with specific vehicle design Side impact airbags are not designed to inflate in frontal or near frontal impacts rollovers or rear impacts because inflation would not likely help the occupant A side impact airbag will only deploy on the side of the vehicle that is struck In any particular crash no one can say whether an airbag should have inflated simply because of the damage to a vehicle or because of what the repair costs were For frontal airbags inflation is determined by the angle o
124. Message W ssseeeererereneeree 3 55 OU ERE Er E 5 16 Overheated Protection Operating Mode 5 30 Engine cont Overheating 2222220 neste eeaeeaeeaeeaeeaes 5 28 Reduced Power Message s seeeeeeeeee es 3 53 Slain ot see ah santas E re 2 21 Entry Lighting 2cstesicccetiialasacuadedie sa aE Eh 3 17 Event Data Recorders EDR eeeeeeeeee ee 7 10 Exit Delay Headlamp ceeeceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeees 3 17 Exit Ligning nen ss tetas 3 18 Extender Safety Belt ccceceeeeceeeeeeeeeees 1 42 Exterior LAMPS wiinccteddasncdncitaelaienesseederienenens 3 14 F Filter Engine Air Cleaner W u u u d dsseeeevevereererenennener 5 21 Finish Damage rsin E A 5 101 Flashto Passes rarere e ESE 3 8 Flat TIG suci an re rue ere red 5 72 Flat Tire Changing 1 31 hen eanna 5 72 Flat Tire Storing cceceeceeeececeeeeeeeeeeeeaeees 5 88 Fluid Automatic Transaxle ceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeees 5 22 Power Steering siss missi rerira seinen iireransnitra 5 36 Windshield Washer eseeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeees 5 37 FOG Eamps sieisen altaner ae encneusaneeats 3 15 Four Way Manual Driver Seat a 1 3 Front Armrest Storage Area W u sssseverererrere 2 40 Front Console Storage Area a se 2 39 Front Reading Lamps simre kasernen 3 19 UGH ERR ore Be ESS ESS a rs SEERE RE KER RR ERR 5 5 Additives ici ren en he Manip ed aab dele 5 6 Galitormia Fuel sacsicchssncacsleuned
125. Metric Tire Example A Tire Size The tire size is a combination of letters and numbers used to define a particular tire s width height aspect ratio construction type and service description See the Tire Size illustration later in this section for more detail 5 56 B TPC Spec Tire Performance Criteria Specification Original equipment tires designed to GM s specific tire performance criteria have a TPC specification code molded onto the sidewall GM s TPC specifications meet or exceed all federal safety guidelines C DOT Department of Transportation The Department of Transportation DOT code indicates that the tire is in compliance with the U S Department of Transportation Motor Vehicle Safety Standards D Tire Identification Number TIN The letters and numbers following DOT Department of Transportation code is the Tire Identification Number TIN The TIN shows the manufacturer and plant code tire size and date the tire was manufactured The TIN is molded onto both sides of the tire although only one side may have the date of manufacture E Tire Ply Material The type of cord and number of plies in the sidewall and under the tread F Uniform Tire Quality Grading UTQG Tire manufacturers are required to grade tires based on three performance factors treadwear traction and temperature resistance For more information see Uniform Tire Quality Grading on page 5 67 G Maximum Cold In
126. Power Receiver Ignition Relay Neutral Start Switch Fuse Cage Automatic Transaxle Shift Lock Control System Anti lock Brake System ABS Motor Main Battery Fuse for Retained 40 Accessory Power Relay and Accessory Relay Main Battery Fuse for Heated Seats Air Main Battery Fuse for Power 44 Outlets Level Control Power Seats and Mirrors and Body Computer 46 Main Battery Fuse for Climate Control Blower and Ignition 3 Relay Main Battery Fuse for Ignition Switch Radio Heads Up Display Remote Keyless Entry RKE Instrument Cluster Air Conditioning and Body Computer Diode for Air Conditioning 70 Compressor Clutch Relay TU 60 Cooling Fan 2 SSS 5 109 a 5 110 ABBE B 8AE e 868 3 6L V6 Engine Fuel Pump Transmission Control Module TCM Anti lock Brake System ABS Solenoids Valves Use Driver s Low Beam Headlamp Driver s High Beam Headlamp Ignition Switch Battery Power Control System Starter Solenoid Battery Fuse Fuse Usage Main Battery Fuse for Retained Accessory Power Relay and Accessory Relay Main Battery Fuse for Heated Seats Air Conditioning Defogger Main Battery Fuse for Power 44 Outlets Level Control Power Seats Mirrors and Body Computer 46 Main Battery Fuse for Climate Control Blower and Ignition 3 Relay Main Battery Fuse for Ignition Switch Radio Heads Up Display 47 HUD Remote Keyless Entry RKE Ins
127. Preset Program Press this button to scan through the preset radio stations set on the pushbuttons on the main radio The radio will go to a preset station stored on the pushbuttons play for a few seconds then go on to the next preset station Press this button again to stop scanning presets This function is inactive if the front seat passengers are listening to the radio When a cassette tape is playing press this button to go to the other side of the tape This function is inactive if the front seat passengers are listening to a cassette tape When a CD is playing press this button to select the next CD if multiple CDs are loaded This function is inactive if the front seat passengers are listening to a CD 3 132 VOL Volume Press this knob lightly so it extends Turn the knob to increase or to decrease the volume Push the knob back into its stored position when you are not using it The upper knob controls the upper headphones and the lower knob controls the lower headphones PHONES To listen to the RSA sound plug the wired headphones into these RCA jacks Theft Deterrent Feature THEFTLOCK is designed to discourage theft of your vehicle s radio It works by using a secret code to disable all radio functions whenever battery power is removed and the radio is placed in a different vehicle This feature requires no user input to be activated The radio is automatically armed when it is put into the vehicle for the f
128. RE will display You must begin driving before the system will detect a low tire pressure See Check Tire Pressure System on page 5 62 USE SET TO SELECT ENGLISH METRIC You can use this display to select English or metric Press the SET button to toggle between English or metric The DIC the odometer the trip odometer and head up display will change A Canadian odometer and trip odometer will remain in metric units only OFF No driver information will be displayed in this mode If the DIC is left in this mode for more than three seconds the display will turn off Press the MODE button to start the DIC 3 65 DIC Vehicle Personalization The DIC is used to program the choices of two drivers The drivers are recognized as DRIVER 1 or DRIVER 2 in the DIC display You will let the DIC know which driver you are by using your remote keyless entry transmitter Each remote keyless entry transmitter was pre programmed to belong to DRIVER 1 or DRIVER 2 Each transmitter may be programmed differently for each driver s preferences lights doors horn or activate the programmed radio stations for driver 1 or driver 2 using your remote keyless entry transmitter After you press the LOCK button on your transmitter and the ignition key is in ON the DIC will display the identified driver number The vehicle will also recall the vehicle customization features that were last programmed to correspond to your transmitter If you unlock your vehi
129. RENE ae REESE SEEREN SE SEERE Es ERE Eee S R 4 21 DefeNSiVe 222 kirs cece eee pi a 4 3 BRUN KEN ar er E R e EES 4 3 EnvirOnMent sieciom a ne se salg 4 2 Freeway serdari cien seia An 4 22 Hill and Mountain Roads 4 24 In Rain and on Wet Roads eeeeeeee ees 4 18 Rocking Your Vehicle to Get it Out 4 31 WINTER Hessens een SE Serre Stenene SAS ES ERE SES ERR SEERNES 4 26 Dual Automatic Climate Control System 3 33 Dual Climate Control System eeeeeeee eee 3 30 DVD Rear Seat Entertainment System 3 115 Electrical System Add On Equipment ceeeeeeeeeeeeeeee ees 5 104 Floor Console Fuse Block a a 5 105 Fuses and Circuit Breakers a se 5 105 Headlamp Wiring samar hanen 5 104 Power Windows and Other Power Options 5 104 Underhood Fuse Block cceeeeeeeeee eee 5 107 Windshield Wiper Fuses e eseeeeee ees 5 104 Engine Air Cleaner Filter 2 2 0 0 ccceceeeneeneeneee een eeaes 5 21 Battery siorr Ghandesacuncaccnnecvenstebamongtteentectne 5 41 Change Oil Message uW u ds cseeeeeeeerere renere eens 3 55 Check and Service Engine Soon Light 3 46 COOlAM SER SEE Er S 5 25 Coolant Heater sienai tsn ansera aaas 2 22 Coolant Temperature Gage u sssseeeeereee 3 46 Coolant Temperature Warning Message 3 52 Engine Compartment Overview 5 12 EXMAUSE 22 cera essere de As nere 2 29 Low Oil Level
130. S two way radios mobile fax or walkie talkies It may be necessary to turn off the DVD player when operating one of these devices in or near the vehicle Excludes the OnStar System Cleaning the DVD Player When cleaning the outside DVD faceplate and buttons use only a clean cloth dampened with clean water Cleaning the Video Screen When cleaning the video screen use only a clean cloth dampened with clean water Use care when directly touching or cleaning the screen as damage may result 3 129 Navigation Radio System Your vehicle may have a navigation radio system that includes Radio Data System RDS with Program Type PTY selections that will seek out the kind of music you want to listen to and XM Satellite Radio Service capabilities if equipped The radio can also communicate with the navigation system to broadcast announcements on traffic weather and emergency alert communications For information on how to use this system see the Navigation System manual Rear Seat Audio RSA This feature allows rear seat passengers to listen to any of the sources radio cassette tapes or CDs However the rear seat passengers can only control the sources that the front seat passengers are not listening to For example rear seat passengers may listen to and control cassette tapes or CDs through the headphones while the driver listens to the radio through the front speakers The rear seat passengers have contr
131. SAFETY BELT WHEN ATTACHING FASTEN SEAT BELTS MOVE SEAT FULLY REARWARD SECURE CHILD SEAT YE PULL BELT OUT COMPLETELY THEN SECURE NE YQ CHILD SEAT POWER t WINDOW B oe AIR BAG X DO NOT INSTALL A REAR FACING CHILD RESTRAINT IN THIS SEATING POSITION e DO NOT INSTALL A FORWARD FACING CHILD RESTRAINT IN THIS SEATING POSITION DOOR LOCK UNLOCK ENGINE COOLANT MASTER s 7 LIGHTING SWITCH s TEMP 11 gee le A PS BATTERY CHARGING SYSTEM PARKING LAMPS HAZARD WARNING FLASHER ENGINE OIL PRESSURE ANTI LOCK BRAKES 7 HD FUSE BOX ACCESS ENGINE COOLANT OWNER S MANUAL SERVICE MANUAL 4 NOTES vi Section 1 Seats and Restraint Systems Front Seats incoado aien eee 1 3 Manual Passenger Seat a se eneen 1 3 Four Way Manual Driver Seat u u u dcssevereereee 1 3 Six Way Power Seats c ceceeeeeeeeeeneeeeeneees 1 4 Manual Lumbar scera ls ne ees 1 5 Heated Seats cccececeeeeeeeee neste eee ener enker 1 5 Reclining Seatbacks 2 02 0 ceeeeeeeeeeeneee een eeeeenes 1 6 Head Restraints os vececieesteiessuecn sanaie ecamcesriarasgars 1 7 Rear Seats acitretine ariane niana durna 1 8 Rear Seat Operation cscs siges kedede 1 8 Split Bench Seats o nano sokker RDL ERE 1 8 Captain Chairs risus beg 1 13 Stowable Seat cceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeaeeees 1 17 Safety Belts lt i ccscccod cee cnn
132. SE OFF and the radio will return to the last radio source that you were listening to Rear Seat Entertainment System Your vehicle may have a DVD Rear Seat Entertainment RSE system The RSE system includes a DVD player a video display screen two sets of wireless headphones and a remote control Parental Control This button is located behind the video screen next to the auxiliary jacks near the driver of the vehicle Press this button while a DVD or CD is playing to freeze the video and mute the audio The video screen will display Parental Control On and the power indicator light on the DVD player will flash It will also disable all other button operations from the remote control and the DVD player with the exception of the eject button The driver will then be able to gain the attention of the rear seat passengers Press this button again to restore normal operation of the DVD player and remote control This button may also be used to turn the DVD player power on and automatically resume play if the vehicle is in an enabled power mode 3 115 Before You Drive The RSE is designed for rear seat passengers only The driver cannot safely view the video screen while driving and should not try to do so The DVD system is designed to be inoperable when the vehicle is exposed to extremely low or high temperatures in order to protect the system from damage Operate the DVD system under normal or comfortable cabin temperature ra
133. WD system components If the vehicle is exposed to extended heavy AWD usage the AWD system will shut itself off to protect the system from overheating When the system cools down the AWD system will activate itself again automatically this cool down can take up to 20 minutes depending on outside temperature and vehicle use See Al Wheel Drive Disable Warning Message on page 3 57 Steering Power Steering If you lose power steering assist because the engine stops or the system is not functioning you can steer but it will take much more effort Steering Tips Driving on Curves It is important to take curves at a reasonable speed A lot of the driver lost control accidents mentioned on the news happen on curves Here is why Experienced driver or beginner each of us is subject to the same laws of physics when driving on curves The traction of the tires against the road surface makes it possible for the vehicle to change its path when you turn the front wheels If there is no traction inertia will keep the vehicle going in the same direction If you have ever tried to steer a vehicle on wet ice you will understand this The traction you can get in a curve depends on the condition of your tires and the road surface the angle at which the curve is banked and your speed While you are in a curve speed is the one factor you can control Suppose you are steering through a sharp curve Then you suddenly apply the bra
134. Weg iv bg x E SIN When to Add Engine Oil lf the oil is below the cross hatched area at the tip of the dipstick then you will need to add at least one quart of oil But you must use the right kind This section explains what kind of oil to use For engine oil crankcase capacity see Capacities and Specifications on page 5 112 Notice Do not add too much oil If your engine has so much oil that the oil level gets above the cross hatched area that shows the proper operating range your engine could be damaged See Engine Compartment Overview on page 5 12 for the location of the engine oil fill cap Fo SAE 5W 30 Cli Be sure to add enough oil to put the level somewhere in the proper operating range in the cross hatched area Push the dipstick all the way back in when you are through What Kind of Engine Oil to Use Look for two things e GM6094M Your vehicle s engine requires oil meeting GM Standard GM6094M You should look for and use only an oil that meets GM Standard GM6094M e RECOMMENDED SAE VISCOSITY GRADE ENGINE OILS ah se As shown in the viscosity chart SAE 5W 30 is best for your vehicle These numbers on an oil container show its LOOK FOR viscosity or thickness Do not use other viscosity THIS SYMBOL il h AE 20W 50 HOT ANDGM S oils such as S OW 50 WEATHER STANDARD Oils meeting these GM 6094M requirements should also have the starburst symbol on the container Th
135. Your Vehicle and the Environment 6 2 Malfunction Indicator Light eeeeeeeeeeeeee es 3 46 Manual Lumbar Controls seeeeeeeneeeeeeee ees 1 5 Manual Passenger Seat i e 1 3 Memory Seat cceceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeee eee eeneeas 2 47 Message All Wheel Drive Disable Warning c c 3 57 GONleh otis DES ENE SEER SEERE aen Ene item teceanatce 3 51 Change Engine Oil 2 2 arsen seeren LET eens 3 55 Charging System Indicator eeeeeeeeee ee 3 53 Door Ajar Warning isis sercdeiinesivciigecivied 3 56 Engine Coolant Temperature Warning 3 52 Highbeam Out Warning 0 eee 3 61 Low Brake Fluid Warning ceeeeeeeeeee es 3 59 Low Engine Oil Level eceeeeeeeeeeeeeee ees 3 55 Low Fuel Warning ceceeeeeeeeeeeee teeta tenes 3 58 Message cont Low Oil Pressure sssseeeerereere nerne rr nr nnnee 3 54 EOW IE EET eee Reale 3 56 Low Washer Fluid Warning eeeeeeeee es 3 58 Park Lamp Warning s eeeeeeeeneeeeeee eens 3 61 PASS Key III Security ccccccceeceeeeeeeees 3 57 Program Mode saa ar oe aner koere 3 60 Rear Hatch Ajar Warning cecce 3 56 Reduced Engine Power 0 cseeeeeeseeees 3 53 Remote Keyless Entry Transmitter Battery LOW Warning ssi eedonia n 3 60 Service Traction System Warning W 1 3 51 Service Vehicle SOON W ssseeeeeerere renerne nn
136. a basecoat clearcoat paint finish may damage it Use only non abrasive waxes and polishes that are made for a basecoat clearcoat paint finish on your vehicle Foreign materials such as calcium chloride and other salts ice melting agents road oil and tar tree sap bird droppings chemicals from industrial chimneys etc can damage the vehicle s finish if they remain on painted surfaces Wash the vehicle as soon as possible If necessary use non abrasive cleaners that are marked safe for painted surfaces to remove foreign matter Exterior painted surfaces are subject to aging weather and chemical fallout that can take their toll over a period of years To help keep the paint finish looking new keep the vehicle in a garage or covered whenever possible Windshield Backglass and Wiper Blades If the windshield is not clear after using the windshield washer or if the wiper blade chatters when running wax sap or other material may be on the blade or windshield Clean the outside of the windshield with a full strength glass cleaning liquid The windshield is clean if beads do not form when you rinse it with water Grime from the windshield will stick to the wiper blades and affect their performance Clean the blade by wiping vigorously with a cloth soaked in full strength windshield washer solvent Then rinse the blade with water Check the wiper blades and clean them as necessary replace blades that look worn 5 99
137. about three seconds in each range Then position the shift lever in PARK P 4 Let the engine run at idle for three to five minutes 5 23 Then without shutting off the engine do the following See Engine Compartment Overview on page 5 12 for information on dipstick location lf your vehicle is equipped with a 3400 V6 engine the dipstick handle will be a red loop 5 24 If your vehicle is equipped with a 3 6L V6 engine the dipstick handle will have this symbol on it Pull out the dipstick and wipe it with a clean rag or paper towel Push it back in all the way wait three seconds and then pull it back out again Check both sides of the dipstick and read the lower level The fluid level must be in the cross hatched area If the fluid level is in the acceptable range push the dipstick back in all the way How to Add Automatic Transaxle Fluid Refer to the Maintenance Schedule to determine what kind of transaxle fluid to use See Recommended Fluids and Lubricants on page 6 12 lf the fluid level is low add only enough of the proper fluid to bring the level into the cross hatched area on the dipstick 1 Pull out the dipstick 2 Using a long neck funnel add enough fluid at the dipstick hole to bring it to the proper level It does not take much fluid generally less than one pint 0 5 L Do not overfill Notice Use of automatic transaxle fluid labeled other than DEXRON III
138. act spare tire See Compact Spare Tire on page 5 94 for more information about the compact spare Hoist Shaft D Retainer Folding Wrench E Compact Spare Tire Hoist Assembly Flip the rear cargo area carpet cut out to expose the hoist shaft 2 Attach the folding wrench into the hoist shaft Turn the folding wrench counterclockwise to lower the spare tire to the ground Continue turning the wrench until the spare tire can be pulled out from under the vehicle 4 Tilt the retainer and slip it through the wheel opening to remove the spare tire from the cable 5 Turn the wrench clockwise to raise the cable back up after removing the spare tire Do not store a full size or a flat road tire under the vehicle See Storing a Flat or Spare Tire and Tools on page 5 88 To continue changing the flat tire see Removing the Flat Tire and Installing the Spare Tire on page 5 80 5 76 If the spare tire will not lower the secondary latch may be engaged causing the tire not to lower Do the following to check the cable 1 Check under the vehicle to see if the cable is visible 2 If it is not visible see Secondary Latch System on page 5 84 If it is visible first try to tighten the cable by turning the folding wrench clockwise until you hear two clicks or feel it skip twice You cannot over tighten the cable 3 4 5 Loosen the cable by turning the wrench counterclockwise three or four turns If the spa
139. ad compounds chemicals known to the State of California to cause cancer and reproductive harm Wash hands after handling Vehicle Storage If you are not going to drive your vehicle for 25 days or more remove the black negative cable from the battery This will help keep your battery from running down Batteries have acid that can burn you and gas that can explode You can be badly hurt if you are not careful See Jump Siarting on page 5 42 for tips on working around a battery without getting hurt Also for your audio system see Theft Deterrent Feature on page 3 132 5 41 Jump Starting If your battery has run down you may want to use another vehicle and some jumper cables to start your vehicle Be sure to use the following steps to do it safely Batteries can hurt you They can be dangerous because They contain acid that can burn you They contain gas that can explode or ignite They contain enough electricity to burn you If you do not follow these steps exactly some or all of these things can hurt you Notice Ignoring these steps could result in costly damage to your vehicle that would not be covered by your warranty 5 42 Trying to start your vehicle by pushing or pulling it will not work and it could damage your vehicle 1 Check the other vehicle It must have a 12 volt battery with a negative ground system Notice If the other vehicle s system is not a 12 volt syste
140. ad tire under the vehicle See Storing a Flat or Spare Tire and Tools on page 5 88 To continue changing the flat tire see Removing the Flat Tire and Installing the Spare Tire on page 5 80 5 78 lf the spare tire will not lower the secondary latch may be engaged causing the tire not to lower Do the following to check the cable 1 2 Check under the vehicle to see if the cable is visible If it is not visible see Secondary Latch System on page 5 84 If it is visible first try to tighten the cable by turning the folding wrench clockwise until you hear two clicks or feel it skip twice You cannot over tighten the cable Loosen the cable by turning the wrench counterclockwise three or four turns If the spare tire has not lowered tighten the cable all the way and then loosen it at least two times If the spare tire did lower to the ground continue with Step 5 under Removing the Spare Tire Vehicles with the Rear Convenience Center listed previously If you still cannot lower the spare tire to the ground see Secondary Latch System on page 5 84 5 79 Removing the Flat Tire and Installing the Spare Tire 1 If there is a wheel cover loosen the plastic nut caps with the wheel wrench They will not come off Then using the flat end of the wheel wrench pry along the edge of the cover until it comes off Be careful the edges may be sharp Do not try to remove the cover with your bare ha
141. aler can offer you one of the following Shuttle Service Participating dealers can provide you with shuttle service to get to your destination with minimal interruption of your daily schedule This includes a one way or round trip shuttle ride to a destination up to 10 miles from the dealership Public Transportation or Fuel Reimbursement If your vehicle requires overnight warranty repairs reimbursement of up to a five day maximum may be available for the use of public transportation such as a taxi or bus In addition should you arrange transportation through a friend or relative reimbursement for reasonable fuel expenses of up to a five day maximum may be available Claim amounts should reflect actual costs and be supported by original receipts Courtesy Rental Vehicle Your dealer may arrange to provide you with a courtesy rental vehicle or reimburse you for a rental vehicle that you obtain if your vehicle is kept for a warranty repair Reimbursement will be limited to a maximum of 30 a day and must be supported by receipts This requires that you sign and complete a rental agreement and meet state local and rental vehicle provider requirements Requirements vary and may include minimum age requirements insurance coverage credit card etc You are responsible for taxes levies usage fees excessive mileage or rental usage beyond the completion of the repair Generally it is not possible to provide a like vehicle as a cou
142. ance II Use Maintenance II if the previous service performed was Maintenance I Always use Maintenance II whenever the message comes on 10 months or more since the last service or if the message has not come on at all for one year Scheduled Maintenance we Maintenance Maintenance T Change engine oil and filter See Engine Oil on page 5 16 Reset oil life system See Engine Oil Life System on page 5 19 An Emission Control Service Visually check for any leaks or damage See footnote j 0 02 e Inspect engine air cleaner filter If necessary replace filter See Engine Air Cleaner Filter on page 5 21 An Emission Control Service See footnotes t and l Rotate tires and check inflation pressures and wear See Tires on page 5 55 0 0 eee Inspect brake system See footnote a 0 022 e Check engine coolant and windshield washer fluid levels and add fluid as sl needed Perform any needed additional services See Additional Required Services in this section inspect suspension and steering components See foomo 0 inspect engine cooling system Seetoomoe e M T inspect wiper blades See toome D T inspect restrain system components See oroe e T Lubricate body components See foomo T Check transaxle fuid Tevel and add fuid as needed J Finspect throttle system See footnote p D T Replace passenger compartment air titer See footnote 9 Additional Require
143. and Parking Lamps ssirisnpie innan 5 51 Halogen BUDS 2 3 2 saaledes eee 5 49 Headlamps Front Turn Signal Sidemarker and Parking Lamps ceeeeeeeeeeeeeee eee 5 49 High Low Beam Changer c eee 3 8 Head Up Display HUD eee eens eee tees 3 21 Heated Se ats sce2ieesvecstdiwiei ci eceden iie 1 5 H at r see ai ae 3 28 3 30 Heater oreste err epee ee tee ee perenne ee 3 33 Highbeam On Light cceeeeeeeeeeeeeeee eee eeneees 3 49 Highbeam Out Warning Message 0 e0e 3 61 Highway Hypnosis 0 ccececcceeseneetencereeeeceees 4 24 Hill and Mountain Roads eceeeeeeeeee eee eees 4 24 HomeLink Transmitter cccccccccccceeeeeeeeeeees 2 34 HomeLink Transmitter Programming 2 35 Hood Checking Things Under ceeeeeeeeeeneees 5 10 Release 230i tehicsiessiedsdsacdeabinnieaasiiv desea 5 11 FIONN ES S E E E E 3 6 How to Use This Manual sssssesseerere rn enrnennrer ii How to Wear Safety Belts Properly 1 25 I IGNITION POSIIONS sis nor ledn keen detec 2 20 Infants and Young Children Restraints 1 45 Inflation Tire Pressure ccenn 5 61 Instrument Panel Brightness ameioura roen dne 3 16 Gluster mecina e aa aa dn died 3 38 Instrument Panel cont Overview oo eee cece cece eee eee e ea eeeeeaeeaeeaeeeeeneees 3 4 SWITCMDANK seriener pma nien ha EEn a 3 20 Integrated Windshield A
144. and replacement parts Service Parts Identification Label You will find this label on the inside of the access panel located on the driver s side of the rear of the vehicle It is very helpful if you ever need to order parts On this label you will find the following VIN Model designation Paint information e Production options and special equipment Be sure that this label is not removed from the vehicle 5 103 Electrical System Add On Electrical Equipment Notice Don t add anything electrical to your vehicle unless you check with your dealer first Some electrical equipment can damage your vehicle and the damage wouldn t be covered by your warranty Some add on electrical equipment can keep other components from working as they should Your vehicle has an airbag system Before attempting to add anything electrical to your vehicle see Servicing Your Airbag Equipped Vehicle on page 1 82 Headlamp Wiring The headlamp wiring is protected by internal fuses in the fuse block An electrical overload will cause the lamps to go off and remain off If this happens have your headlamp wiring checked right away 5 104 Windshield Wiper Fuses The windshield wiper motor is protected by an internal circuit breaker and a fuse If the motor overheats due to heavy snow etc the wiper will stop until the motor cools If the overload is caused by some electrical problem be sure to get it fixed Power Windows and Other Po
145. andled by easing your foot off the accelerator pedal If your vehicle starts to slide ease your foot off the accelerator pedal and quickly steer the way you want the vehicle to go If you start steering quickly enough your vehicle may straighten out Always be ready for a second skid if it occurs Of course traction is reduced when water snow ice gravel or other material is on the road For safety you will want to slow down and adjust your driving to these conditions It is important to slow down on slippery surfaces because stopping distance will be longer and vehicle control more limited While driving on a surface with reduced traction try your best to avoid sudden steering acceleration or braking including engine braking by shifting to a lower gear Any sudden changes could cause the tires to slide You may not realize the surface is slippery until your vehicle is skidding Learn to recognize warning clues such as enough water ice or packed snow on the road to make a mirrored surface and slow down when you have any doubt If you have the anti lock braking system remember It helps avoid only the braking skid If you do not have anti lock then in a braking skid where the wheels are no longer rolling release enough pressure on the brakes to get the wheels rolling again This restores steering control Push the brake pedal down steadily when you have to stop suddenly As long as the wheels are rolling you
146. arder to push down If your engine stops you will still have some power brake assist But you will use it when you brake Once the power assist is used up it may take longer to stop and the brake pedal will be harder to push Anti Lock Brake System ABS Your vehicle may have anti lock brakes ABS is an advanced electronic braking system that will help prevent a braking skid ANTI LOCK Canada United States If your vehicle has anti lock brakes this warning light on the instrument panel will come on briefly when you start your vehicle When you start your engine or when you begin to drive away your anti lock brake system will check itself You may hear a momentary motor or clicking noise while this test is going on and you may even notice that your brake pedal moves or pulses a little This is normal Let us say the road is wet and you are driving safely Suddenly an animal jumps out in front of you You slam on the brakes and continue braking Here is what happens with ABS A computer senses that wheels are slowing down If one of the wheels is about to stop rolling the computer will separately work the brakes at each wheel The anti lock system can change the brake pressure faster than any driver could The computer is programmed to make the most of available tire and road conditions This can help you steer around the obstacle while braking hard As you brake your computer keeps receiving updates on
147. are safer if they are restrained in the rear rather than the front seat General Motors recommends that child restraints be secured in a rear seat including an infant riding in a rear facing infant seat a child riding in a forward facing child seat and an older child riding in a booster seat Your vehicle has a rear seat that will accommodate a rear facing child restraint A label on your sun visor says Never put a rear facing child seat in the front This is because the risk to the rear facing child is so great if the airbag deploys 1 78 A child in a rear facing child restraint can be seriously injured or killed if the right front passenger s airbag inflates This is because the back of the rear facing child restraint would be very close to the inflating airbag Even though the passenger sensing system is designed to turn off the passenger s frontal airbag if the system detects a rear facing child restraint no system is fail safe and no one can guarantee that an airbag will not deploy under some unusual circumstance even though it is turned off General Motors recommends that rear facing child restraints be secured in the rear seat even if the airbag is off The passenger sensing system is designed to turn off the right front passenger s frontal airbag if the right front passenger seat is unoccupied the system determines that an infant is present in a rear facing infant seat the system determines
148. areeteeennteseenerennne 2 38 Capacities and Specifications eee 5 112 SUMOO ae ee E E 2 47 Maintenance Schedule 222 6 1 Vehicle Personalization 2 d dsssseeerereeree 2 47 Maintenance Schedule cceceececcececeeceseee 6 2 Instrument Panel 20cecceceeceeeeeeeeeeeeeaees 3 1 Customer Assistance and Information 7 1 Instrument Panel Overview ecceeeeeeeeee eens 3 Customer Assistance and Information _ 7 2 Climate Controls ooo cece cece eeeeeeeeeeee nets ees 3 28 Reporting Safety Defects 1 7 11 Warning Lights Gages and Indicators _ SOP Index OO 1 Ww BUICK GENERAL MOTORS GM the GM Emblem BUICK the BUICK Emblem and the name RENDEZVOUS are registered trademarks of General Motors Corporation This manual includes the latest information at the time it was printed We reserve the right to make changes after that time without notice For vehicles first sold in Canada substitute the name General Motors of Canada Limited for Buick Motor Division whenever it appears in this manual Keep this manual in the vehicle so it will be there if it is needed while you are on the road If the vehicle is sold leave this manual in the vehicle Litho in U S A Part No OO5RENDEZVOUS A First Edition Canadian Owners A French language copy of this manual can be obtained from your dealer or from Helm Incorporated P O Box 07130 Detroit MI 48207
149. arning Message LOW WASHER FLUID United States Canada Your vehicle may have a low washer fluid warning message If your washer fluid is low this warning message will come on and stay on until you add washer fluid See Windshield Washer Fluid on page 5 37 for adding washer fluid instructions If the warning message is still on after adding fluid you need to reset the warning message To reset the warning message turn the ignition off and then back on If the message stays on see your dealer 3 58 Low Fuel Warning Message LOW FUEL United States Canada If your fuel is low the warning message will come on and stay on until you add fuel If the warning message is still on after adding fuel you need to reset the warning message To reset the warning message turn the ignition off and then back on If the message stays on see your dealer Low Brake Fluid Warning Message Canada United States lf your brake fluid is low the warning message will come on and stay on until you add brake fluid The brake system warning light will also be illuminated lf this message appears the brakes need attention You should have your vehicle serviced immediately See Brake System Warning Light on page 3 44 and Brakes on page 5 38 If the warning message is still on after adding fluid you may need to reset the warning message To reset the warning message turn the ignition off and then back on If the message stays on
150. around TRAF When a traffic announcement comes on the tuned radio station you will hear it If the station does not broadcast traffic announcements press the TRAF button and the radio will seek to a station that does When a station that broadcasts traffic announcements is found the radio will stop seeking and brackets will be displayed around TRAF If no station is found that broadcasts traffic announcements NO TRAFFIC will appear on the display If the brackets are on the display and TRAF is not press the TRAF button to remove the brackets or use the TUNE knob or the SEEK arrows to go to a station that broadcasts traffic announcements If no station is found that broadcasts traffic announcements NO TRAFFIC will appear on the display 3 82 The radio will play the traffic announcements if the volume is low The radio will interrupt the play of a CD if the last tuned station broadcasts traffic announcements and the brackets are displayed This function does not apply to XM Satellite Radio Service Radio Messages CAL CALIBRATE The audio system has been calibrated for your vehicle from the factory If CAL appears on the display it means that the radio has not been configured properly for your vehicle and must be returned to the dealer for service LOCKED This message is displayed when the THEFTLOCK system has locked up Take the vehicle to the dealer for service If any error occurs repeatedly or if an error cannot
151. ars on the display and or the CD comes out it could be for one of the following reasons It is very hot When the temperature returns to normal the CD should play You are driving on a very rough road When the road becomes smoother the CD should play The CD is dirty scratched wet or upside down The air is very humid If so wait about an hour and try again There may have been a problem while burning the CD The label may be caught in the CD player If the CD is not playing correctly for any other reason try a known good CD If any error occurs repeatedly or if an error cannot be corrected contact your dealer If the radio displays an error message write it down and provide it to your dealer when reporting the problem Listening to a DVD Your vehicle may have a Rear Seat Entertainment System see Rear Seat Entertainment System on page 3 115 for more information If your vehicle has this system and a DVD is playing the DVD symbol will appear on the radio display indicating that the DVD is available and can be listened through your vehicles speakers To listen to the DVD press the CD AUX button until RSE appears on the radio display The current source will stop and the DVD sound will come through the speakers To stop listening to the DVD press the CD AUX button if a CD is loaded or press the BAND button to select a different source When the RSE system is turned off the radio will display R
152. art number or specification may be obtained from your dealer Usage Fluid Lubricant Engine oil which meets GM Standard GM6094M and displays the American Petroleum Institute Certified for Gasoline Engines starburst symbol GM Goodwrench oil meets all the requirements for your vehicle To determine the proper viscosity for your vehicle s engine see Engine Oil on page 5 16 50 50 mixture of clean drinkable water and use only Engine Oil Engine Coolant DEX COOL Coolant See Engine Coolant on page 5 25 Hydraulic Brake Delco Supreme 11 Brake Fluid or System equivalent DOT 3 brake fluid Fide i GM Optikleen Washer Solvent i GM Power Steering Fluid GM Part Power Steering No U S 89021184 in Canada y 89021186 Usage Fluid Lubricant DEXRON III Automatic Transmission Fluid Look for Approved for the H Specification on the label evi Leck Multi Purpose Lubricant Superlube Cylinders GM Part No U S 12346241 in y Canada 10953474 Carrier Assembly Differential Rear Drive Module and Transfer Case Power Transfer Unit Hood Latch Assembly Secondary Latch Pivots Automatic Transaxle VERSATRAK Fluid GM Part No U S 12378514 in Canada 88901045 Lubriplate Lubricant Aerosol GM Part No U S 12346293 in Canada 992723 or lubricant meeting Spring Anchor requirements of NLGI 2 Category and Release LB or GC LB Pawl Hood and Door Multi Purpose Lubrica
153. ary device to the RCA jacks Refer to the manufacturer s instructions for proper usage To use the auxiliary audio and video inputs connect an external auxiliary device such as a camcorder to the RCA jacks and turn on both the auxiliary device power and the power on the front of the RSE player If a disc is present when the RSE power is turned on the player will automatically begin playing the disc and the user will need to press the SRCE button on the remote control or on the DVD player faceplate to switch the system between the DVD player and the auxiliary device See DVD Player and Remote Control later in this section for more information 3 117 Audio Output Audio from the DVD player or auxiliary devices can be heard through the following possible sources e Wireless Headphones Vehicle s Speakers Rear Seat Audio RSA RCA Jacks if equipped Plug the wired headphones not included into the jacks on the RSA system Only one audio source can be heard through the vehicle s speakers at a time The RSE system or an auxiliary device can be heard through all of the vehicles speakers when the following occurs The RSA system if equipped is off A DVD or auxiliary device is playing The front audio system is on and either the CD the CD TAPE or the CD AUX button is pressed to enable the RSE system RSE will appear on the radio display when the RSE system is on and RSE OFF when it is off 3 1
154. at D J Hook B Full Size Tire E D Ring C Wing Nut Fold the seatback down and flip the D ring up 2 Lay the tire on the seatback with the valve stem pointing up with the center hole of the tire over the D ring Remove the J hook and the wing nut from the back of the jack access door Assemble the wing nut and the J hook Install the wing nut and the J hook to the D ring through the center hole of the tire Tighten the wing nut to secure the tire to the seatback Push and pull on the tire to make sure the tire is secure and does not move Put back all tools as they were stored in the jack storage compartment and put the compartment cover back on Slip the tabs on the side of the compartment cover into the cover opening Push the cover in place and push down the tabs on the cover so that it rests in the groove This secures the cover in place 5 91 Storing the Spare Tire and Tools Storing a jack a tire or other equipment in the passenger compartment of the vehicle could cause injury In a sudden stop or collision loose equipment could strike someone Store all these in the proper place 5 92 The underbody mounted spare tire needs to be stored with the valve stem pointing down If the spare tire is stored with the valve stem pointing upwards its secondary latch won t work properly and the spare tire could loosen and suddenly fall from your vehicle If this happened when your v
155. ations six FM1 six FM2 and six AM six XM1 and six XM2 if equipped can be programmed on the six numbered pushbuttons by performing the following steps 1 Turn the radio on 2 Press BAND to select FM1 FM2 or AM or XM1 or XM2 3 Tune in the desired station 4 Press EQ to select the equalization 5 Press and hold one of the six numbered pushbuttons until you hear a beep Whenever that numbered pushbutton is pressed the station that was set will return and the equalization that was selected will be stored for that pushbutton 6 Repeat the steps for each pushbutton Setting the Tone Bass Treble AUDIO Push and release this knob until BASS MID or TREBLE appears on the display Then turn the AUDIO knob to increase or to decrease If a station is weak or noisy decrease the treble To adjust bass midrange or treble to the middle position select BASS MID or TREBLE Then push and hold AUDIO for more than two seconds until you hear a beep BASS and a zero MID and a zero or TREBLE and a zero will appear on the display To adjust both tone controls and both speaker controls to the middle position first end out of audio mode by waiting five seconds without making any changes Then push and hold the AUDIO knob for more than two seconds until you hear a beep ALL CENTERED will appear on the display EQ Equalizer Press this button to select customized equalization settings designed for country western jaz
156. atives will explain any payment obligations you might incur For prompt and efficient assistance when calling please provide the following to the Roadside Assistance Representative Your name home address and home telephone number Telephone number of your location Location of the vehicle Model year color and license plate number Mileage Vehicle Identification Number and delivery date of the vehicle Description of the problem While we hope you never have the occasion to use our service it is added security while traveling for you and your family Remember we are only a phone call away Buick Roadside Assistance 1 800 252 1112 text telephone TTY users call 1 888 889 2438 Buick reserves the right to limit services or reimbursement to an owner or driver when in Buick s judgement the claims become excessive in frequency or type of occurrence Roadside Assistance is not part of or included in the coverage provided by the New Vehicle Limited Warranty Buick reserves the right to make any changes or discontinue the Roadside Assistance program at any time without notification Canadian Roadside Assistance Vehicles purchased in Canada have an extensive roadside assistance program accessible from anywhere in Canada or the United States Please refer to the Warranty and Owner Assistance Information book Courtesy Transportation Buick has always exemplified quality and value in its offering of m
157. ator light in the button will come on to let you know that air conditioning is activated You may notice a slight change in engine performance when the air conditioning compressor shuts off and turns on again This is normal The system is designed to make adjustments to help with fuel economy while still maintaining the selected temperature On hot days open the windows to let hot inside air escape then close them This helps to reduce the time it takes for your vehicle to cool down It also helps the system to operate more efficiently The air conditioning system removes moisture from the air so you may sometimes notice a small amount of water dripping underneath your vehicle while idling or after turning off the engine This is normal 3 31 Defogging and Defrosting Fog on the inside of windows is a result of high humidity or moisture condensing on the cool window glass This can be minimized if the climate controls system is used properly There are two modes to clear fog or frost from your windshield Use the defog mode to clear the windows of fog or moisture and warm the passengers Use the defrost mode to remove fog or frost from the windshield more quickly Turn the right knob to select the defog or defrost mode 5 Defog This mode directs air to the windshield and the floor outlets When you select this mode the system turns off recirculation and runs the air conditioning compressor unless the outside temperature
158. ays on it means that something may be wrong with the airbag system If this ever happens have the vehicle serviced promptly because an adult size person sitting in the right front passenger s seat may not have the protection of the frontal airbag See Airbag Readiness Light on page 3 41 for more on this including important safety information Aftermarket equipment such as seat covers can affect how well the passenger sensing system operates You may want to consider not using seat covers or other aftermarket equipment if your vehicle has the passenger sensing system See Adding Equipment to Your Airbag Equipped Vehicle on page 1 82 for more information about modifications that can affect how the system operates Stowing of articles under the passenger s seat or between the passenger s seat cushion and seatback may interfere with the proper operation of the passenger sensing system 1 81 Servicing Your Airbag Equipped Vehicle Airbags affect how your vehicle should be serviced There are parts of the airbag system in several places around your vehicle Your dealer and the service manual have information about servicing your vehicle and the airbag system To purchase a service manual see Service Publications Ordering Information on page 7 12 For up to 10 seconds after the ignition key is turned off and the battery is disconnected an airbag can still inflate during improper service You can be injured if you are
159. b or contact a major oil company that does business in the country where you will be driving Filling Your Tank Fuel vapor burns violently and a fuel fire can cause bad injuries To help avoid injuries to you and others read and follow all the instructions on the pump island Turn off your engine when you are refueling Do not smoke if you are near fuel or refueling your vehicle Keep sparks flames and smoking materials away from fuel Do not leave the fuel pump unattended when refueling your vehicle this is against the law in some places Keep children away from the fuel pump never let children pump fuel The tethered fuel cap is located behind a hinged fuel door on the driver s side of the vehicle To remove the fuel cap turn it slowly to the left counterclockwise The fuel cap has a spring in it if the cap is released too soon it will spring back to the right J While refueling hang the tethered fuel cap from the hook on the fuel door If you spill fuel and then something ignites it you could be badly burned Fuel can spray out on you if you open the fuel cap too quickly This spray can happen if your tank is nearly full and is more likely in hot weather Open the fuel cap slowly and wait for any hiss noise to stop Then unscrew the cap all the way Be careful not to spill fuel Do not top off or overfill the tank and wait a few seconds after you have finished pumping before removing the nozzle Clea
160. be programmed If you are ever driving and the SECURITY message comes on and stays on you will be able to restart your engine if you turn it off Your PASS Key III system however is not working properly and must be serviced by your dealer Your vehicle is not protected by the PASS Key III system at this time If you lose or damage a PASS Key III key see your dealer who can service PASS Key III to have a new key made Starting and Operating Your Vehicle New Vehicle Break In Notice Your vehicle does not need an elaborate break in But it will perform better in the long run if you follow these guidelines If you have all wheel drive keep your speed at 55 mph 88 km h or less for the first 500 miles 805 km Do not drive at any one speed fast or slow for the first 500 miles 805 km Do not make full throttle starts Avoid making hard stops for the first 200 miles 322 km or so During this time your new brake linings are not yet broken in Hard stops with new linings can mean premature wear and earlier replacement Follow this breaking in guideline every time you get new brake linings Do not tow a trailer during break in See Towing a Trailer on page 4 38 for more information Ignition Positions With the key in the ignition you can turn it to four different positions A OFF This is the only position in which you can remove the key This position locks the ignition and transaxle
161. ble channel The system is working properly No Info Category Name not No category information is available at this time on this available channel The system is working properly No Info No Text Informational No text or informational messages are available at this time message available on this channel The system is working properly Not Found No channel available for There are no channels available for the selected category the chosen category The system is working properly XM Locked Theft lock active The XM receiver in your vehicle may have previously been in another vehicle For security purposes XM receivers cannot be swapped between vehicles If this message is received after having your vehicle serviced check with the servicing facility Radio ID Radio ID label If tuned to channel 0 this message will alternate with the channel 0 XM Radio 8 digit radio ID label This label is needed to activate the service Unknown Radio ID not known If this message is received when tuned to channel 0 there should only be if may be a receiver fault Consult with your dealer hardware failure Chk XMRevr Hardware failure If this message does not clear within a short period of time the receiver may have a fault Consult with your dealer 3 84 Playing a CD Insert a CD partway into the slot label side up The player will pull it in and the CD should begin playing If you want to insert a CD while the ignition or the radio is off first
162. bled an indicator light will glow on the switch You will not see any lights on the rear display if the switch is in the off position OFF How the System Works Unless disabled the URPA will turn on automatically when the shift lever is moved into REVERSE R When the system turns on the three lights on the display will illuminate for one and a half seconds to let you know that the system is working If your vehicle is moving in REVERSE R at a speed greater than 3 mph 5 km h the red light will flash to remind you that the system does not work at speed greater than 3 mph 5 km h If an object is detected at a REVERSE R speed of less than 3 mph 5 km h one of the following will occur C Descon Eraish Mere amber amber red lights amp amber amber red lights flashing amp continuous chime A chime will sound the first time an object is detected between 20 inches 0 5 m and 5 feet 1 5 m away URPA cannot detect objects that are above liftgate level In order for the rear sensors to recognize an object it must be within detection range behind the vehicle 3 25 When the System Does Not Seem to Work Properly The light may flash red when the vehicle is in REVERSE R if the ultrasonic sensors are not kept clean So be sure to keep your rear bumper free of mud dirt snow ice and slush Other conditions that may affect system performance include things like the vibrations from a jackhammer or the c
163. bout 1 to 3 inches 3 to 8 cm away from the HomeLink buttons while keeping the indicator light in view 3 Simultaneously press and hold both the desired button on HomeLink and the hand held transmitter button Do not release the buttons until Step 4 has been completed Some entry gates and garage door openers may require you to substitute Step 3 with the procedure noted in Gate Operator and Canadian Programming later in this section 4 The indicator light will flash slowly at first and then rapidly after HomeLink successfully receives the frequency signal from the hand held transmitter Release both buttons 2 36 5 Press and hold the newly trained HomeLink button and observe the indicator light If the indicator light stays on constantly programming is complete and your device should activate when the HomeLink button is pressed and released To program the remaining two HomeLink buttons begin with Step 2 under Programming HomeLink Do not repeat Step 1 as this will erase all of the programmed channels If the indicator light blinks rapidly for two seconds and then turns to a constant light continue with Steps 6 through 8 following to complete the programming of a rolling code equipped device most commonly a garage door opener Locate in the garage the garage door opener receiver motor head unit Locate the Learn or Smart button This can usually be found where the hang
164. button to play the passage The elapsed time of the track will appear on the display FWD gt Forward Press and hold this button to advance quickly within a track You will hear sound at a reduced volume Release this button to play the passage The elapsed time of the track will appear on the display 3 111 RPT Repeat With repeat one track or an entire CD can be repeated To use repeat do the following To repeat the track you are listening to press and release the RPT button RPT will appear on the display Press RPT again to turn off repeat play To repeat the CD you are listening to press and hold the RPT button for two seconds RPT will appear on the display Press RPT again to turn off repeat play RDM Random With random you can listen to the tracks in random rather than sequential order on one CD or on all of the CDs To use random do one of the following To play the tracks on the CD you are listening to in random order press and release the RDM button RANDOM ONE will appear on the display Press RDM again to turn off random play To play the tracks on all of the CDs that are loaded in random order press and hold RDM for more than two seconds You will hear a beep and RANDOM ALL will appear on the display Press RDM again to turn off random play 3 112 AUTO EQ Automatic Equalization Press AUTO EQ to select the desired equalization setting while playing a CD The equalization wi
165. carrier crossrails Some vehicles may not have the crossrails Notice Damage may be caused to the roof of your vehicle if anything is placed directly on the roof Notice Loading cargo on the luggage carrier that weighs more than 220 Ibs 100 kg or hangs over the rear or sides of the vehicle may damage your vehicle Load cargo so that it rests on the slats as far forward as possible and against the side rails making sure to fasten it securely When you carry cargo on the luggage carrier of a proper size and weight put it on the slats and distribute the weight evenly Then slide the crossrail if equipped up against the rear of the load to keep it from moving You can then tie it down Cargo containers must be loaded on the crossrails only 2 41 Don t exceed the maximum vehicle capacity when loading your vehicle For more information on vehicle capacity and loading see Loading Your Vehicle on page 4 31 To prevent damage or loss of cargo as you re driving check now and then to make sure the luggage carrier and cargo are still securely fastened Loading things onto the luggage carrier can interfere with the performance of your XM Satellite Radio System if equipped To adjust the crossrail s the sunroof stop A if equipped must be removed To remove the sunroof stop do the following 1 Find the tool B located in a bag in the glove box labeled TOOL KIT ACSRY 2 Use the tool to remove the screw locate
166. cckistecetelisediei caedesesdieerenty 2 47 Ventilation Adjustment ceeeeeeeeee neces eee eee es 3 36 VIS OS in ns Er u O Ea E beboes 2 15 W Warning Lights Gages and Indicators 3 37 Warnings Hazard Warning Flashers scence 3 6 Other Warning Devices eeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeees 3 6 Safety and Symbols en niise inini iii Vehicle Damage ceeeeeeeeeeeeereeeeeeeeeees iv Washer Fluid Low Warning Message 3 58 Wheels Alignment and Tire Balance ce 5 68 Replacement js a ciesdcastanscetacsad ian iniia 5 68 Where to Put the Restraint eee eee 1 52 WINDOWS cciicsie siir ani a St anaes dereeseavadaes 2 13 16 Windows cont POW SEE scaneientsieaed S 2 14 Windshield Backglass and Wiper Blades Cleaning 5 99 Windshield Washer 0 eceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeees 3 9 Fluid Ree SE ES ERE ERE ascent 5 37 Windshield Wiper Blade Replacement eeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeees 5 53 FUSES Cetere aen esd en eels ES ERN 5 104 Windshield Wipers eeeeeeeeeeeeeeee renee 3 9 Winter DOMINO icici ccecticencedesgidacescse aeina 4 26 X XM Satellite Radio Antenna System 3 135 Y Your Driving the Road and Your Vehicle 4 2 Your Vehicle and the Environment 055 6 2
167. cle 7 Push and pull on the rear storage system to make Place the mounting brackets onto the forward sure that it is locked into place properly mounting bolts on the floor of the vehicle 4 Put the nuts back onto the mounting bolts and tighten 2 45 Removing the Rear Convenience Reinstalling the Rear Convenience Center on Vehicles with the Third Row Center on Vehicles with the Third Row Stowable Seat Stowable Seat 1 Make sure that all items have been removed from 1 Make sure that all items have been removed from the top and the inside of the rear convenience the rear of the vehicle center 2 Lift the handle s on the top of the lid to open the storage bin 3 Remove the two nuts from inside the storage bin The nuts are located in the bottom of the bin If you are only removing the convenience center and not the stowable seat you must replace these nuts once the bin is removed to secure the seat 4 Lift the storage bin and remove it from the rear of the vehicle 2 Lift the bin into the back of the vehicle Align the bin over the rear mounting bolts 3 Put the nuts back onto the mounting bolts and tighten 4 Push and pull on the rear storage system to make sure that it is locked into place properly 2 46 Sunroof If the vehicle has a sunroof the switch to operate it is located on the headliner between the sun visors oe The sunroof switch will only work when the ignition is ON or when the ig
168. cle and check with your dealer 1 79 The passenger sensing system is designed to enable may inflate the right front passenger s frontal airbag anytime the system senses that a person of adult size is sitting properly in the right front passenger s seat When the passenger sensing system has allowed the airbag to be enabled the on indicator will light and stay lit to remind you that the airbag is active For some children who have outgrown child restraints and for very small adults the passenger sensing system may or may not turn off the right front passenger s frontal airbag depending upon the person s seating posture and body build Everyone in your vehicle who has outgrown child restraints should wear a safety belt properly whether or not there is an airbag for that person If a person of adult size is sitting in the right front passenger s seat but the off indicator is lit it could be because that person is not sitting properly in the seat If this happens turn the vehicle off and ask the person to place the seatback in the fully upright position then sit upright in the seat centered on the seat cushion with the person s legs comfortably extended Restart the vehicle and have the person remain in this position for about two minutes This will allow the system to detect that person and then enable the passenger s airbag 1 80 If the airbag readiness light in the instrument panel cluster ever comes on and st
169. cle using your key instead of your transmitter the DIC will not change drivers and your vehicle will recall the information from the last transmitter used If your vehicle does not have a DIC you do not have available the vehicle customization features using the remote keyless entry transmitter 3 66 Entering Programming Mode To program features your vehicle must be in the programming mode Do the following 1 Turn the ignition key to ON with the vehicle in PARK P 2 Press and release the MODE button scrolling through the DIC messages until PERSONALIZATION PRESS SET TO BEGIN is displayed 3 Press the SET button and TO SELECT DRIVER PRESS REMOTE LOCK will appear Press the LOCK button on the remote keyless entry transmitter This identifies which remote keyless entry transmitter is being programmed by displaying PERSONALIZATION FOR DRIVER 1 or DRIVER 2 PROGRAM MODE United States Canada 4 The program mode message will appear in the message center as an indication that your vehicle is ready to begin programming 5 Follow the instructions given by the DIC Headlamp Exit Delay This feature allows you to customize the headlamps and parking lamps This feature can be programmed to one of the following modes OFF The headlamps and parking lamps will not turn on at the same instant that the ignition is turned to OFF 15 The headlamps and parking lamps will stay on for 15 seconds when the ignition is turne
170. close to an airbag when it inflates Avoid yellow connectors They are probably part of the airbag system Be sure to follow proper service procedures and make sure the person performing work for you is qualified to do so The airbag system does not need regular maintenance 1 82 Adding Equipment to Your Airbag Equipped Vehicle Q Because have a disability have to get my vehicle modified How can find out whether this will affect my advanced airbag system A Changing or moving any parts of the front seats safety belts the airbag sensing and diagnostic module located under the drivers seat or the inside rearview mirror can affect the operation of the advanced airbag system If you have questions call Customer Assistance The phone numbers and addresses for Customer Assistance are in Step Two of the Customer Satisfaction Procedure in this manual See Customer Satisfaction Procedure on page 7 2 Restraint System Check Checking Your Restraint Systems Now and then make sure the safety belt reminder light and all your belts buckles latch plates retractors and anchorages are working properly Look for any other loose or damaged safety belt system parts If you see anything that might keep a safety belt system from doing its job have it repaired Torn or frayed safety belts may not protect you in a crash They can rip apart under impact forces If a belt is torn or frayed get a new one right away Also loo
171. cluster in between the tachometer and speedometer It gives you important safety and maintenance facts Passenger Seatbelt Reminder Message This message will come on and a chime will sound when the ignition is in run and the driver s seatbelt is buckled and the passenger s seatbelt is not and the passenger airbag is enabled with a passenger detected by the passenger sensing system If your vehicle is equipped with the passenger sensing system this message reminds the passenger to buckle their seatbelt Service Traction System Warning Message SERVICE TRACTION TC Canada SYSTEM United States If your vehicle has the traction control system and this message is displayed when you re driving there may be a problem with your traction control system Your vehicle may need service When this message is displayed the traction control system will not limit wheel spin Adjust your driving accordingly If there s an engine related and brake system problem that is specifically related to traction control the traction control system will turn off and the warning message will come on If the traction control system warning message comes on and stays on for an extended period of time when the system is turned on your vehicle needs service 3 51 Traction Active Message TC Canada TRACTION ACTIVE United States If your vehicle has the traction control system the TRACTION ACTIVE message will ap
172. come on The air conditioning compressor also comes on The recirculation mode can be used with vent and bi level modes but it cannot be used with floor defog defrost or outside air modes Temperature Control Use the DRIVER knob to increase or decrease the air temperature inside your vehicle If the front passenger would like the temperature to be warmer or cooler use the PASS knob to adjust the passenger s temperature Air Conditioning The air conditioning compressor will automatically come on when a temperature cooler than the interior temperature is chosen using the temperature knobs You may notice a slight change in engine performance when the air conditioning compressor shuts off and turns on again This is normal The system is designed to make adjustments to help with fuel economy while still maintaining the selected temperature On hot days open the windows to let hot inside air escape then close them This helps to reduce the time it takes for your vehicle to cool down It also helps the system to operate more efficiently The air conditioning system removes moisture from the air so you may sometimes notice a small amount of water dripping underneath your vehicle while idling or after turning off the engine This is normal Defogging and Defrosting Fog on the inside of windows is a result of high humidity or moisture condensing on the cool window glass This can be minimized if the climate controls system i
173. commended Fluids and Lubricants 6 12 Recreational Vehicle Towing eeeeeeeeeeee 4 36 Reduced Engine Power Message 0600 3 53 Remote Keyless Entry System c eeeeeee ees 2 5 Remote Keyless Entry System Operation 2 6 Remote Keyless Entry Transmitter Battery Low Warning Message sceeeeeneeeeeee eee es 3 60 Removing the Flat Tire and Installing the Spare Tirene ea a ia 5 80 Removing the Spare Tire and Tools 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 5 74 Replacement Bulbs eceseseneeeeeeeeeeeees 5 53 Reporting Safety Defects Canadian Government eeeeeeeeneeeeeeeees 7 12 General Motors 0 ccecceeeececeeeeeeteeeeeaeees 7 12 United States Government ceeeeeeeeee ees 7 11 Restraint System Check Checking Your Restraint Systems 60 5 1 83 12 Restraint System Check cont Replacing Restraint System Parts After ANG Fassa A E 1 83 Restraint Systems Checking 2237 b ERNA Eee En hes elser 1 83 Replacing Parts 2 c ccececececceeete sentence cua 1 83 Retained Accessory Power RAP ccecce 2 21 Right Front Passenger Position Safety Belts 1 34 Roadside Assistance Program iocis rssisn anasu sannari tis 7 6 Rocking Your Vehicle to Get it Out 4 31 Roof Rack System ssis carens inns innesa 2 40 Running Your Engine While You Are Parked 2 30 Safety Belt P
174. confirmation and your vehicle is equipped with the Driver Information Center DIC see DIC Vehicle Personalization on page 3 66 LOCK To lock all doors press LOCK The LOCK button on the remote keyless entry transmitter will arm the content theft deterrent system See Content Theft Deterrent on page 2 15 for more information If you would like to program the way the headlamps parking lamps horn and radio operate with remote lock confirmation and your vehicle is equipped with the Driver Information Center DIC see DIC Vehicle Personalization on page 3 66 REAR To unlock the liftgate press REAR See Liftgate on page 2 17 for more information 2 Remote Alarm Press the button with the horn symbol to make the headlamps and parking lamps flash and the horn sound This will allow you to attract attention if needed Press the button with the horn symbol again to stop the alarm from sounding or the alarm will turn off after 90 seconds Matching Transmitter s to Your Vehicle Each remote keyless entry transmitter is coded to prevent another transmitter from unlocking your vehicle If a transmitter is lost or stolen a replacement can be purchased through your dealer Remember to bring any remaining transmitters with you when you go to your dealer When the dealer matches the replacement transmitter to your vehicle any remaining transmitters must also be matched Once your dealer has coded the new transmitter the lost tran
175. ct the quality of the air we breathe Improper fluid levels or the wrong tire inflation can increase the level of emissions from your vehicle To help protect our environment and to keep your vehicle in good condition be sure to maintain your vehicle properly Using Your Maintenance Schedule We at General Motors want to help you keep your vehicle in good working condition But we do not know exactly how you will drive it You may drive very short distances only a few times a week Or you may drive long distances all the time in very hot dusty weather You may use your vehicle in making deliveries Or you may drive it to work to do errands or in many other ways Because of all the different ways people use their vehicles maintenance needs vary You may need more frequent checks and replacements So please read the following and note how you drive If you have any questions on how to keep your vehicle in good condition see your GM Goodwrench dealer This schedule is for vehicles that e carry passengers and cargo within recommended limits You will find these limits on the tire and loading information label See Loading Your Vehicle on page 4 31 are driven on reasonable road surfaces within legal driving limits use the recommended fuel See Gasoline Octane on page 5 5 The services in Scheduled Maintenance on page 6 4 should be performed when indicated See Additional Required Services on page 6 6 and Maintenance Footnot
176. d Windshield Washer PUSH To wash your windshield press and hold the paddle with the windshield washer symbol The washers and wipers will operate When you release the paddle the washers will stop and the wipers will continue to operate for two cycles unless your wipers were already on In that case the wipers will resume the wiper speed you selected earlier In freezing weather do not use your washer until the windshield is warmed Otherwise the washer fluid can form ice on the windshield blocking your vision Rear Window Washer Wiper The rear window washer wiper switch is located in the instrument panel switchbank See Instrument Panel Rear Intermittent Wiper Press the wiper symbol on the top of the switch to turn on the intermittent wiper To turn off the wiper gently press the bottom of the switch Switchbank on page 3 20 OD Rear Wiper Washer To wash and wipe the rear window press the washer symbol on the bottom of the switch Washer fluid will spray as long as the switch is held in When the switch is released the wiper will continue to cycle three more times There is only one washer fluid reservoir for the front and rear windshield wipers See Windshield Washer Fluid on page 5 37 To wash the rear window while the rear wiper is already on press the bottom of the switch Press the top of the switch to continue the intermittent wiper cycle after the washing cycle is completed
177. d Services The following services should be performed at the first maintenance service I or II after the indicated miles kilometers shown for each item Additional Required Services 25 000 50 000 75 000 100 000 125 000 150 000 Service and Miles Kilometers 41 500 83 000 ge 000 a 000 on 500 a 000 Inspect fuel system for damage or leaks 0 e e Inspect exhaust system for loose or damaged components Replace engine air cleaner filter See Engine Air Cleaner Filter on page 5 21 An Emission Control Service Change automatic transaxle fluid and filter severe service See footnote h Change automatic o fluid and filter normal service Replace spark plugs and inspect spark plug wires An Emission Control Service Engine cooling system service or every 5 years whichever occurs first An Emission Control Service See footnote i Inspect engine accessory drive belt An Emission Control Service Maintenance Footnotes t The U S Environmental Protection Agency or the California Air Resources Board has determined that the failure to perform this maintenance item will not nullify the emission warranty or limit recall liability prior to the completion of the vehicle s useful life We however urge that all recommended maintenance services be performed at the indicated intervals and the maintenance be recorded a Visually inspect brake lines and hoses for proper hook up binding leaks cracks
178. d child restraint in the second row center bench seat and need to temporarily transport a flat tire for repair move the child restraint to a rear seat outboard position See Securing a Child Restraint in a Rear Outside Seat Position on page 1 60 for more on this including important safety information Once you have the top strap anchored you will be ready to secure the child restraint itself Tighten the top strap when and as the child restraint manufacturer s instructions say 1 54 Top Strap Anchor Location Captain s Chairs Your vehicle has top strap anchors already installed for the rear seating positions An anchor bar for a top strap is located at the rear of the seat cushion for each second row outboard seating position The anchor bar for the center position bench seat is located on the floor behind the second row seats If the vehicle has the extended rear convenience center you need to remove a plastic plug and look under the convenience center to find the anchor bar for the center position bench seat Do not secure a child restraint with a top strap in the right front passenger s position if a national or local law requires that the top strap be anchored or if the instructions that come with the child restraint say that the top strap must be anchored There is no place to anchor the top strap in this position 1 56 Second Row Center Position Bench Seat with Third Row Seat If the veh
179. d for a long period of time remove the batteries and keep them in a cool dry place Tips and Troubleshooting Chart No power The ignition may not be in ACCESSORY ON START or RAP The parental control button might have been pressed The power indicator light will flash Disc will not play The system might be off The parental control button might have been pressed The power indicator light will flash The system might be in auxiliary source mode Press the SRCE button to switch between the DVD player and the auxiliary source The disc is upside down or is not compatible 3 125 No sound The picture is distorted during fast forward or reverse The picture does not fill the screen There are black borders on the top and bottom or on both sides or it looks stretched out 3 126 The volume on the headphones could be too low Adjust the volume on the right earpiece on the wireless headphones lf the DVD system is being heard through the vehicle speakers adjust the volume from the radio The radio must have the RSE enabled by using the CD CD TAPE or CD AUX button This is normal for this operation Quickly press and release the display control button on the remote control or the DVD player and choose Display Mode Then select Full This will fillthe screen If there are borders on the top and bottom the movie may have been made that way for a standard screen ejected the disc and tried
180. d in the side rail assembly in front of the front crossrail 3 Repeat for the other side 4 Put the tool and the screws back in the plastic bag Your luggage carrier has release levers within the end in the glove box of each crossrail support 2 42 To adjust the crossrails lift the release levers on each side to unlock them Slide the crossrails forward or backward as needed to accommodate loads of various sizes After repositioning the crossrails push the release lever down This will lock the crossrails in place Notice Opening the sunroof when the luggage rack crossrails are not in the full rear position could cause damage to the sunroof or luggage rack Verify the luggage rack crossrails are in the full rear position before opening the sunroof When you are done using the crossrails you Must replace the sunroof stop To replace the sunroof stop do the following 1 Put the crossrails in the full rear position 2 Using the tool put the screws back into each side rail assembly Make sure the screws are in the first hole in front of the crossrail Convenience Net Your vehicle may have a convenience net The convenience net is designed to help keep small loads like grocery bags from falling over Install the convenience net at the rear of your vehicle just inside the liftgate tailgate opening Attach both the upper and lower hooks to the loops on either side of the liftgate opening The label on the
181. d not be covered by your warranty Always use DEX COOL silicate free coolant in your vehicle How to Add Coolant to the Coolant Recovery Tank If you have not found a problem yet but the coolant level is not at or above the full cold mark add a 50 50 mixture of clean drinkable water and DEX COOL engine coolant at the coolant recovery tank See Engine Coolant on page 5 25 for more information 5 32 Adding only plain water to your cooling system can be dangerous Plain water or some other liquid such as alcohol can boil before the proper coolant mixture will Your vehicle s coolant warning system is set for the proper coolant mixture With plain water or the wrong mixture your engine could get too hot but you would not get the overheat warning Your engine could catch fire and you or others could be burned Use a 50 50 mixture of clean drinkable water and DEX COOL coolant Notice In cold weather water can freeze and crack the engine radiator heater core and other parts Use the recommended coolant and the proper coolant mixture You can be burned if you spill coolant on hot Steam and scalding liquids from a hot cooling system can blow out and burn you badly They are under pressure and if you turn the radiator engine parts Coolant contains ethylene glycol and it will burn if the engine parts are hot enough Do not spill coolant on a hot engine pressure cap even a little they can come out at
182. d paper labels to CDs they could get caught in the CD player If an error appears on the display see CD Messages later in this section 3 110 LOAD CD Press the LOAD side of this button to load CDs into the CD player This CD player will hold up to six CDs To insert one CD do the following 1 Turn the ignition on 2 Press and release the LOAD button 3 Wait for the light located to the right of the slot to turn green 4 Load a CD Insert the CD partway into the slot label side up The player will pull the CD in To insert multiple CDs do the following 1 Turn the ignition on 2 Press and hold the LOAD button for two seconds You will hear a beep and the light located to the right of the slot will begin to flash 3 Once the light stops flashing and turns green load a CD Insert the CD partway into the slot label side up The player will pull the CD in 4 Once the CD is loaded the light will begin flashing again Press the LOAD button again Once the light turns green load the next disc Repeat this procedure for each CD The CD player takes up to six CDs Do not try to load more than six To load more than one CD but less than six complete Steps 1 through 3 When finished loading CDs the radio will begin to play the last CD loaded lf more than one CD has been loaded a number for each CD will be displayed Playing a Specific Loaded CD For every CD loaded a number will appear on the d
183. d since then To determine the current mode or to change the mode do the following 1 Follow the instructions for Entering Programming Mode listed previously 2 Press the MODE button until INTERIOR LIGHTING ON appears on the DIC 3 Press the SET button until the arrow is before KEY OUT or DOOR The mode you selected is now set You can either exit programming mode by following the instructions later in this section or program the next feature available on your vehicle Auto Door Lock Unlock The doors will automatically lock when the vehicle is shifted out of PARK P For automatic unlocking you can program your vehicle to one of the following modes OFF When the shift lever is put in PARK P your doors will not unlock automatically DRIVER When the shift lever is put in PARK P only your driver s door will unlock ALL When the shift lever is put in PARK P all doors will unlock Your vehicle was originally programmed to ALL The mode may have been changed since then To determine the current mode or to change the mode do the following 1 Follow the instructions for Entering Programming Mode listed previously 2 Make sure that the AUTO DOOR LOCK feature is programmed to ON 3 Press the MODE button until AUTO DOOR UNLOCK appears on the DIC 4 Press the SET button until the arrow is before OFF DRIVER or ALL 3 69 If the auto door unlock feature has been programmed to DRIVER or ALL
184. d to OFF 30 The headlamps and parking lamps will stay on for 30 seconds when the ignition is turned to OFF 60 The headlamps and parking lamps will stay on for 60 seconds when the ignition is turned to OFF Your vehicle was originally programmed to 30 second mode The mode may have been changed since then To determine the current mode or to change the mode do the following 1 Follow the instructions for Entering Programming Mode listed previously 2 Press the MODE button until HEADLMP EXIT DELAY appears in the DIC 3 Press the SET button until the arrow is before the mode you prefer The mode you selected is now set You can either exit programming mode by following the instructions later in this section or program the next feature available on your vehicle 3 67 Interior Lighting Delay The interior lighting delay feature can be programmed to one of the following modes OFF This feature will not illuminate the interior of your vehicle when all of the doors are closed ON This feature will continue to illuminate the interior lamps for 25 seconds after all doors have been closed so that you can find your ignition and buckle your safety belt at night Interior lighting delay will not occur while the ignition is in ON After 25 seconds the interior lamps will fade out The lamps will fade out before the 25 seconds if one of the following occurs The ignition is turned to ON All doors are lock
185. d with the flow Try to merge into the gap at close to the prevailing speed Switch on your turn signal check your mirrors and glance over your shoulder as often as necessary Try to blend smoothly with the traffic flow Once you are on the freeway adjust your speed to the posted limit or to the prevailing rate if it is slower Stay in the right lane unless you want to pass Before changing lanes check your mirrors Then use your turn signal Just before you leave the lane glance quickly over your shoulder to make sure there is not another vehicle in your blind spot Once you are moving on the freeway make certain you allow a reasonable following distance Expect to move slightly slower at night When you want to leave the freeway move to the proper lane well in advance If you miss your exit do not under any circumstances stop and back up Drive on to the next exit The exit ramp can be curved sometimes quite sharply The exit speed is usually posted Reduce your speed according to your speedometer not to your sense of motion After driving for any distance at higher speeds you may tend to think you are going slower than you actually are Before Leaving on a Long Trip Make sure you are ready Try to be well rested If you must start when you are not fresh such as after a day s work do not plan to make too many miles that first part of the journey Wear comfortable clothing and shoes you can easily drive
186. d you would be less likely to slide under the lap belt If you slid under it the belt would apply force at your abdomen This could cause serious or even fatal injuries The shoulder belt should go over the shoulder and across the chest These parts of the body are best able to take belt restraining forces 1 36 The safety belt locks if there is a sudden stop or a crash or if you pull the belt very quickly out of the retractor You can be seriously hurt if your shoulder belt is too loose In a crash you would move forward too much which could increase injury The shoulder belt should fit against your body To unlatch the belt just push the button on the buckle 1 37 Center Rear Passenger Position Lap Shoulder Belt If your vehicle has a bench seat someone can sit in the center position When you sit in the center seating position you have a lap safety belt which has no retractor You also have a shoulder belt which has a retractor In order to have the protection of the shoulder belt you must first connect it to the lap belt 1 38 1 Remove the shoulder belt from its stowage location in the roof and pull it all the way down to the lap belt 2 Insert the metal knob on the shoulder belt into the 3 To make the lap belt longer tilt the latch plate and keyhole on the lap belt buckle as shown Be sure to pull it along the belt slide the shoulder belt part into the keyhole until it locks into place
187. da to 1 cup 250 ml of lukewarm water affect the color of the fabric Let dry 2 For liquids blot with a clean soft white cloth For solids remove as much as possible and then vacuum or brush 5 96 Stains caused by oil and grease can be cleaned with an approved GM cleaner and a clean white cloth 1 Carefully scrape off excess stain 2 Clean with cool water and allow to dry completely 3 If a stain remains follow the Using Cleaner on Fabric instructions described earlier Vinyl Use warm water and a clean cloth Rub with a clean damp cloth to remove dirt This may have to be done more than once Things like tar asphalt and shoe polish will stain if they are not removed quickly Use a clean cloth and vinyl cleaner See your dealer for this product Leather Use a soft cloth with lukewarm water and a mild soap or saddle soap and wipe dry with a soft cloth Then let the leather dry naturally Do not use heat to dry For stubborn stains use a leather cleaner Never use oils varnishes solvent based or abrasive cleaners furniture polish or shoe polish on leather Soiled or stained leather should be cleaned immediately If dirt is allowed to work into the finish it can harm the leather Instrument Panel Use only mild soap and water to clean the top surfaces of the instrument panel Sprays containing silicones or waxes may cause annoying reflections in the windshield and even make it diff
188. dio The audio system is acquiring and processing audio and after 4 second delay text data No action is needed This message should disappear shortly CH Off Air Channel not in service This channel is not currently in service Tune to another channel CH Unavail Channel no longer This previously assigned channel is no longer assigned available Tune to another station If this station was one of the presets choose another station for that preset button No Info Artist Name Feature not No artist information is available at this time on this available channel The system is working properly 3 108 XM Radio Messages cont d Radio Display us Condition Action Required No Info Song Program Title not No song title information is available at this time on this available channel The system is working properly No Info Category Name not No category information is available at this time on this available channel The system is working properly No Info No Text Informational No text or informational messages are available at this message available time on this channel The system is working properly Not Found No channel available for There are no channels available for the selected category the chosen category The system is working properly XM Locked Theft lock active The XM receiver in the vehicle may have previously been in another vehicle For security purposes XM receivers cannot be swapped between vehicles If this messa
189. e 4 To turn the image off turn the dimmer knob counterclockwise until it stops If the sun comes out or it becomes cloudy you may need to adjust the HUD brightness again using the dimmer knob Polarized sunglasses could make the HUD image harder to see When you first start the vehicle the display will show BUICK and the Buick logo for a few seconds If it is cold outside this display may stay on for up to a minute Clean the inside of the windshield as needed to remove any dirt or film that reduces the sharpness or clarity of the HUD image To clean the HUD spray household glass cleaner on a soft clean cloth Wipe the HUD lens gently then dry it Do not spray cleaner directly on the lens because the cleaner could leak into the unit If the ignition is on and you cannot see the HUD image check to see if one of the following conditions exist The HUD unit is covered The HUD dimmer knob is adjusted incorrectly The HUD image is not adjusted to the proper height Ambient light in the direction your vehicle is facing is low A fuse is blown See Fuses and Circuit Breakers on page 5 105 If you ever have to have your windshield replaced be sure to get one that is designed for the HUD or your HUD image may look blurred and out of focus 3 23 Ultrasonic Rear Parking Assist URPA The Ultrasonic Rear Parking Assist URPA system is designed to help you park while the vehicle is in REVERSE R It operates
190. e alarm A door unlocked manually will remain unlocked until locked again Disarming with Your Key Your alarm system will disarm when you use your key to unlock the driver s door The security light will stop flashing to let you know the system is no longer armed Disarming with the Remote Keyless Entry Transmitter Your alarm system will disarm when you press UNLOCK on your remote keyless entry transmitter to unlock the doors The security light on top of the instrument panel will stop flashing to let you know the system is no longer armed PASS Key III Your PASS Key III system operates on a radio frequency subject to Federal Communications Commission FCC Rules and with Industry Canada This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules Operation is subject to the following two conditions 1 This device may not cause harmful interference 2 This device must accept any interference received including interference that may cause undesired operation This device complies with RSS 210 of Industry Canada Operation is subject to the following two conditions 1 This device may not cause interference 2 This device must accept any interference received including interference that may cause undesired operation of the device Changes or modifications to this system by other than an authorized service facility could void authorization to use this equipment PASS Key III uses a radio frequency transponder in
191. e Fuel Container 1 1 1 1 1 1 5 10 Taillamps Turn Signal and Stoplamps 5 51 Checking Things Under the Hood 5 10 Taillamps and Back Up Lamps 5 52 Hood Release sg and ai beer osse ne 5 114 Replacement Bulbs seseeeceeeeeeeeeeeees 5 53 Engine Compartment Overview ceeeeee ees 5 12 Windshield Wiper Blade Replacement 5 53 Engine Qil aar eaae a 5 16 Ti 5 55 Engine Oil Life System essere 5 19 si icine a Engine Air Cleaner Filter sneen 5 21 de T ewa ane aoa REE aged 5 58 Automatic Transaxle Fluid W Wu u s dsseeereerereree 5 22 Te oN OY Ane Sen NI ss s aise i Inflation Tire Pressure incinn 5 61 Engine Coolant 0 cceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeen eee ees 5 25 Check Tire P Syst 5 62 Radiator Pressure Cap ccccssccccceesneeee 5 28 OCE IE TESSUT SYSTE green egner i i Tire Inspection and Rotation i e 5 64 Engine Overheating eeeeeeeeeeneeeeee teens 5 28 When It Is Time for New Ti 5 65 Overheated Engine Protection en t Is ime for New Tires neeese X Buying NeW Tires es ones Roe ye 5 66 Operating Mode cceeeeeeeeeeeeeee een eenes 5 30 i i Uniform Tire Quality Grading eeeeeeeee 5 67 Cooling System onanere NEEDS 5 30 Power Steering Fluid ceeeeeeeee teeter eee e ees 5 36 Wheel Alignment and Tire Balance 5 68 Wheel Replacement
192. e MODE button until CALIBRATE COMPASS displays 2 Press and hold the SET button for longer than three seconds ZONE PRESS amp HOLD SET TO CHANGE This display mode will appear when you are manually calibrating the system When the compass is being recalibrated for the first time the zone symbol will be displayed When the compass is being recalibrated any time after that the current zone number for compass variance will be displayed in place of the zone symbol Use the SET button to select the zone number from the graphic shown to select the current area of the country that you are driving in PRESS SET TO CALIBRATE COMPASS After selecting your zone press the MODE button and this will be displayed on the DIC Press and hold the SET button and complete three 360 degree turns in an area free from large metal objects at a speed no faster than 5 mph 8 km h The following two messages will toggle in the display until you calibrate the compass DRIVE VEHICLE IN CIRCLE e CALIBRATING COMPASS When calibration is complete the vehicle direction will be displayed instead of the C symbol 3 63 DIC Controls and Displays When the ignition is turned to ON or START the DIC will display the following BUICK BUICK will be displayed for three seconds DRIVER This message will be displayed for another three seconds after BUICK appears in the display This display lets the driver know which driver s remote ke
193. e PTY and take you to the PTY s first station 4 To go to another station within that PTY and the PTY is displayed press either SEEK arrow once If the PTY is not displayed press either SEEK arrow twice to display the PTY and then to go to another station 5 Press P TYP to exit program type select mode If PTY times out and is no longer on the display go back to Step 1 If both PTY and TRAF are on the radio will search for stations with the selected PTY and traffic announcements SCAN Scan the stations within a PTY by performing the following 1 Press P TYP to activate program type select mode The PTY symbol will appear on the display 2 Turn the AUDIO knob to select a PTY 3 Once the desired PTY is displayed press and hold either SEEK arrow and the radio will begin scanning the stations in the PTY 4 Press either SEEK arrow to stop at a station lf both PTY and TRAF are on the radio will scan for stations with the selected PTY and traffic announcements BAND Alternate Frequency Alternate frequency allows the radio to switch to a stronger station with the same program type To turn alternate frequency on press and hold BAND for two seconds AF ON will appear on the display The radio may switch to stations with a stronger frequency To turn alternate frequency off press and hold BAND again for two seconds AF OFF will appear on the display The radio will not switch to other stations This function
194. e TRAC OFF light will come on to remind you that the system will not limit wheel spin Adjust your driving accordingly The traction control system automatically comes on whenever you start your vehicle To limit wheel spin especially in slippery road conditions you should always leave the system on But you can turn the traction control system off if you ever need to You should turn the system off if your vehicle ever gets stuck in sand mud or snow and rocking the vehicle is required See f You Are Stuck In Sand Mud Ice or Snow on page 4 30 To turn the system off press the TRAC OFF button located on the instrument panel switchbank lfthe system is limiting wheel spin when you press the button the message will go off but the system will not turn off until there is no longer a current need to limit wheel spin The TRAC OFF light will come on to remind you the system is off You can turn the system back on at any time by pressing the button again The traction control system warning message should go off All Wheel Drive AWD System If your vehicle has all wheel drive AWD the AWD system operates automatically without any action required by the driver If the front drive wheels begin to slip the rear wheels will automatically begin to drive the vehicle as required There may be a slight engagement noise during hard use but this is normal During heavy AWD applications the engine torque may be reduced to protect A
195. e a brake problem Your vehicle s hydraulic brake system is divided into two parts If one part isn t working the other part can still work and stop you For good braking though you need both parts working well If the warning light comes on there could be a brake problem Have your brake system inspected right away O P Canada BRAKE United States 3 44 This light should come on briefly when you turn the ignition key to ON If it doesn t come on then have it fixed so it will be ready to warn you if there s a problem If the light comes on while you are driving pull off the road and stop carefully You may notice that the pedal is harder to push Or the pedal may go closer to the floor It may take longer to stop If the light is still on have the vehicle towed for service See Anti Lock Brake System Warning Light on page 3 45 and Towing Your Vehicle on page 4 36 Your brake system may not be working properly if the brake system warning light is on Driving with the brake system warning light on can lead to an accident If the light is still on after you have pulled off the road and stopped carefully have the vehicle towed for service Anti Lock Brake System Warning Light ANTI LOCK Canada United States Your vehicle may have an anti lock brake system warning light If it does the light should come on for a few seconds when you turn the ignition key to ON If the anti lock brake system warn
196. e are located in different areas of the engine compartment See Engine Compartment Overview on page 5 12 for more information on location Engine Overheating You will find an engine coolant temperature gage on your vehicle s instrument panel See Engine Coolant Temperature Gage on page 3 46 You also have an engine coolant temperature warning message on your instrument panel See Engine Coolant Temperature Warning Message on page 3 52 If your vehicle is equipped with the 3 6L V6 engine you will have a reduced engine power message as well See Reduced Engine Power Message on page 3 53 5 28 If Steam Is Coming From Your Engine Steam from an overheated engine can burn you badly even if you just open the hood Stay away from the engine if you see or hear steam coming from it Just turn it off and get everyone away from the vehicle until it cools down Wait until there is no sign of steam or coolant before you open the hood If you keep driving when your engine is overheated the liquids in it can catch fire You or others could be badly burned Stop your engine if it overheats and get out of the vehicle until the engine is cool See Overheated Engine Protection Operating Mode on page 5 30 for information on driving to a safe place in an emergency Notice If your engine catches fire because you keep driving with no coolant your vehicle can be badly damaged The costly repairs would not be covered by your warranty See Ove
197. e being turned on reset the system If your vehicle does not have the optional Driver Information Center DIC do the following 1 Turn the ignition to ON with the engine off 2 Fully press and release the accelerator pedal slowly three times within five seconds 3 Turn the key to OFF If the CHANGE ENGINE OIL message comes back on when you start your vehicle the engine oil life system has not reset Repeat the procedure 5 20 If your vehicle has the optional DIC do the following 1 Turn the ignition to ON with the engine off 2 Press the MODE button until the DIC reads OIL LIFE LEFT HOLD SET TO RESET 3 Press and hold the SET button until 100 is displayed You will hear three chimes and the CHANGE ENGINE OIL message will go off 4 Turn the key to OFF If the CHANGE ENGINE OIL message comes back on when you start your vehicle the engine oil life system has not reset Repeat the procedure What to Do with Used Oil Used engine oil contains certain elements that may be unhealthy for your skin and could even cause cancer Do not let used oil stay on your skin for very long Clean your skin and nails with soap and water or a good hand cleaner Wash or properly dispose of clothing or rags containing used engine oil See the manufacturer s warnings about the use and disposal of oil products Used oil can be a threat to the environment If you change your own oil be sure to drain all the oil from the filter b
198. e has a feature to help prevent you from draining the battery in case you accidentally leave the interior or exterior lamps on If the interior lamps are left on while the ignition is in OFF they will automatically turn off after 10 minutes If the exterior lamps are left on while the ignition is in OFF with all doors and the liftgate closed they will automatically turn off after 10 minutes If your vehicle has less than 14 miles 24 km on the odometer the battery saver will turn off the lamps after only three minutes If the interior lamps are turned off as a result of the battery saver feature they may be turned back on by turning the interior lamp control to OFF and then back to ON The battery saver will not turn the interior lamps off automatically after doing this They will have to be turned off manually 3 20 Instrument Panel Switchbank There is an instrument panel switchbank located below the comfort controls It contains switches or blanks that will vary with the options that are on your vehicle The switches you may have are Rear Window Wiper Washer See Windshield Washer on page 3 9 Traction Disable See Traction Control System TCS on page 4 10 Park Aid Disable See Ultrasonic Rear Parking Assist URPA on page 3 24 Heated Seats See Heated Seats on page 1 5 Head Up Display HUD If the HUD image is too bright or too high in your field of view it may take you more time to see th
199. e heat build up and extend the life of your transaxle 4 44 Parking on Hills You really should not park your vehicle with a trailer attached on a hill If something goes wrong your rig could start to move People can be injured and both your vehicle and the trailer can be damaged But if you ever have to park your rig on a hill do the following 1 Apply your regular brakes but do not shift into PARK P yet Have someone place chocks under the trailer wheels When the wheel chocks are in place release the regular brakes until the chocks absorb the load Reapply the regular brakes Then apply your parking brake and then shift to PARK P Release the regular brakes When You Are Ready to Leave After Parking on a Hill 1 Apply your regular brakes and hold the pedal down while you Start your engine Shift into a gear Release the parking brake 2 Let up on the brake pedal 3 Drive slowly until the trailer is clear of the chocks 4 Stop and have someone pick up and store the chocks Maintenance When Trailer Towing Your vehicle will need service more often when you are pulling a trailer See the Maintenance Schedule for more on this Things that are especially important in trailer operation are automatic transaxle fluid engine oil belts cooling system and brake system Each of these is covered in this manual and the Index will help you find them quickly If you are trailering it is
200. e is broken Try a new tape CLEAN PLAYER If this message appears on the display the cassette tape player needs to be cleaned It will still play tapes but it should be cleaned as soon as possible to prevent damage to the tapes and player See Care of Your Cassette Tape Player on page 3 134 If the cassette tape is not playing correctly for any other reason try a known good cassette If any error occurs repeatedly or if an error cannot be corrected contact your GM dealer If the radio displays an error message write it down and provide it to your GM dealer when reporting the problem CD Adapter Kits It is possible to use a portable CD player with the cassette tape player after activating the bypass feature on the tape player To activate the bypass feature use the following steps 1 Turn the ignition on 2 Turn the radio off 3 Insert the adapter into the cassette slot 4 Press and hold the CD TAPE button until READY appears on the display The override feature will remain active until the eject button is pressed 3 97 Playing a CD Insert a CD partway into the slot label side up The player will pull it in and the CD should begin playing If you want to insert a CD when the ignition or the radio is off first press the eject or the DISP button If the ignition or radio is turned off with the CD in the player it will stay in the player When the ignition or radio is turned on the CD will start playing
201. e loose and even come off This could lead to an accident Be sure to use the correct wheel nuts If you have to replace them be sure to get new GM original equipment wheel nuts Stop somewhere as soon as you can and have the nuts tightened with a torque wrench to the proper torque specification See Capacities and Specifications on page 5 112 for wheel nut torque specification Notice Improperly tightened wheel nuts can lead to brake pulsation and rotor damage To avoid expensive brake repairs evenly tighten the wheel nuts in the proper sequence and to the proper torque specification See Capacities and Specifications on page 5 112 for the wheel nut torque specification 5 83 9 Tighten the wheel nuts firmly in a crisscross sequence as shown Notice Wheel covers will not fit on your compact spare If you try to put a wheel cover on the compact spare you could damage the cover or the spare 10 Do not try to put a wheel cover on the compact spare tire It will not fit Store the wheel cover securely in the rear of the vehicle until you have the flat tire repaired or replaced 5 84 Secondary Latch System Your vehicle has an underbody mounted tire hoist assembly equipped with a secondary latch system It is designed to stop the compact spare tire from suddenly falling off your vehicle if the cable holding the spare tire is damaged For the secondary latch to work the tire must be stowed with the valve stem point
202. e of the tape player The tape player should be cleaned regularly after every 50 hours of use The radio may display CLEAN PLAYER to indicate that the tape player has been used for 50 hours without resetting the tape clean timer If this message appears on the display the cassette tape player needs to be cleaned It will still play tapes but it should be cleaned as soon as possible to prevent damage to the tapes and player If there is a reduction in sound quality try a known good cassette to see if the tape or the tape player is at fault If this other cassette has no improvement in sound quality clean the tape player For best results use a scrubbing action non abrasive cleaning cassette with pads which scrub the tape head as the hubs of the cleaner cassette turn The recommended cleaning cassette is available through your dealer The cut tape detection feature of the cassette tape player may identify the cleaning cassette tape as a damaged tape in error If the cleaning cassette ejects insert the cassette at least three times to ensure thorough cleaning A non scrubbing action wet type cleaner which uses a cassette with a fabric belt to clean the tape head can be used This type of cleaning cassette will not eject on its own A non scrubbing action cleaner may not clean as thoroughly as the scrubbing type cleaner The use of a non scrubbing action dry type cleaning cassette is not recommended After the player is cleaned
203. e point harness has straps that come down over each of the infant s shoulders and buckle together at the crotch The five point harness system has two shoulder straps two hip straps and a crotch strap A shield may take the place of hip straps A T shaped shield has shoulder straps that are attached to a flat pad which rests low against the child s body A shelf or armrest type shield has straps that are attached to a wide shelf like shield that swings up or to the side When choosing a child restraint be sure the child restraint is designed to be used in a vehicle If it is it will have a label saying that it meets federal motor vehicle safety standards Then follow the instructions for the restraint You may find these instructions on the restraint itself or in a booklet or both These restraints use the belt system or the LATCH system in your vehicle but the child also has to be secured within the restraint to help reduce the chance of personal injury When securing an add on child restraint refer to the instructions that come with the restraint which may be on the restraint itself or in a booklet or both and to this manual The child restraint instructions are important so if they are not available obtain a replacement copy from the manufacturer 1 51 Where to Put the Restraint Accident statistics show that children are safer if they are restrained in the rear rather than the front seat General Motors recommends that ch
204. e that comes into contact with the road Treadwear Indicators Narrow bands sometimes called wear bars that show across the tread of a tire when only 1 16 inch 1 6 mm of tread remains See When It Is Time for New Tires on page 5 65 UTQGS Uniform Tire Quality Grading Standards A tire information system that provides consumers with ratings for a tire s traction temperature and treadwear Ratings are determined by tire manufacturers using government testing procedures The ratings are molded into the sidewall of the tire See Uniform Tire Quality Grading on page 5 67 Vehicle Capacity Weight The number of designated seating positions multiplied by 150 lbs 68 kg plus the rated cargo load See Loading Your Vehicle on page 4 31 Vehicle Maximum Load on the Tire Load on an individual tire due to curb weight accessory weight occupant weight and cargo weight Vehicle Placard A label permanently attached to a vehicle showing the vehicle s capacity weight and the original equipment tire size and recommended inflation pressure See Tire and Loading Information Label under Loading Your Vehicle on page 4 31 Inflation Tire Pressure Tires need the correct amount of air pressure to operate effectively Notice Do not let anyone tell you that under inflation or over inflation is all right It is not If your tires do not have enough air under inflation you can get the following Too much flexing Too
205. eLink Transmitter Read the instructions completely before attempting to program the HomeLink Transmitter Because of the steps involved it may be helpful to have another person available to assist you in programming the transmitter Keep the original transmitter for use in other vehicles as well as for future HomeLink programming It is also recommended that upon the sale of the vehicle the programmed HomeLink buttons should be erased for security purposes Refer to Erasing HomeLink Buttons or for assistance contact HomeLink on the internet at www homelink com or by calling 1 800 355 3515 Be sure that people and objects are clear of the garage door or gate operator you are programming When programming a garage door it is advised to park outside of the garage It is recommended that a new battery be installed in your hand held transmitter for quicker and more accurate transmission of the radio frequency 2 35 Programming HomeLink Your vehicle s engine should be turned off while programming the transmitter Follow these steps to program up to three channels 1 Press and hold down the two outside buttons releasing only when the indicator light begins to flash after 20 seconds Do not hold down the buttons for longer than 30 seconds and do not repeat this step to program a second and or third transmitter to the remaining two HomeLink buttons 2 Position the end of your hand held transmitter a
206. ecen reb aean aa 3 39 Split Bench Seats 2528 sees iinei 1 8 Starting Your Engine israelere neis 2 21 Seea MAR E er he LD bad ok geetnedacameys 4 12 Steering Wheel Controls Audio 3 133 Steering Wheel Tilt Wheel ceeeeeeee ee 3 6 Storage Areas Cell Phone Storage Area i e 2 39 Convenience Net eceececeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeees 2 43 CupMOldGr S aars nan e ani 2 39 Floor Console Storage Area W W sseseerereee 2 39 Front Armrest Storage Area sssseserene 2 40 Glove BOX eder alka 2 38 Overhead Console 252632 zur bekende Nee 2 39 Rear Convenience Center W W u dsseeeeererenee 2 44 Rear Storage Area W u u sssseeeeeeereree nerne 2 40 Roof Rack System cceceeeneeeteneeeteneeee es 2 40 Stowable Seat cceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeaeeaeenes 1 17 Stuck in Sand Mud Ice or Snow 008 4 30 SUN VISOTS eccriene e EE 2 15 SUMMOOT saeir neiaa aea oa Eaa 2 47 Surge Tank Pressure Cap SGCM Coolant 3 51 Switchbanks Instrument Panel 3 20 14 Tachometer ead cadet cauntecietndec ER nere eee nel 3 40 Taillamps Back Up Lam pS ae ribberne 5 52 Turn Signal and Stoplamps eeeeeeee 5 51 TGS Warning Light oser nere eres 3 45 Theft Deterrent Radio eeceeeseeeeeeeeeees 3 132 Theft Deterrent Systems ceeeeeeeeeeeeeeee es 2 15 Content Theft Deterrent eeeeeee e
207. ection 3 Instrument Panel Instrument Panel Overview sssseseereee 3 4 Battery Run Down Protection eee 3 20 Hazard Warning Flashers c eceeeeeee ees 3 6 Instrument Panel Switchbank 0 066 3 20 Other Warning Devices ceeeeeeeeeneeeeeneees 3 6 Head Up Display HUD cetera 3 21 FROMM ie gcniedeaeoheovbdat mend chee cents shag EAEE E Ea 3 6 Ultrasonic Rear Parking Assist URPA 3 24 Tilt Wheel sccescnetcaeeietedictnectieaeebnelciaeaaes 3 6 Accessory Power Outlets eeeeeeeeeeeeees 3 26 Turn Signal Multifunction Lever s es 3 7 Ashtrays and Cigarette Lighter 06 3 27 Turn and Lane Change Signals 2 3 7 Climate Controls 2 3 28 Headlamp High Low Beam Changer 3 8 Climate Control System ccccccceeeseeeeeeeeees 3 28 Flash to Pass E RES EN Eee FADE SEN RES nein 3 8 Dual Climate Control System 3 30 Windshield WIPES ces cesvccentigieseg e ES ERa 3 9 Dual Automatic Climate Control System 3 33 Ae a E Outlet Adjustment W W W sssseeeeeererererrerereee 3 36 Exterior Lamps I4 Warning Lights Gages and Indicators 3 37 Daytime Running Lamps DRL 3 14 heale ted Atala iis Siesta RE SES KER E eae i Automatic Headlamp System 2 3 15 Trip AE a al aL Ae ae NE A interior Lamp o e Tehometer aean ee 3 40 Instrument Panel Brightnes
208. ed space When anything from a container is used to clean the vehicle be sure to follow the manufacturer s warnings and instructions Always open the doors or windows of the vehicle when cleaning the inside Never use these to clean the vehicle Gasoline Benzene Naphtha Carbon Tetrachloride Acetone Paint Thinner Turpentine Lacquer Thinner Nail Polish Remover They can all be hazardous some more than others and they can all damage the vehicle too Do not use any of these products unless this manual says you can In many uses these will damage the vehicle Alcohol Laundry Soap Bleach e Reducing Agents Fabric Carpet Use a vacuum cleaner often to get rid of dust and loose dirt Wipe vinyl leather plastic and painted surfaces with a clean damp cloth GM approved cleaning products can be obtained from your dealer Here are some cleaning tips Always read the instructions on the cleaner label Clean up stains as soon as you can before they set Carefully scrape off any excess stain Use a clean cloth or sponge and change to a clean area often A soft brush may be used if stains are stubborn To avoid forming a ring on fabric after spot cleaning clean the entire area immediately or it will set 5 95 Most stains can be removed with club soda water 3 Spray a small amount of the cleaner onto a clean To clean use the following instructions soft white clo
209. ed to the upper outlets and warmer air to the floor outlets WWW Floor This mode directs most of the air to the floor outlets Use this mode to send air to the rear of the vehicle Keep the area under the front seats free of objects that could obstruct airflow to the rear of the vehicle The right knob can also be used to select defog or defrost mode For more information see Defogging and Defrosting later in this section Fan Turn the left knob clockwise or counterclockwise to increase or decrease the fan speed Turn the knob counterclockwise until it stops to turn off the fan The fan must be turned on for the air conditioning compressor to operate lt Recirculation This mode keeps outside air from coming in the vehicle It can be used to prevent outside air and odors from entering your vehicle or help heat or cool the air inside your vehicle more quickly Press this button to turn the recirculation mode on or off When the button is pressed an indicator light will come on The air conditioning compressor also comes on The recirculation mode can be used with vent and bi level modes but it cannot be used with floor defog defrost or outside air modes Temperature Control Use the drivers and passenger s temperature levers to increase or decrease the air temperature inside your vehicle x AIC Air Conditioning Press this button to turn the air conditioning system on or off When A C is pressed an indic
210. ed using the remote keyless entry transmitter There is no occupant activity detected for an illumination period of 25 seconds 3 68 Your vehicle was originally programmed to ON The mode may have been changed since then To determine the current mode or to change the mode do the following 1 Follow the instructions for Entering Programming Mode listed previously 2 Press the MODE button until INTERIOR LIGHTING DELAY appears on the DIC 3 Press the SET button until the arrow is before ON or OFF The mode you selected is now set You can either exit programming mode by following the instructions later in this section or program the next feature available on your vehicle Interior Lighting On The interior lighting on feature can be programmed to one of the following modes KEY OUT The interior lamps will come on for about 25 seconds whenever you remove the key from the ignition DOOR The interior lamps will come on for about 25 seconds when any door is opened Interior lighting on will not occur while the ignition is in ON After 25 seconds the interior lamps will fade out The lamps will fade out before the 25 seconds if one of the following occurs The ignition is turned to ON LOCK is pressed on the remote keyless entry transmitter There is no occupant activity detected for an illumination period of 25 seconds Your vehicle was originally programmed to DOOR The mode may have been change
211. edetermined deployment threshold Deployment thresholds take into account a variety of desired deployment and non deployment events and are used to predict how severe a crash is likely to be in time for the airbags to inflate and help restrain the occupants Whether your frontal airbags will or should deploy is not based on how fast your vehicle is traveling It depends largely on what you hit the direction of the impact and how quickly your vehicle slows down In addition your vehicle has dual stage frontal airbags which adjust the restraint according to crash severity Your vehicle is equipped with electronic frontal sensors which help the sensing system distinguish between a moderate and a more severe frontal impact For moderate frontal impacts these airbags inflate at a level less than full deployment For more severe frontal impacts full deployment occurs If the front of your vehicle goes straight into a wall that does not move or deform the threshold level for the reduced deployment is about 12 to 20 mph 19 to 33 km h and the threshold level for a full deployment is about 21 to 25 mph 34 to 40 km h The threshold level can vary however with specific vehicle design so that it can be somewhat above or below this range 1 73 Airbags may inflate at different crash speeds For example If the vehicle hits a stationary object the airbag could inflate at a different crash speed than if the object were moving e
212. ee 3 59 Traction AGtive arne El ener ele 3 52 Mirrors Manual Rearview Mirror sseseeeeeeeererrrnrer 2 31 Outside Convex Mirror W u u s sssseeeeeeeererenenee 2 32 Outside Curb View Assist Mirror 0208 2 32 Outside Heated Mirrors cceeeeeeeeeneee nena 2 32 Outside Power Mirror 0cceceeceeeeeeeeeees 2 31 MYyGMLink COM ccecceeeeee eee eeee een eee een eeeeeneeeees 7 3 N Navigation Radio System c ceeeeeeeeeneee tenes 3 130 New Vehicle Break In 2 eceeeeeeeeeeeeeeees 2 19 Normal Maintenance Replacement Parts 6 13 10 Odometer aaao ea iia 3 39 Odometer Trip cccceceececeeceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeees 3 39 Off Road Recovery ccceeeeeeeeeeeee eee eeeeeneene es 4 14 Oil ENGINE irese idoieitin a secede tines ican 5 16 Pressure Message 0 csceeceeeeeeeeeeeeeeseeees 3 54 Older Children Restraints c ccccceeeeeeeaee 1 43 Online Owner Center cccceceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeees 7 3 OnStar System oo ceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeee 2 33 Other Warning Devices eeeeeeeeeeee teeter eens 3 6 Outlet Adjustment ececeeeeeeeee een eee eeneeee es 3 36 Outside Convex Mirror 20 0 ccc cece eee eeeeeeeceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeaes 2 32 Curb View Assist Mirror ccccccceeeeee sees 2 32 Heated Mirrors ccc eee ec eee eeeeeeeeeeeeneeeeenes 2 32 Power Mirol oase anes 2
213. ee ee eee 2 15 PASS Key Il oo cc ccccccccccccccccceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeees 2 17 PASS Key Ill Operation 1 2 18 Wilt WCC iirrainn nann E E a a 3 6 Tire LOW MESsSaget ei ciccccnties thacvine tee wroehestceteansana ned 3 56 LESS Fee EET cebadsdeaeeannene 5 55 Aluminum or Chrome Plated Wheels IGICANING sect cesekeaangnemagnacetctencsstteaawentsenes 5 100 Buying NOW Tires cccccncecd nn cceeneecenesnevaetanenes 5 66 Chains Er ES cect ees menace nets ERE ea Nebel eee FNs 5 70 Changing a Flat Tire 223 re 5 72 Check Tire Pressure System 0 eeeeee 5 62 Cleaning cut REESE BEES SEERE ETERN cher FEE ENES EDER 5 100 Compact Spare Tire reirei eee 5 94 fa Tire Goes Flatir oieri 5 72 Inflation Tire Pressure a na 5 61 Tires cont Inspection and Rotation ssseseeserererernes 5 64 Installing the Spare Tire 1 W u ssssseeeeererreee 5 80 Removing the Flat Tire cceeeeeeeeeeee eee es 5 80 Removing the Spare Tire and Tools 5 74 Secondary Latch System eeeeeeeeeeeee ee 5 84 Storing a Flat or Spare Tire and Tools 5 88 Tire Sidewall Labelling eceeeeeeeeeeeeeees 5 56 Tire Terminology and Definitions 5 58 Uniform Tire Quality Grading 2 5 67 Wheel Alignment and Tire Balance 5 68 Wheel Replacement cceeeeeeeeeeee eee eees 5 68 When It Is Time for New Tires ccecce 5 65 TOD SUA ikra Rees eng EN
214. eeeeeeee ees 5 101 Child Restraints Child Restraint Systems cceeeeeeeeee teens 1 48 Child Restraints cont Infants and Young Children s 1 45 Lower Anchorages and Top Tethers for Children LATCH System eeeeeeeeeeeee 1 58 Older Children serierne ur Eero Eder 1 43 Securing a Child Restraint Designed for the LATCH System 5232 arrene ias 1 60 Securing a Child Restraint in a Center Rear Seat Position ccceceececeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeees 1 62 Securing a Child Restraint in a Rear Outside Seat POS Nain irsk aueedecessaneets 1 60 Securing a Child Restraint in the Right Front Seat POSIION 12 nr error 1 64 TOP SAP itiren enea e tein etnies 1 53 Top Strap Anchor Location ssseeeree 1 54 Where to Put the Restraint eee 1 52 Cigarette Lighter ccceeceeeeeeeneeeeeeeee een eeaes 3 27 Cleaning Aluminum or Chrome Plated Wheels 5 100 Exterior Lamps Lenses ceceeeeeeeeeeeeee es 5 99 ablic Carpet aneian a ai 5 95 FINISH CAPO iciccccscsimscisveatedssenncinge rainei sont naive 5 99 Glass Surfaces cccceceeeeeeeceeeeseeeeeeeeees 5 98 Instrument Panel so aen Seler loa 5 97 Interior Plastic Components ssssereree 5 97 eather 53 rese he einen 5 97 Cleaning cont ES Er enke 5 100 Underbody Maintenance ssseseerererrerrer 5 101 V SES RS otuuee etter E E N 5 97 Washing Your Vehicle 2 5 98 Weathers trips lase
215. eeeetereeeeees 3 56 Door Ajar Warning Message c c 3 56 Rear Hatch Ajar Warning Message 3 56 Check Gas Cap Message eeceeeeeeeeeeeees 3 57 PASS Key III Security Message 00608 3 57 All Wheel Drive Disable Warning Message 3 57 Low Washer Fluid Warning Message 3 58 Low Fuel Warning Message seeeeeeees 3 58 Low Brake Fluid Warning Message 3 59 Service Vehicle Soon Message 1 eeeeeeee 3 59 Program Mode Message 0 seeeeeeee sees 3 60 Remote Keyless Entry Transmitter Battery Low Warning Message cceeeeeeeeeeeeneeeee tees 3 60 Instrument Panel Parking Lamp Warning Message 06 3 61 Highbeam Out Warning Message 0600 3 61 Driver Information Center DIC 008 3 62 DIC Controls and Displays ceeeeeeeee ees 3 64 DIC Vehicle Personalization 0 eeeeeeeeees 3 66 Audio System S cceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeen ees 3 75 Setting the Time s 00 seis kenni eur 3 76 Radio With GD tcc anecsccescbeseiainnnptetasnoacceaase 3 76 Radio with Cassette and CD eeeeeeeeeees 3 87 Radio with Six Disc CD cceeeeeeee erences 3 100 Rear Seat Entertainment System 0 3 115 Navigation Radio System eeeeeeeeeeeeeees 3 130 Rear Seat Audio RSA ceeeeeeeeee eee eeees 3 130 Theft Deter
216. efore disposal Never dispose of oil by putting it in the trash pouring it on the ground into sewers or into streams or bodies of water Instead recycle it by taking it to a place that collects used oil If you have a problem properly disposing of your used oil ask your dealer a service station or a local recycling center for help Engine Air Cleaner Filter See Engine Compartment Overview on page 5 12 for the location of the engine air cleaner filter When to Inspect the Engine Air Cleaner Filter Inspect the air cleaner filter at the Maintenance II intervals and replace at the first oil change after 50 000 miles 83 000 km See Scheduled Maintenance on page 6 4 for more information If you are driving in dusty dirty conditions inspect the filter at each engine oil change How to Inspect the Engine Air Cleaner Filter To inspect the air cleaner filter remove the filter from the vehicle and lightly shake the filter to release loose dust and dirt If the filter remains caked with dirt a new filter is required To inspect or replace the air cleaner filter do the following 1 Remove the two clamps on the duct 2 Remove the duct 3400 V6 engine shown 3 6 L V6 engine similar 5 21 3 Unlatch the two hooks on top of the engine air cleaner filter housing 4 Inspect or replace the engine air cleaner filter 5 Align the tabs located on the bottom of the panel with the slots at the bottom of the housing 6
217. ehicle needs service 3 45 Engine Coolant Temperature Gage Canada United States This gage shows the engine coolant temperature If the gage pointer moves into the red area your engine is too hot It means that your engine coolant has overheated If you have been operating your vehicle under normal driving conditions you should pull off the road stop your vehicle and turn off the engine as soon as possible See Engine Overheating on page 5 28 3 46 Malfunction Indicator Lamp Service Engine Soon Light in the United States or Check Engine Light in Canada SERVICE ENGINE SOON United States Canada Your vehicle is equipped with a computer which monitors operation of the fuel ignition and emission control systems This system is called OBD II On Board Diagnostics Second Generation and is intended to assure that emissions are at acceptable levels for the life of the vehicle helping to produce a cleaner environment The SERVICE ENGINE SOON or check engine light comes on to indicate that there is a problem and service is required Malfunctions often will be indicated by the system before any problem is apparent This may prevent more serious damage to your vehicle This system is also designed to assist your service technician in correctly diagnosing any malfunction Notice If you keep driving your vehicle with this light on after awhile your emission controls may not work as well your fuel economy
218. ehicle was being driven the tire might contact a person or another vehicle causing injury and of course damage to itself as well Be sure the underbody mounted spare tire is stored with its valve stem pointing down 1 Lay the compact spare tire on the ground at the rear of the vehicle Position the compact spare tire so that the valve stem is pointed down facing the rear of the vehicle Lower the cable to the ground See Removing the Spare Tire and Tools on page 5 74 Tilt the retainer downward and slip it through the center hole of the spare tire Make sure the retainer is fully seated across the underside of the wheel Attach the folding wrench to the hoist shaft Turn the folding wrench clockwise to lift the spare tire When the tire reaches the stabilizer bar move the tire over the bar then continue to turn the folding wrench clockwise to lift the spare tire When the tire is almost in the stored position turn the tire so that the valve stem is towards the rear of the vehicle This will help when you check and maintain tire pressure in the spare Raise the tire fully against the underside of the vehicle Continue turning the folding wrench until you feel more than two clicks This indicates that the compact spare tire is secure and the cable is tight The spare tire hoist cannot be overtightened 10 Make sure the tire is stored securely Push pull A and then try to turn B
219. ehicle when the engine is running unless you have to If you have left the engine running the vehicle can move suddenly You or others could be injured To be sure your vehicle will not move even when you are on fairly level ground always set your parking brake and move the shift lever to PARK P See Shifting Into Park P on page 2 27 If you are pulling a trailer see Towing a Trailer on page 4 38 2 23 REVERSE R Use this gear to back up Notice Shifting to REVERSE R while your vehicle is moving forward could damage the transaxle The repairs would not be covered by your warranty Shift to REVERSE R only after your vehicle is stopped To rock your vehicle back and forth to get out of snow ice or sand without damaging your transaxle see f You Are Stuck In Sand Mud Ice or Snow on page 4 30 NEUTRAL N In this position your engine does not connect with the wheels To restart when you are already moving use NEUTRAL N only Also use NEUTRAL N when your vehicle is being towed Shifting into a drive gear while your engine is running at high speed is dangerous Unless your foot is firmly on the brake pedal your vehicle could move very rapidly You could lose control and hit people or objects Do not shift into a drive gear while your engine is running at high speed 2 24 Notice Shifting out of PARK P or NEUTRAL N with the engine racing may damage the transaxle The repairs would not be c
220. en in crashes than those who are wearing safety belts Rear passengers who are not safety belted can be thrown out of the vehicle in a crash And they can strike others in the vehicle who are wearing safety belts Rear Seat Outside Passenger Positions The positions next to the windows have lap shoulder belts Here is how to wear one properly Lap Shoulder Belt 1 Pick up the latch plate and pull the belt across you Do not let it get twisted The shoulder belt may lock if you pull the belt across you very quickly If this happens let the belt go back slightly to unlock it Then pull the belt across you more slowly 2 Push the latch plate into the buckle until it clicks If the belt stops before it reaches the buckle tilt the latch plate and keep pulling until you can buckle it Pull up on the latch plate to make sure it is secure If the belt is not long enough see Safety Belt Extender on page 1 42 Make sure the release button on the buckle is positioned so you would be able to unbuckle the safety belt quickly if you ever had to 1 35 L p Q r gt N K be Le Py H A i D 3 To make the lap part tight pull down on the buckle end of the belt as you pull up on the shoulder part The lap part of the belt should be worn low and snug on the hips just touching the thighs In a crash this applies force to the pelvic bones An
221. enter of gravity than other types of vehicles This means that you should not expect a utility vehicle to handle the same way a vehicle with a lower center of gravity like a car would in similar situations But driver behavior factors are far more often the cause of a utility vehicle rollover than are environmental or vehicle factors Safe driver behavior and understanding the environment in which you will be driving can help avoid a rollover crash in any type of vehicle including utility vehicles Defensive Driving The best advice anyone can give about driving is Drive defensively Please start with a very important safety device in your vehicle Buckle up See Safety Belts They Are for Everyone on page 1 20 Defensive driving really means be ready for anything On city streets rural roads or freeways it means always expect the unexpected Assume that pedestrians or other drivers are going to be careless and make mistakes Anticipate what they might do Be ready for their mistakes Rear end collisions are about the most preventable of accidents Yet they are common Allow enough following distance It is the best defensive driving maneuver in both city and rural driving You never know when the vehicle in front of you is going to brake or turn suddenly Defensive driving requires that a driver concentrate on the driving task Anything that distracts from the driving task such as concentrating on a cellular
222. ep hands clothing and tools away from any underhood electric fan If the coolant inside the coolant recovery tank is boiling do not do anything else until it cools down The vehicle should be parked on a level surface The coolant level should be at or above the full cold mark If it is not you may have a leak at the pressure cap or in the radiator hoses heater hoses radiator water pump or somewhere else in the cooling system Heater and radiator hoses and other engine parts can be very hot Do not touch them If you do you can be burned Do not run the engine if there is a leak If you run the engine it could lose all coolant That could cause an engine fire and you could be burned Get any leak fixed before you drive the vehicle 5 31 If there seems to be no leak with the engine on check to see if the electric engine cooling fans are running If the engine is overheating both fans should be running If they are not your vehicle needs service Notice Engine damage from running your engine without coolant is not covered by your warranty See Overheated Engine Protection Operating Mode on page 5 30 for information on driving to a safe place in an emergency Notice Using coolant other than DEX COOL may cause premature engine heater core or radiator corrosion In addition the engine coolant may require changing sooner at 30 000 miles 50 000 km or 24 months whichever occurs first Any repairs woul
223. er Airbag System Your vehicle has airbags a frontal airbag for the driver and another frontal airbag for the right front passenger Your vehicle may also have side impact airbags Side impact airbags are available for the driver and right front passenger lf your vehicle has a side impact airbag for the driver and or the right front passenger the words AIR BAG will appear on the airbag covering on the side of the seatback closest to the door Frontal airbags are designed to help reduce the risk of injury from the force of an inflating frontal airbag But these airbags must inflate very quickly to do their job and comply with federal regulations 1 67 Here are the most important things to know about the airbag system You can be severely injured or killed in a crash if you are not wearing your safety belt even if you have airbags Wearing your safety belt during a crash helps reduce your chance of hitting things inside the vehicle or being ejected from it Airbags are designed to work with safety belts but do not replace them Frontal airbags for the driver and right front passenger are designed to deploy only in moderate to severe frontal and near frontal crashes They are not designed to inflate in rollover rear or low speed frontal crashes or in many side crashes And for some unrestrained occupants frontal airbags may provide less protection in frontal crashes than more forceful airbags have provided in the
224. er Mirrors Ignition 1 Module Turn Signal Switch Rear Defogger 22 Air Bag Module 24 TCC Switch 25 HVAC Blower Motor 8 HVAC Mode and Temperature Motors and Head Up Display 28 Not Used 29 Windshield Wipers and Washer Instrument Panel Cluster Body 3 o 32 Control Module BCM PASS Key III Park Lock Ignition Key Solenoid Rear Window Wiper Washer Fuse Usage Instrument Panel Lights Hazard Flashers Instrument Panel Cluster Climate Control Security LED and Remote Keyless Entry Mode PASS Key III Body Control Module BCM Advanced Occupant System Module C Reay Uso Underhood Fuse Block This fuse block is located in the engine compartment on the passenger s side of the vehicle See Engine Compartment Overview on page 5 12 for more information on location The back up lamp relay A is located behind and to the left of the underhood fuse block To remove the cover press the two tabs in and lift up the cover 5 107 D od O 8 5 108 Bee ho par ep De ol 5 Te pot 3400 V6 Engine Fuel Pump Air Conditioning Compressor Clutch Horn Engine Controls Emissions and Sensors Power Control Module PCM Battery Power Anti Lock Brakes ABS Control Module Transaxle Solenoids Anti lock Brake System ABS Solenoid Valves 10 Powertrain Control Module PCM Body Control Module Battery
225. ere aligned and balanced carefully at the factory to give you the longest tire life and best overall performance If you notice unusual tire wear or your vehicle pulling one way or the other the alignment may need to be reset If you notice your vehicle vibrating when driving on a smooth road your wheels may need to be rebalanced Wheel Replacement Replace any wheel that is bent cracked or badly rusted or corroded If wheel nuts keep coming loose the wheel wheel bolts and wheel nuts should be replaced If the wheel leaks air replace it except some aluminum wheels which can sometimes be repaired See your dealer if any of these conditions exist Your dealer will know the kind of wheel you need Each new wheel should have the same load carrying capacity diameter width offset and be mounted the same way as the one it replaces If you need to replace any of your wheels wheel bolts or wheel nuts replace them only with new GM original equipment parts This way you will be sure to have the right wheel wheel bolts and wheel nuts for your vehicle Using the wrong replacement wheels wheel bolts or wheel nuts on your vehicle can be dangerous It could affect the braking and handling of your vehicle make your tires lose air and make you lose control You could have a collision in which you or others could be injured Always use the correct wheel wheel bolts and wheel nuts for replacement Notice The wrong wheel ca
226. ers An electric fan under the hood can start up and injure you even when the engine is not running Keep hands clothing and tools away from any underhood electric fan Do not fill a container while it is inside a vehicle in a vehicle s trunk pickup bed or on any surface other than the ground Bring the fill nozzle in contact with the Things that burn can get on hot engine parts inside of the fill opening before operating and start a fire These include liquids like fuel the nozzle Contact should be maintained oil coolant brake fluid windshield washer and until the filling is complete other fluids and plastic or rubber You or Do not smoke while pumping gasoline others could be burned Be careful not to drop or spill things that will burn onto a hot engine Hood Release To open the hood do the following 1 Pull the hood release handle located under the instrument panel on the driver s side of the vehicle 2 At the front of the vehicle pull up on the center of the hood and push the secondary hood release to the right 3 After you have partially lifted the hood gas struts will automatically take over to lift and hold the hood in the fully open position Before closing the hood be sure all filler caps are on properly Then pull the hood down to close Engine Compartment Overview When you lift the hood of the 3400 V6 engine here is what you will see Underhood Fuse Block See Underhood Fuse
227. es on page 6 7 for further information Performing maintenance work on a vehicle can be dangerous In trying to do some jobs you can be seriously injured Do your own maintenance work only if you have the required know how and the proper tools and equipment for the job If you have any doubt see your GM Goodwrench dealer to have a qualified technician do the work Some maintenance services can be complex So unless you are technically qualified and have the necessary equipment you should have your GM Goodwrench dealer do these jobs When you go to your GM Goodwrench dealer for your service needs you will know that GM trained and supported service technicians will perform the work using genuine GM parts If you want to get service information see Service Publications Ordering Information on page 7 12 Owner Checks and Services on page 6 8 tells you what should be checked when to check it and what you can easily do to help keep your vehicle in good condition The proper replacement parts fluids and lubricants to use are listed in Recommended Fluids and Lubricants on page 6 12 and Normal Maintenance Replacement Parts on page 6 13 When your vehicle is serviced make sure these are used All parts should be replaced and all necessary repairs done before you or anyone else drives the vehicle We recommend the use of genuine GM parts Scheduled Maintenance When the CHANGE ENGINE OIL message comes on it means that service
228. ess than a second and you could crash and be injured What can you do about highway hypnosis First be aware that it can happen Then here are some tips Make sure your vehicle is well ventilated with a comfortably cool interior Keep your eyes moving Scan the road ahead and to the sides Check your mirrors and your instruments frequently e If you get sleepy pull off the road into a rest service or parking area and take a nap get some exercise or both For safety treat drowsiness on the highway as an emergency 4 24 Hill and Mountain Roads Driving on steep hills or mountains is different from driving in flat or rolling terrain lf you drive regularly in steep country or if you are planning to visit there here are some tips that can make your trips safer and more enjoyable Keep your vehicle in good shape Check all fluid levels and also the brakes tires cooling system and transaxle These parts can work hard on mountain roads Know how to go down hills The most important thing to know is this let your engine do some of the slowing down Shift to a lower gear when you go down a steep or long hill If you do not shift down your brakes could get so hot that they would not work well You would then have poor braking or even none going down a hill You could crash Shift down to let your engine assist your brakes on a steep downhill slope Coasting downhill in NEUTRAL N or with the ignitio
229. even if they are not currently displayed A Canadian trip odometer will remain in metric units only To reset the trip odometer to zero 0 push and hold the trip reset button for at least one and a half seconds but less than three seconds The trip odometer that is showing in the display will be reset 3 39 Retro Active Reset The trip odometer has a feature called retro active reset This feature can be used to set the trip odometer to the number of miles or kilometers driven since the ignition was last turned on This can be used if you forget to reset your trip odometer at the beginning of a trip To use the retro active reset feature push and hold the trip reset button for at least three seconds The trip odometer will then display the number of miles or kilometers driven since the ignition was last turned on and you began driving If you use the retro active reset feature after you have started the vehicle but before you begin moving the display will show the number of miles or kilometers you drove during the last ignition cycle Once you begin driving the trip odometer will accumulate mileage For example if you have driven 5 0 miles 8 0 km since you started your vehicle and then activate the retro active reset feature the display will show 5 0 miles 8 0 km As you drive the display will then increase to 5 1 miles 8 2 km 5 2 miles 8 4 km etc 3 40 Tachometer The tachometer displays the engine speed in rev
230. exceed the GVWR for your vehicle or the GAWR for either the front or rear axle Do not load your vehicle any heavier than the Gross Vehicle Weight Rating GVWR or either the maximum front or rear Gross Axle Weight Rating GAWR If you do parts on your vehicle can break and it can change the way your vehicle handles These could cause you to lose control and crash Also overloading can shorten the life of your vehicle Notice Overloading your vehicle may cause damage Repairs would not be covered by your warranty Do not overload your vehicle 4 35 If you put things inside your vehicle like suitcases tools packages or anything else they will go as fast as the vehicle goes If you have to stop or turn quickly or if there is a crash they will keep going Things you put inside your vehicle can strike and injure people in a sudden stop or turn or in a crash Put things in the cargo area of your vehicle Try to spread the weight evenly Never stack heavier things like suitcases inside the vehicle so that some of them are above the tops of the seats Do not leave an unsecured child restraint in your vehicle When you carry something inside the vehicle secure it whenever you can Do not leave a seat folded down unless you need to 4 36 Towing Towing Your Vehicle Consult your dealer or a professional towing service if you need to have your disabled vehicle towed See Roadside Assistance Program
231. f mineral based oil such as engine oil in your brake system can damage brake system parts so badly that they will have to be replaced Do not let someone put in the wrong kind of fluid e If you spill brake fluid on your vehicle s painted surfaces the paint finish can be damaged Be careful not to spill brake fluid on your vehicle If you do wash it off immediately See Appearance Care on page 5 95 5 39 Brake Wear Your vehicle has four wheel disc brakes Disc brake pads have built in wear indicators that make a high pitched warning sound when the brake pads are worn and new pads are needed The sound may come and go or be heard all the time your vehicle is moving except when you are pushing on the brake pedal firmly The brake wear warning sound means that soon your brakes will not work well That could lead to an accident When you hear the brake wear warning sound have your vehicle serviced Notice Continuing to drive with worn out brake pads could result in costly brake repair Some driving conditions or climates may cause a brake squeal when the brakes are first applied or lightly applied This does not mean something is wrong with your brakes 5 40 Properly torqued wheel nuts are necessary to help prevent brake pulsation When tires are rotated inspect brake pads for wear and evenly tighten wheel nuts in the proper sequence to GM torque specifications Brake linings should always be replaced as c
232. f the impact and how quickly the vehicle slows down in frontal and near frontal impacts For side impact airbags inflation is determined by the location and severity of the impact What Makes an Airbag Inflate In an impact of sufficient severity the airbag sensing system detects that the vehicle is in a crash For both frontal and side impact airbags the sensing system triggers a release of gas from the inflator which inflates the airbag The inflator the airbag and related hardware are all part of the airbag modules Frontal airbag modules are located inside the steering wheel and instrument panel For vehicles with side impact airbags the airbag modules are located in the seatback closest to the driver s and or right front passenger s door How Does an Airbag Restrain In moderate to severe frontal or near frontal collisions even belted occupants can contact the steering wheel or the instrument panel In moderate to severe side collisions even belted occupants can contact the inside of the vehicle The airbag supplements the protection provided by safety belts Airbags distribute the force of the impact more evenly over the occupant s upper body stopping the occupant more gradually But the frontal airbags would not help you in many types of collisions including rollovers rear impacts and many side impacts primarily because an occupant s motion is not toward the airbag Side impact airbags would not help you in many types
233. flation Load Limit Maximum load that can be carried and the maximum pressure needed to support that load Compact Spare Tire Example A Temporary Use Only The compact spare tire or temporary use tire has a tread life of approximately 3 000 miles 5 000 km and should not be driven at speeds over 65 mph 105 km h The compact spare tire is for emergency use when a regular road tire has lost air and gone flat If your vehicle has a compact spare tire see Compact Spare Tire on page 5 94 and If a Tire Goes Flat on page 5 72 B Tire Ply Material The type of cord and number of plies in the sidewall and under the tread C Tire Identification Number TIN The letters and numbers following the DOT Department of Transportation code is the Tire Identification Number TIN The TIN shows the manufacturer and plant code tire size and date the tire was manufactured The TIN is molded onto both sides of the tire although only one side may have the date of manufacture D Maximum Cold Inflation Load Limit Maximum load that can be carried and the maximum pressure needed to support that load E Tire Inflation The temporary use tire or compact spare tire should be inflated to 60 psi 420 kPa For more information on tire pressure and inflation see Inflation Tire Pressure on page 5 61 F Tire Size A combination of letters and numbers define a tire s width height aspect ratio construction type and service descript
234. for Determining Correct Load Limit 1 Locate the statement The combined weight of occupants and cargo should never exceed XXX kg or XXX pounds on your vehicle s placard 2 Determine the combined weight of the driver and passengers that will be riding in your vehicle 3 Subtract the combined weight of the driver and passengers from XXX kilograms or XXX pounds 4 The resulting figure equals the available amount of cargo and luggage load capacity For example if the XXX amount equals 1400 Ibs and there will be five 150 Ib passengers in your vehicle the amount of available cargo and luggage load capacity is 650 Ibs 1400 750 5 x 150 650 Ibs 5 Determine the combined weight of luggage and cargo being loaded on the vehicle That weight may not safely exceed the available cargo and luggage load capacity calculated in Step 4 6 If your vehicle will be towing a trailer the load from your trailer will be transferred to your vehicle Example 1 Consult this manual to determine how this reduces Item Description Total the available cargo and luggage load capacity Vehicle Capacity Weight for your vehicle OA for Example 1 1 000 Ibs 453 kg See Towing a Trailer on page 4 38 for important pa Subtract Occupant information on towing a trailer towing safety rules and Weight 150 Ibs 300 Ibs 136 kg trailering tips 68 kg x2 Available Occupant and co Cargo Weight 700 Ibs 317 kg 4 33
235. formation that includes song title and artist name A service fee is required in order to receive the XM service For more information contact XM at www xmradio com or call 1 800 852 XMXM 9696 Playing the Radio PWR Power Push this knob to turn the system on and off VOLUME Turn this knob to increase or to decrease the volume AUTO VOL Automatic Volume With automatic volume the audio system adjusts automatically to make up for road and wind noise as you drive Set the volume at the desired level Press this button to select MIN MED or MAX Each higher setting will allow for more volume compensation at faster vehicle speeds Then as you drive automatic volume increases the volume as necessary to overcome noise at any speed The volume level should always sound the same to you as you drive To turn automatic volume off press this button until OFF appears on the display 3 101 RCL Recall Press this knob to switch the display between the radio station frequency and the time When the ignition is off press this knob to display the time For RDS press the RCL knob to change what appears on the display while using RDS The display options are station name RDS station frequency PTY and the name of the program if available For XM if equipped press the RCL knob while in XM mode to retrieve four different categories of information related to the current song or channel Artist Song Title Cate
236. forward i Repeat these steps for the other section of the split For up level split bench seats continue pushing bench seat forward on the recliner lever to release the rear latches from the floor pins and flip the seat forward The seat can stay in this position or it can be removed from the vehicle by following the next steps Replacing the Split Bench Seat A safety belt that is improperly routed not properly attached or twisted will not provide If the seatback is not locked it could move forward in a sudden stop or crash That could cause injury to the person sitting there Always press rearward on the seatback to be sure it is locked the protection needed in a crash The person wearing the belt could be seriously injured After installing the seat always check to be sure that the safety belts are properly routed and attached and are not twisted Make sure that the seatback is in the folded forward position and that the safety belts are on the correct section of the seat i Don t put the sections of the bench seat in so that they A seat that is not locked into place properly face rearward because they won t latch that way can move around in a collision or sudden stop People in the vehicle could be injured Be sure to lock the seat into place properly when installing it The split bench seat sections have seat position labels located on the back of each section showing where the section must go The sea
237. ft deterrent system the power door lock switch may cause the system to arm See Content Theft Deterrent on page 2 15 for more information Delayed Locking With the delayed locking feature the doors will not lock immediately when locking the doors using the power door lock switch or when LOCK on the remote keyless entry transmitter is pressed while any door is open Instead three chimes will be heard to indicate that the delayed locking feature is in operation Five seconds after all doors are closed the doors will lock automatically If the ignition is in ON or ACCESSORY this feature will not lock the doors If your vehicle is equipped with the Driver Information Center DIC see DIC Vehicle Personalization on page 3 66 to program the delayed locking feature Programmable Automatic Door Locks All of the doors will automatically lock when all doors are closed the engine is running and the shift lever is shifted out of PARK P All of the doors will automatically unlock when the shift lever is shifted into PARK P With the automatic door lock feature you can still lock or unlock the doors at any time either manually with the power door lock switches or by pressing LOCK on the remote keyless entry transmitter See Remote Keyless Entry System Operation on page 2 6 for more y z 5 On the inside of the rear door will be a lock Push the lever up to engage the safety lock information 3 Close the door
238. ft up on the recliner lever located on the outboard side of the seatback Use the recliner lever to move the seatback to the desired position It is easier to raise or lower the seatback if you lean forward and take the weight off the seatback The seatbacks on the second row captain s chairs fold forward the same way After raising a seatback to an upright position push and pull on the seatback to check that it is locked upright Removing the Captain s Chairs 1 Make sure that the seatback is in the upright position Hs ENTEN 2 Lift the seatback recliner lever to fold the seatback He ON forward 4 The seat can then be lifted off the front floor pins 5 Remove the seat by rocking it slightly toward the rear of the vehicle and then pulling it out Repeat these steps for the other captain s chair 3 Pull the nylon strap behind the chair to release the rear hooks from the floor pins Replacing the Captain s Chairs A safety belt that is improperly routed not properly attached or twisted will not provide If the seatback is not locked it could move forward in a sudden stop or crash That could cause injury to the person sitting there Always press rearward on the seatback to be sure it is locked the protection needed in a crash The person wearing the belt could be seriously injured After installing the seat always check to be sure that the safety belts are properly routed and attached and are not twis
239. g Mode This emergency operating mode allows your vehicle to be driven to a safe place in an emergency situation If an overheated engine condition exists an overheat protection mode which alternates firing groups of cylinders helps prevent engine damage In this mode you will notice a significant loss in power and engine performance If your vehicle is equipped with the 3 6L V6 engine the reduced engine power message along with the engine coolant temperature warning message will come on to indicate the vehicle has entered overheated engine protection operating mode The temperature gage will also indicate an overheat condition exists Driving extended miles km and or towing a trailer in the overheat protection mode should be avoided Notice After driving in the overheated engine protection operating mode to avoid engine damage allow the engine to cool before attempting any repair The engine oil will be severely degraded Repair the cause of coolant loss change the oil and reset the oil life system See Engine Oil on page 5 16 5 30 Cooling System When you decide it is safe to lift the hood here is what you will see J iS SE ss a A q BEES ER SEA 3400 V6 engine 3 6 L V6 engine A Radiator Pressure Cap B Electric Engine Cooling Fans C Coolant Recovery Tank An electric engine cooling fan under the hood can start up even when the engine is not running and can injure you Ke
240. ge is received after having your vehicle serviced check with your dealer Radio ID Radio ID label If tuned to channel 0 this message will alternate with the channel 0 XM Radio 8 digit radio ID label This label is needed to activate the service Unknown Radio ID not known If this message is received when tuned to channel 0 there should only be if may be a receiver fault Consult with your dealer hardware failure Chk XMRevr Hardware failure If this message does not clear within a short period of time the receiver may have a fault Consult with your dealer 3 109 Playing a CD If the ignition or radio is turned off with a CD in the player it will stay in the player When the ignition or radio is turned on the CD will start playing where it stopped if it was the last selected audio source When a CD is inserted the CD symbol will appear on the CD As each new track starts to play the track number will appear on the display The CD player can play the smaller 3 inch 8 cm single CDs with an adapter ring Full size CDs and the smaller CDs are loaded in the same manner If playing a CD R the sound quality may be reduced due to CD R quality the method of recording the quality of the music that has been recorded and the way the CD R has been handled There may be an increase in skipping difficulty in finding tracks and or difficulty in loading and ejecting If these problems occur try a known good CD Do not ad
241. gh beams When you return to low beam the fog lamps will come back on Using your high beams in fog is not recommended 3 15 Interior Lamps The interior lamps can be controlled or automatically turn on or off under certain conditions They are explained in the following text Instrument Panel Brightness This feature controls the brightness of the instrument panel lights The knob for this feature is located on the interior lamps control Press the knob to extend it Turn the knob to adjust the instrument panel brightness Press the knob in when not in use Interior Lamps Control The interior lamp control is located to the left of the steering column below the exterior lamp control Turn the interior lamp control to one of the following positions OFF This position turns the interior lamps off DOOR This position turns on the interior lamps when any door is opened and when the ignition key is removed from the ignition ON This position turns the interior lamps on Headlamp Exit Delay lf your vehicle has headlamp exit delay it will keep the headlamps and parking lamps on at night for 30 seconds if the following conditions are met The ignition is turned to OFF The exterior lamp control is in the AUTO position LOCK is pressed on the remote keyless entry transmitter e It is dark enough outside After 30 seconds the headlamps and parking lamps will turn off The lamps will turn off befo
242. glare as from a driver who does not lower the high beams or a vehicle with misaimed headlamps slow down a little Avoid staring directly into the approaching headlamps Keep your windshield and all the glass on your vehicle clean inside and out Glare at night is made much worse by dirt on the glass Even the inside of the glass can build up a film caused by dust Dirty glass makes lights dazzle and flash more than clean glass would making the pupils of your eyes contract repeatedly Remember that your headlamps light up far less of a roadway when you are in a turn or curve Keep your eyes moving that way it is easier to pick out dimly lighted objects Just as your headlamps should be checked regularly for proper aim so should your eyes be examined regularly Some drivers suffer from night blindness the inability to see in dim light and are not even aware of it Driving in Rain and on Wet Roads Rain and wet roads can mean driving trouble On a wet road you cannot stop accelerate or turn as well because your tire to road traction is not as good as on dry roads And if your tires do not have much tread left you will get even less traction It is always wise to go slower and be cautious if rain starts to fall while you are driving The surface may get wet suddenly when your reflexes are tuned for driving on dry pavement The heavier the rain the harder it is to see Even if your Driving too fast through large
243. gle trip Once learned the system will remember the tire pressure until the system is reset 5 63 Tire Inspection and Rotation Tires should be rotated every 5 000 to 8 000 miles 8 000 to 13 000 km Any time you notice unusual wear rotate your tires as soon as possible and check wheel alignment Also check for damaged tires or wheels See When It Is Time for New Tires on page 5 65 and Wheel Replacement on page 5 68 for more information Make sure the spare tire is stored securely Push pull and then try to rotate or turn the tire If it moves use the folding wrench to tighten the cable See Storing a Flat or Spare Tire and Tools on page 5 88 The purpose of regular rotation is to achieve more uniform wear for all tires on the vehicle The first rotation is the most important See Scheduled Maintenance on page 6 4 5 64 When rotating your tires always use the correct rotation pattern shown here Do not include the compact spare tire in your tire rotation After the tires have been rotated adjust the front and rear inflation pressures as shown on the Tire and Loading Information label Reset the check tire pressure system if equipped See Check Tire Pressure System on page 5 62 Make certain that all wheel nuts are properly tightened See Wheel Nut Torque under Capacities and Specifications on page 5 112 Rust or dirt on a wheel or on the parts to which it is fastened can make wheel nuts become
244. go over the shoulder and across the chest These parts of the body are best able to take belt restraining forces The safety belt locks if there is a sudden stop or crash or if you pull the belt very quickly out of the retractor 1 27 Q What is wrong with this A The shoulder belt is too loose It will not give nearly as much protection this way 1 28 You can be seriously hurt if your shoulder belt is too loose In a crash you would move forward too much which could increase injury The shoulder belt should fit against your body Q What is wrong with this A The belt is buckled in the wrong place You can be seriously injured if your belt is buckled in the wrong place like this In a crash the belt would go up over your abdomen The belt forces would be there not at the pelvic bones This could cause serious internal injuries Always buckle your belt into the buckle nearest you 1 29 Q What is wrong with this The belt is over an armrest 1 30 You can be seriously injured if your belt goes over an armrest like this The belt would be much too high In a crash you can slide under the belt The belt force would then be applied at the abdomen not at the pelvic bones and that could cause serious or fatal injuries Be sure the belt goes under the armrests Q What is wrong w
245. gory or PTY Channel Number Channel Name To change the default on the display press the RCL knob until you see the display you want then hold the knob until the display flashes The selected display will now be the default Finding a Station BAND Press this button to switch between FM1 FM2 AM or XM1 or XM2 if equipped The display will show the selection TUNE Turn this knob to select radio stations 3 102 K SEEK gt Press the right or the left arrow to go to the next or to the previous station and stay there The radio will only seek stations with a strong signal that are in the selected band K SCAN gt Press and hold either SCAN arrow for two seconds until SC appears on the display and you hear a beep The radio will go to a station play for a few seconds then go on to the next station Press either SCAN arrow again to stop scanning To scan preset stations press and hold either SCAN arrow for more than four seconds PRESET SCAN will appear on the display and you will hear a double beep The radio will go to the first preset station stored on the pushbuttons play for a few seconds then go on to the next preset station Press either SCAN arrow again to stop scanning presets The radio will only scan stations with a strong signal that are in the selected band Setting Preset Stations Up to 30 stations six FM1 six FM2 and six AM six XM1 and six XM2 if equipped can be programmed on the six
246. h or they could even inflate without a crash To help avoid injury to yourself or others have your vehicle serviced right away if the airbag readiness light stays on after you start your vehicle The airbag readiness light should flash for a few seconds when you turn the ignition key to ON If the light does not come on then have it fixed so it will be ready to warn you if there is a problem 3 42 Passenger Airbag Status Indicator Your vehicle has the passenger sensing system Your rearview mirror has a passenger airbag status indicator PASSENGER AIR BAG ogame ON Passenger Airbag Status Indicator United States Se e2 RO AM Passenger Airbag Status Indicator Canada When the ignition key is turned to ON or START the passenger airbag status indicator will light ON and OFF or the symbol for on and off for several seconds as a system check Then after several more seconds the status indicator will light either ON or OFF or either the on or off symbol to let you know the status of the right front passenger s frontal airbag If the word ON or the on symbol is lit on the passenger airbag status indicator it means that the right front passenger s frontal airbag is enabled may inflate If the on indicator comes on when you have a rear facing child restraint installed in the right front passenger s seat it means that the passenger sensing system has not turned off the passenger s frontal airbag A child
247. h as fuel lines frame floor pan and exhaust system even though they have corrosion protection At least every spring flush these materials from the underbody with plain water Clean any areas where mud and debris can collect Dirt packed in close areas of the frame should be loosened before being flushed Your GM dealer or an underbody car washing system can do this for you Chemical Paint Spotting Some weather and atmospheric conditions can create a chemical fallout Airborne pollutants can fall upon and attack painted surfaces on the vehicle This damage can take two forms blotchy ring shaped discolorations and small irregular dark spots etched into the paint surface Although no defect in the paint job causes this GM will repair at no charge to the owner the surfaces of new vehicles damaged by this fallout condition within 12 months or 12 000 miles 20 000 km of purchase whichever occurs first 5 101 Vehicle Care Appearance Materials See your GM dealer for more information on purchasing the following products Description Usage Polishing Cloth Interior and exterior Wax Treated polishing cloth Tar and Road Oil Removes tar road oil Remover and asphalt Chrome Cleaner and Use on chrome or Polish stainless steel White Sidewall Tire Removes soil and black Cleaner marks from whitewalls Cleans vinyl tops Vinyl Cleaner upholstery and convertible tops Removes dirt grime smoke and fingerpr
248. hange the way the engine operates Before adding electrical equipment check with your dealer If you do not your engine might not perform properly 2 21 Engine Coolant Heater Your vehicle may have an engine coolant heater In very cold weather 0 F 18 C or colder the engine coolant heater can help You will get easier starting and better fuel economy during engine warm up Usually the coolant heater should be plugged in a minimum of four hours prior to starting your vehicle At temperatures above 32 F 0 C use of the coolant heater is not required To Use the Engine Coolant Heater 1 Turn off the engine 2 Open the hood and unwrap the electrical cord The electrical cord is located on the driver s side of the engine compartment 3 Plug it into a normal grounded 110 volt AC outlet 2 22 Plugging the cord into an ungrounded outlet could cause an electrical shock Also the wrong kind of extension cord could overheat and cause a fire You could be seriously injured Plug the cord into a properly grounded three prong 110 volt AC outlet If the cord will not reach use a heavy duty three prong extension cord rated for at least 15 amps 4 Before starting the engine be sure to unplug and store the cord as it was before to keep it away from moving engine parts If you do not it could be damaged How long should you keep the coolant heater plugged in The answer depends on the outside temperature the ki
249. he amount of traffic on them You will want to watch out for what the other drivers are doing and pay attention to traffic signals Here are ways to increase your safety in city driving Know the best way to get to where you are going Get a city map and plan your trip into an unknown part of the city just as you would for a cross country trip Try to use the freeways that rim and crisscross most large cities You will save time and energy See Freeway Driving on page 4 22 Treat a green light as a warning signal A traffic light is there because the corner is busy enough to need it When a light turns green and just before you start to move check both ways for vehicles that have not cleared the intersection or may be running the red light 4 21 Freeway Driving Mile for mile freeways also called thruways parkways expressways turnpikes or superhighways are the safest of all roads But they have their own special rules 4 22 The most important advice on freeway driving is Keep up with traffic and keep to the right Drive at the same speed most of the other drivers are driving Too fast or too slow driving breaks a smooth traffic flow Treat the left lane on a freeway as a passing lane At the entrance there is usually a ramp that leads to the freeway If you have a clear view of the freeway as you drive along the entrance ramp you should begin to check traffic Try to determine where you expect to blen
250. he Auto Safety Hotline toll free at 1 800 424 9393 or 366 0123 in the Washington D C area or write to NHTSA U S Department of Transportation Washington D C 20590 You can also obtain other information about motor vehicle safety from the hotline Reporting Safety Defects to the Canadian Government If you live in Canada and you believe that your vehicle has a safety defect you should immediately notify Transport Canada in addition to notifying General Motors of Canada Limited You may write to Transport Canada 330 Sparks Street Tower C Ottawa Ontario K1A ON5 Reporting Safety Defects to General Motors In addition to notifying NHTSA or Transport Canada in a situation like this we certainly hope you will notify us Please call us at 1 800 521 7300 or write Buick Customer Assistance Center P O Box 33136 Detroit MI 48232 5136 In Canada please call us at 1 800 263 3777 English or 1 800 263 7854 French Or write General Motors of Canada Limited Customer Communication Centre 163 005 1908 Colonel Sam Drive Oshawa Ontario L1H 8P7 7 12 Service Publications Ordering Information Service Manuals Service Manuals have the diagnosis and repair information on engines transmission axle suspension brakes electrical steering body etc Transmission Transaxle Transfer Case Unit Repair Manual This manual provides information on unit repair service procedures adjustments and specifications
251. he inactive CD will remain safely inside the radio for future listening CD Press this button to play a CD when listening to the radio A Eject Press this button to eject the CD Eject may be activated with either the ignition or radio off CDs may be loaded with the ignition or radio off if this button is pressed first 3 86 CD Messages CHECK CD If this message appears on the radio display it could for one of the following reasons Itis very hot When the temperature returns to normal the CD should play e You are driving on a very rough road When the road becomes smoother the CD should play e The CD is dirty scratched wet or upside down The air is very humid If so wait about an hour and try again There may have been a problem while burning the CD The label may be caught in the CD player If the CD is not playing correctly for any other reason try a known good CD If any error occurs repeatedly or if an error cannot be corrected contact your dealer If the radio displays an error message write it down and provide it to your dealer when reporting the problem Listening to a DVD Your vehicle may have a Rear Seat Entertainment System see Rear Seat Entertainment System on page 3 115 for more information If your vehicle has this system and a DVD is playing the DVD symbol will appear on the radio display indicating that the DVD is available and can be listened to through your vehicles
252. he remote keyless entry transmitter The alarm will go into standby mode Once the liftgate is closed the alarm will be armed See Liftgate Release under Liftgate on page 2 11 for more information on how to open the liftgate Arming with the Power Lock Switch The content theft deterrent alarm system will arm when you use either power door lock switch to lock the doors while any door or the liftgate is open and the key is removed from the ignition The security light located on top of the instrument panel will start flashing when the system is armed Within five seconds after the security light begins to flash any door can be manually unlocked and opened without sounding the alarm A door unlocked manually will remain unlocked until locked again Arming with the Remote Keyless Entry Transmitter Your alarm system will arm when you press LOCK once on your remote keyless entry transmitter to lock the doors The alarm system light will come on for 30 seconds and then start flashing to let you know the system is armed Within the 30 second delay after the security light comes on and an additional five seconds after the light begins to flash any door can be manually unlocked and opened without sounding the alarm If LOCK is pressed on your remote keyless entry transmitter twice within five seconds any door can be manually unlocked and opened within five seconds after the security light begins to flash without sounding th
253. he track will appear on the display 4 RDM Random Press this pushbutton to hear the tracks in random rather than sequential order Press RDM again to turn off random play EQ Equalizer Press EQ to select an equalization setting while playing a CD The equalization will be set whenever a CD is played See EQ listed previously for more information Ki SEEK Press the left arrow to go to the start of the current track if more than eight seconds have played Press the right arrow to go to the next track If either arrow is held or pressed more than once the player will continue moving backward or forward through the CD 3 85 To scan tracks press and hold either SEEK arrow for two seconds until SCAN appears on the display and you will hear a beep The CD will go to the next track play for a few seconds then go on to the next track The sound will mute and SCAN and the track number will appear on the display while scanning The CD will only scan forward Press either SEEK arrow again to stop scanning DISP Display Press this button to see which track is playing Press it again within five seconds to see how long it has been playing To change the default on the display track or elapsed time press this button until you see the display you want then hold the button until the display flashes The selected display will now be the default BAND Press this button to listen to the radio when a CD is playing T
254. hen release the switch To increase your speed in very small amounts move the switch to R A briefly and then release it Each time you do this your vehicle will go about 1 mph 1 6 km h faster The accelerate feature will work whether or not you have set an initial cruise control speed Reducing Speed While Using Cruise Control There are two ways to reduce speed while using cruise control Press the SET button at the end of the lever until you reach the lower speed you want then release it To slow down in very small amounts press the SET button briefly Each time you do this you will go about 1 mph 1 6 km h slower Passing Another Vehicle While Using Cruise Control Use the accelerator pedal to increase your speed When you take your foot off the pedal your vehicle will slow down to the cruise control speed you set earlier Using Cruise Control on Hills How well your cruise control will work on hills depends upon your speed load and the steepness of the hills When going up steep hills you may have to step on the accelerator pedal to maintain your speed When going downhill you may have to brake or shift to a lower gear to keep your speed down Of course applying the brake takes you out of cruise control Many drivers find this to be too much trouble and do not use cruise control on steep hills Ending Cruise Control There are two ways to turn off the cruise control Step lightly on the brake pedal Move
255. hese characters represent the load range and speed rating of the tire The load index represents the load carry capacity a tire is certified to carry The load index can range from 1 to 279 The speed rating is the maximum speed a tire is certified to carry a load Speed ratings range from A to Z Tire Terminology and Definitions Air Pressure The amount of air inside the tire pressing outward on each square inch of the tire Air pressure is expressed in pounds per square inch psi or kiloPascal kPa Accessory Weight This means the combined weight of optional accessories Some examples of optional accessories are automatic transmission power steering power brakes power windows power seats and air conditioning Aspect Ratio The relationship of a tire s height to its width Belt A rubber coated layer of cords that is located between the plies and the tread Cords may be made from steel or other reinforcing materials Bead The tire bead contains steel wires wrapped by steel cords that hold the tire onto the rim Bias Ply Tire A pneumatic tire in which the plies are laid at alternate angles less than 90 degrees to the centerline of the tread Cold Inflation Pressure The amount of air pressure in a tire measured in pounds per square inch psi or kilopascals kPa before a tire has built up heat from driving See Inflation Tire Pressure on page 5 61 Curb Weight This means the weight of a motor vehicle with s
256. hicle To lock the driver s door from the outside with your key insert the key and turn it toward the rear of the vehicle Unlocked doors can be dangerous e Passengers especially children can easily open the doors and fall out of a moving vehicle When a door is locked the handle will not open it You increase the chance of being thrown out of the vehicle in a crash if the doors are not locked So wear safety belts properly and lock the doors whenever you drive Young children who get into unlocked vehicles may be unable to get out A child can be overcome by extreme heat and can suffer permanent injuries or even death from heat stroke Always lock your vehicle whenever you leave it Outsiders can easily enter through an unlocked door when you slow down or stop your vehicle Locking your doors can help prevent this from happening To unlock either manual locking front door from the inside pull back on the manual lever To lock either front door from the inside push the manual lever forward Power Door Locks The power door lock switch is located on the driver s and front passenger s doors next to the door handle t mm Fm s Press the front of the switch to lock all doors or press the back of the switch to unlock all doors The rear doors do not have power door lock switches Instead each rear door has a manual lever that works only that door s lock If your vehicle has the content the
257. hild restraint in different directions to be sure it is secure To remove the child restraint just unbuckle the vehicle s safety belt and let it go back all the way The safety belt will move freely again and be ready to work for an adult or larger child passenger 1 62 Securing a Child Restraint in a Center Rear Seat Position lf your child restraint is equipped with the LATCH system see Lower Anchorages and Top Tethers for Children LATCH System on page 1 58 See Top Strap on page 1 53 if the child restraint has one lf your child restraint does not have the LATCH system you will be using the lap shoulder belt to secure the child restraint in the center rear seating position To secure a child restraint in this position you will use only the lap part of the belt Disconnect the shoulder part of the belt and store it before securing child restraint See Center Rear Passenger Position on page 1 38 If you are using a top strap equipped child restraint in the center rear seat and need to temporarily transport a flat tire for repair move the child restraint to a rear seat outboard position See Securing a Child Restraint in a Rear Outside Seat Position on page 1 60 for more on this including important safety information Be sure to follow the instructions that came with the child restraint Secure the child in the child restraint when and as the instructions say 1 Make the belt as long as possible by tilting the latch
258. hill use the brakes to hold the vehicle in place 2 25 All Wheel Drive If your vehicle has all wheel drive your engine s driving power is sent to all four wheels for extra traction when needed This is like four wheel drive but there is no separate lever or switch to engage or disengage the front axle It is fully automatic and adjusts itself as needed for road conditions You may experience a brief vehicle vibration upon acceleration when driving in slippery conditions This is normal and is an indication that the all wheel drive system is functioning properly Parking Brake The parking brake is located under the instrument panel on the 2 26 driver s side of the vehicle To set the parking brake hold the regular brake pedal down with your right foot and push down on the parking brake pedal with your left foot If the ignition is on the brake system warning light will come on See Brake System Warning Light on page 3 44 To release the parking brake hold the regular brake pedal down with your right foot while you push down on the parking brake pedal with your left foot When you lift your left foot from the parking brake pedal it will pop up to the released position Notice Driving with the parking brake on can overheat the brake system and cause premature wear or damage to brake system parts Verify that the parking brake is fully released and the brake warning light is off before driving If you
259. hold BAND again for two seconds AF OFF will appear on the display The radio will not switch to other stations This function does not apply for XMTM Satellite Radio Service Setting Preset PTYs RDS Only These buttons have factory PTY presets Up to 12 PTYs six FM1 and six FM2 can be programmed on the six numbered pushbuttons by performing the following steps 1 Press BAND to select FM1 or FM2 2 Press the P TYPE button to activate program type select mode P TYPE and the last selected PTY will appear on the display 3 105 3 Turn the P TYPE knob to select a PTY 4 Press and hold one of the six numbered pushbuttons until you hear a beep Whenever that numbered pushbutton is pressed the PTY that was set will return 5 Repeat the steps for each pushbutton RDS Messages ALERT Alert warns of local or national emergencies When an alert announcement comes on the current radio station ALERT will appear on the display You will hear the announcement even if the volume is low or a CD is playing If a CD is playing play will stop during the announcement Alert announcements cannot be turned off ALERT will not be affected by tests of the emergency broadcast system This feature is not supported by all RDS stations 3 106 INFO Information If the current station has a message INFO will appear on the display Press this button to see the message The message may display the artist song title call in
260. ically start if the vehicle is in ACCESSORY ON START or RAP lf a disc is already in the player make sure that the DVD player is on then press the play pause button on the player faceplate or on the remote control Some DVDs will not allow fast forwarding or skipping of the copyright information or the previews Some DVDs will begin playing after the previews have finished lf the DVD does not begin playing at the main title refer to the on screen instructions Stopping and Resuming Playback To stop playing a disc press and release the stop button on the DVD player faceplate or the remote control To resume playback press the play pause button on the DVD player faceplate or the remote control The movie should resume play from where it was last stopped if the disc has not been ejected and the stop button has not been pressed twice on the remote control or the DVD player faceplate If the disc has been ejected or if the stop button has been pressed twice on the remote control or the DVD player faceplate the disc will resume play at the beginning of the disc Ejecting a Disc Press the eject button on the DVD player faceplate to eject the disc There is not an eject button on the remote control If a disc is ejected from the player but not removed the DVD player will reload the disc after a short period of time The disc will be stored in the DVD player The DVD player will not resume play of the disc automaticall
261. icate a problem check and have it repaired if needed What to Use Refer to the Maintenance Schedule to determine what kind of lubricant to use See Recommended Fluids and Lubricants on page 6 12 Bulb Replacement Headlamps Front Turn Signal For the proper type of replacement bulbs see Sidemarker and Parking Lamps Replacement Bulbs on page 5 53 1 Open the hood See Hood Release on page 5 11 For any bulb changing procedure not listed in this for more information section contact your dealer 2 Push in on the headlamp panel and lift up the headlamp retaining clip partway but do not remove Halogen Bulbs Halogen bulbs have pressurized gas inside and can burst if you drop or scratch the bulb You or others could be injured Be sure to read and follow the instructions on the bulb package 3 Remove the wing stud on the upper outboard side of the lamp assembly 4 Unsnap the headlamp assembly by pulling it forward away from the vehicle 5 Disconnect the electrical connector by pulling back on the locking tab located on the electrical connector to separate the two connectors 6 Turn the bulb socket 8 Unhook the electrical connector by lifting up the one quarter of a turn gray tabs and separate the connector from the clockwise bulb base 9 Install the appropriate new bulb into the electrical connector Push the bulb firmly enough so that the gray tabs hook over the tab on the bulb 10 Put the bulb a
262. icle and even make the vehicle fall To help avoid personal injury and vehicle damage be sure to fit the jack lift head into the proper location before raising the vehicle 4 Attach the folding wrench to the jack and turn the wrench clockwise to raise the jack head 3 inches 7 6 cm Raise the vehicle by turning the folding wrench clockwise in the jack Raise the vehicle far enough off the ground so that there is enough room for the spare tire to fit under the wheel well Remove all the wheel nuts and take off the flat tire 5 81 Never use oil or grease on studs or nuts If you do the nuts might come loose Your wheel could fall off causing a serious accident Rust or dirt on the wheel or on the parts to which it is fastened can make the wheel nuts become loose after a time The wheel could come off and cause an accident When you change a wheel remove any rust or dirt from the places where the wheel attaches to the vehicle In an emergency you can use a cloth or a paper towel to do this but be sure to use a scraper or wire brush later if you need to to get all the rust or dirt off 7 Remove any rust or dirt from the wheel bolts mounting surfaces and spare wheel 5 82 8 Lower the vehicle by attaching the folding wrench to the jack and turning the wrench counterclockwise Lower the jack completely Incorrect wheel nuts or improperly tightened wheel nuts can cause the wheel to com
263. icle has a third row seat and the seatback is upright there is an anchor strap located between the third row seatback and cushion to anchor the child restraint for the second row center position bench seat Second Row Center Position Bench Seat with Third Row Seat Folded Down lf the vehicle has a third row seat and the seatback is folded there is an anchor on the back of the third row seat for the second row center position bench seat Third Row Passenger s Side Outside Position There is also a top strap anchor for the third row passenger s side outside position Locate the anchor symbol on the flap of carpet behind the seat Lift up the carpet to access the anchor 1 57 Lower Anchorages and Top Tethers for Children LATCH System Your vehicle has the LATCH system You will find anchors in the second row outside passenger positions This system designed to make installation of child restraints easier does not use the vehicle s safety belts Instead it uses vehicle anchors and child restraint attachments to secure the restraints Some restraints also use another vehicle anchor to secure a top tether strap 1 58 A Lower Anchorage B Lower Anchorage C Top Tether In order to use the LATCH system in your vehicle you need a child restraint designed for that system To assist you in locating the lower anchors for this child restraint system each seating position with the LATCH system has a
264. icult to see through the windshield under certain conditions Interior Plastic Components Use only a mild soap and water solution on a soft cloth or sponge Commercial cleaners may affect the surface finish 5 97 Glass Surfaces Glass should be cleaned often GM Glass Cleaner or a liquid household glass cleaner will remove normal tobacco smoke and dust films on interior glass See Vehicle Care Appearance Materials on page 5 102 Notice If you use abrasive cleaners when cleaning glass surfaces on your vehicle you could scratch the glass and or cause damage to the rear window defogger and the integrated radio antenna When cleaning the glass on your vehicle use only a soft cloth and glass cleaner Care of Safety Belts Keep belts clean and dry Do not bleach or dye safety belts If you do it may severely weaken them In a crash they might not be able to provide adequate protection Clean safety belts only with mild soap and lukewarm water 5 98 Weatherstrips Silicone grease on weatherstrips will make them last longer seal better and not stick or squeak Apply silicone grease with a clean cloth During very cold damp weather frequent application may be required See Recommended Fluids and Lubricants on page 6 12 Washing Your Vehicle The paint finish on the vehicle provides beauty depth of color gloss retention and durability The best way to preserve the vehicle s finish is to keep it clean by washi
265. ild restraints be secured in a rear seat including an infant riding in a rear facing infant seat a child riding in a forward facing child seat and an older child riding in a booster seat Your vehicle has a rear seat that will accommodate a rear facing child restraint A label on your sun visor says Never put a rear facing child seat in the front This is because the risk to the rear facing child is so great if the air bag deploys A child in a rear facing child restraint can be seriously injured or killed if the right front passenger s airbag inflates This is because the back of the rear facing child restraint would be very close to the inflating airbag CAUTION Continued 1 52 Even though the passenger sensing system is designed to turn off the passenger s frontal airbag if the system detects a rear facing child restraint no system is fail safe and no one can guarantee that an airbag will not deploy under some unusual circumstance even though it is turned off General Motors recommends that rear facing child restraints be secured in the rear seat even if the airbag is off If you need to secure a forward facing child restraint in the right front seat always move the front passenger seat as far back as it will go It is better to secure the child restraint ina rear seat Wherever you install it be sure to secure the child restraint properly Keep in mind that an unsecured child restraint can
266. in a rear facing child restraint can be seriously injured or killed if the right front passenger s airbag inflates This is because the back of the rear facing child restraint would be very close to the inflating airbag Do not use a rear facing child restraint in the right front passenger s seat unless the airbag has been turned off If the word OFF or the off symbol is lit on the airbag status indicator it means that the passenger sensing system has turned off the right front passenger s frontal airbag See Passenger Sensing System on page 1 77 for more on this including important safety information If after several seconds all status indicator lights remain on or if there are no lights at all there may be a problem with the lights or the passenger sensing system See your dealer for service If the off indicator and the airbag readiness light ever come on together it means that something may be wrong with the airbag system If this ever happens have the vehicle serviced promptly because an adult size person sitting in the right front passenger seat may not have the protection of the frontal airbag See Airbag Readiness Light on page 3 41 3 43 Brake System Warning Light When the ignition is on the brake system warning light will come on when you set your parking brake The light will stay on if your parking brake doesn t release fully If it stays on after your parking brake is fully released it means you hav
267. in to stop scanning This function is inactive if the front seat passengers are listening to the radio When a cassette tape is playing press the up or the down arrow to go to the next or the previous selection This function is inactive if the front seat passengers are listening to a cassette tape When a CD is playing press the up arrow to go to the next track on the CD Press the down arrow to go to the start of the current track if more than eight seconds have played This function is inactive if the front seat passengers are listening to a CD PWR Power Press this button to turn the system on or off TAPE CD Press this button to switch between playing a cassette tape a CD or a DVD when listening to the radio The inactive tape CD or DVD will remain safely inside the radio for future listening BAND Press this button to switch between FM1 FM2 AM or XM1 or XM2 if equipped If the front passengers are listening to the radio the RSA will not switch between the bands or change the frequency Press BAND to listen to the radio when a cassette tape or a CD is playing The inactive cassette or CD will remain safely inside the radio for future listening 3 131 The BAND button will not access XM Satellite Radio service when the front seat passengers are listening to the RSE system through the vehicle s speakers and the rear seat passengers are using the wired headphones to listen to the RSA system P SET PROG
268. ing antenna wire is attached to the motor head unit Firmly press and release the Learn or Smart button The name and color of the button may vary by manufacturer You will have 30 seconds to start Step 8 8 Return to the vehicle Firmly press and hold the programmed HomeLink button for two seconds then release Repeat the press hold release sequence a second time and depending on the brand of the garage door opener or other rolling code device repeat this sequence a third time to complete the programming HomeLink should now activate your rolling code equipped device To program the remaining two HomeLink buttons begin with Step 2 of Programming HomeLink You do not want to repeat step 1 as this will erase all previous programming Gate Operator and Canadian Programming Canadian radio frequency laws require transmitter signals to time out or quit after several seconds of transmission This may not be long enough for HomeLink to pick up the signal during programming Similarly some U S gate operators are manufactured to time out in the same manner If you live in Canada or you are having difficulty programming a gate operator by using the Programming HomeLink procedures regardless of where you live replace Step 3 under Programming HomeLink with the following Continue to press and hold the HomeLink button while you press and release every two seconds
269. ing broadcast XM Satellite Radio Service XM is a satellite radio service that is based in the 48 contiguous Untied States XM offers 100 coast to coast channels including music news sports talk and children s programming XM provides digital quality audio and text information that includes song title and artist name A service fee is required in order to receive the XM service For more information contact XM at www xmradio com or call 1 800 852 XMXM 9696 3 88 Playing the Radio PWR Power Push this knob to turn the system on and off VOL Volume Turn this knob to increase or to decrease the volume DISP Display Press this button to display the time when the ignition is turned off For XM if equipped press the DISP button while in XM mode to retrieve four different categories of information related to the current song or channel Artist Song Title Category or PTY Channel Number Channel Name To change the default on the display press the DISP button until you see the display you want then hold the button until the display flashes The selected display will now be the default SCV Speed Compensated Volume With SCV the audio system adjusts automatically to make up for road and wind noise as you drive To use SCV press the TUNE AUDIO knob repeatedly until SPEED VOL appears on the display Turn the TUNE AUDIO knob to select MIN MED or MAX Each higher setting will provide
270. ing down See Storing a Flat or Spare Tire and Tools on page 5 88 for instructions on storing the spare tire correctly Before beginning this procedure read all the instructions Failure to read and follow the instructions could damage the hoist assembly and you and others could get hurt Read and follow the instructions listed below To release the spare tire from the secondary latch do the following Someone standing too close during the procedure could be injured by the jack If the spare tire does not slide off the jack completely make sure no one is behind you or on either side of you as you pull the jack out from the spare 1 If the cable is not visible start this procedure at Step 3 All wheel drive Vehicle shown 2 Turn the wrench counterclockwise until approximately 6 inches 15 cm of cable is exposed 5 85 Front wheel drive Vehicle shown Attach the folding wrench to the jack and raise the jack at least 10 turns Place the jack under the vehicle ahead of the rear bumper Position the center lift point of the jack under the center of the spare tire Turn the folding wrench clockwise to raise the jack until it lifts the secondary latch spring Keep raising the jack until the spare tire stops moving upward and is held firmly in place This lets you know that the secondary latch has released and the spare tire is balancing on the jack 5 86 7 Lower the jack by turning
271. ing light stays on longer than normal after you ve started your engine turn the ignition off Or if the light comes on and stays on when you re driving stop as soon as possible and turn the ignition off Then start the engine again to reset the system If the light still stays on or comes on again while you re driving the anti lock brake system needs service and you don t have anti lock brakes The anti lock brake system warning light should come on briefly when you turn the ignition key to ON If the light doesn t come on then have it fixed so it will be ready to warn you if there is a problem Traction Control System TCS Warning Light TRAC OFF United States Canada Your vehicle may have a traction control system warning light The traction control system warning light may come on for the following reasons e If you turn the system off by pressing the TRAC OFF button located in the instrument panel switchbank the warning light will come on and stay on To turn the system back on press the button again The warning light should go off See Traction Control System TCS on page 4 10 for more information Ifthere s an engine related and brake system problem that is specifically related to traction control the traction control system will turn off and the warning light will come on If the traction control system warning light comes on and stays on for an extended period of time when the system is turned on your v
272. ings you need to see when it is dark outside Be sure to keep the HUD image dim and placed low in your field of view If your vehicle has the Head Up Display HUD it can show the speedometer reading in English or metric The current audio system information as well as Rear Seat Entertainment system information may also be displayed and will appear as an image focused out toward the front of your vehicle The HUD is capable of displaying English or French See DIC Controls and Displays on page 3 64 to change the display from English to metric The HUD will display the following lights and messages when they appear on the instrument panel cluster Turn Signal Indicators See Turn Signal Multifunction Lever on page 3 7 High Beam Indicator See Headlamp High Low Beam Changer on page 3 8 Low Fuel Warning Message See Low Fuel Warning Message on page 3 58 The Head Up Display also displays a CHECK GAGES message The following messages could appear on the instrument panel cluster when CHECK GAGES appears Engine Coolant Temperature Warning See Engine Coolant Temperature Warning Message on page 3 52 Low Oil Pressure See Low Oil Pressure Message on page 3 54 Charging System Indicator See Charging System Indicator Message on page 3 53 Low Brake Fluid Warning See Low Brake Fluid Warning Message on page 3 59 3 21 The HUD controls are located to the left of the steering wheel on the instrument panel
273. ints Removes dirt and grime from chrome wheels and wire wheel covers Removes dust fingerprints and surface contaminants Spray on and wipe off Glass Cleaner Chrome and Wire Wheel Cleaner Finish Enhancer 5 102 Description Usage Removes swirl marks fine Swirl Remover Polish scratches and other light surface contamination Removes light scratches Cleans shines and Teri ALS Shine protects in one step No wiping necessary Medium foaming shampoo Cleans and lightly waxes Biodegradable and phosphate free Quickly removes spots F and stains from carpets Spot Lifter vinyl and cloth upholstery Odorless spray odor Odor Eliminator eliminator used on fabrics vinyl leather and carpet See your General Motors parts department for these products See Recommended Fluids and Lubricants on page 6 12 Wash Wax Concentrate Vehicle Identification Vehicle Identification Number VIN SAMPLE4UX1M072675 LE4UX1M This is the legal identifier for your vehicle It appears on a plate in the front corner of the instrument panel on the driver s side You can see it if you look through the windshield from outside your vehicle The VIN also appears on the Vehicle Certification and Service Parts labels and the certificates of title and registration Engine Identification The 8th character in your VIN is the engine code This code will help you identify your engine specifications
274. ints Q What is the proper way to wear safety belts A If possible an older child should wear a Older Children lap shoulder belt and get the additional restraint a shoulder belt can provide The shoulder belt should not cross the face or neck The lap belt should fit snugly below the hips just touching the top of the thighs It should never be worn over the abdomen which could cause severe or even fatal internal injuries in a crash Accident statistics show that children are safer if they are restrained in the rear seat In a crash children who are not buckled up can strike other people who are buckled up or can be thrown out of the vehicle Older children need to use safety belts properly Older children who have outgrown booster seats should wear the vehicle s safety belts 1 43 Never do this Here two children are wearing the same belt The belt can not properly spread the impact forces In a crash the two children can be crushed together and seriously injured A belt must be used by only one person at a time 1 44 Q What if a child is wearing a lap shoulder belt A but the child is so small that the shoulder belt is very close to the child s face or neck If the child is sitting in a seat next to a window move the child toward the center of the vehicle If the child is sitting in the center rear seat passenger position move the child toward the safety belt buckle In either case be sure that
275. io distortion In auxiliary mode the picture moves or scrolls In severe or extreme temperatures the DVD system might not be operable Temperatures below 4 F 20 C or above 140 F 60 C could damage the DVD system Operate the DVD system under normal or comfortable cabin temperature ranges Verify that the headphones are facing to the front of the vehicle left and right sides are indicated on the headphones to ensure that the signal is received properly Check the signal coming from the auxiliary device and make sure that the connection and the signal are good DVD Messages The following errors may be displayed on the video screen Disc Format Error This message will be displayed if a disc is inserted upside down if the disc is not readable or if the disc format is not compatible Disc Play Error This message will be displayed if the mechanism can not play the disc Scratched or damaged discs will cause this error Region Code Error This message will be displayed if the region code of the DVD is not compatible with the region code of the DVD player Load Eject Error This message will be displayed if the disc is not properly loaded or ejected No Disc This message will be displayed when the play button is pressed without a disc in the player DVD Distortion There may be an experience with video distortion when operating cellular phones scanners CB radios Global Position Systems GP
276. ion The letter T as the first character in the tire size means the tire is for temporary use only G TPC Spec Tire Performance Criteria Specification Original equipment tires designed to GM s specific tire performance criteria have a TPC specification code molded onto the sidewall GM s TPC specifications meet or exceed all federal safety guidelines 5 57 Tire Size The following illustration shows an example of a typical passenger vehicle tire size P225 60R16 97S LLU B CDE F A Passenger P Metric Tire The United States version of a metric tire sizing system The letter P as the first character in the tire size means a passenger vehicle tire engineered to standards set by the U S Tire and Rim Association B Tire Width The three digit number indicates the tire section width in millimeters from sidewall to sidewall C Aspect Ratio A two digit number that indicates the tire height to width measurements For example if the tire size aspect ratio is 60 as shown in item C of the illustration it would mean that the tire s sidewall is 60 percent as high as it is wide 5 58 D Construction Code A letter code is used to indicate the type of ply construction in the tire The letter R means radial ply construction the letter D means diagonal or bias ply construction and the letter B means belted bias ply construction E Rim Diameter Diameter of the wheel in inches F Service Description T
277. ion and release the safety belt as described in Center Rear Passenger Position on page 1 38 Make sure that the shoulder belt crosses the shoulder To remove and store the elastic cord remove it from the comfort guide The elastic cord will go back under the head restraint 1 42 Safety Belt Pretensioners Your vehicle has safety belt pretensioners Although you cannot see them they are located on the retractor part of the safety belts for the driver and right front passenger They help the safety belts reduce a person s forward movement in a moderate to severe frontal or near frontal crash Pretensioners work only once If they activate in a crash you will need to get new ones and probably other new parts for your safety belt system See Replacing Restraint System Parts After a Crash on page 1 83 Safety Belt Extender If the vehicle s safety belt will fasten around you you should use it But if a safety belt is not long enough your dealer will order you an extender It is free When you go in to order it take the heaviest coat you will wear so the extender will be long enough for you To help avoid personal injury do not let someone else use it and use it only for the seat it is made to fit The extender has been designed for adults Never use it for securing child seats To wear it just attach it to the regular safety belt For more information see the instruction sheet that comes with the extender Child Restra
278. irst time When the ignition is turned off the blinking red light indicates that THEFTLOCK is armed If THEFTLOCK is activated the radio will not operate if stolen The radio will display LOCKED and a red LED indicator light will come on above the key symbol to indicate a locked condition If this occurs the radio will need to be returned to your GM dealer Audio Steering Wheel Controls If your vehicle has this feature some audio controls can be adjusted at the steering wheel They include the following SOURCE When listening to the radio press this button to play a cassette tape CD or a DVD if equipped If a cassette tape and CD and or DVD are loaded the system will go to the tape play first The inactive tape CD or DVD will remain safely inside the player for future listening MUTE Press this button to silence the system Press it again or any other radio button to turn the sound on A voL Y Volume Press the up or down arrow to increase or decrease the volume A SEEK Press the up or the down arrow to go to the next or to the previous station and stay there The sound will mute while seeking The radio will only seek stations with a strong signal that are in the selected band When playing a cassette tape or a CD press the up arrow to go to the next selection BAND Press this button to switch between FM1 FM2 AM or XM1 or XM2 if equipped SCAN Press this button to scan the statio
279. is being updated and code no action is required This process should take no longer than 30 seconds No Signal Loss of signal The system is functioning correctly but the vehicle is in a location that is blocking the XM signal When you move into an open area the signal should return Loading XM Acquiring channel audio The audio system is acquiring and processing audio and text after 4 second delay data No action is needed This message should disappear shortly CH Off Air Channel not in service This channel is not currently in service Tune to another channel CH Unavail Channel no longer This previously assigned channel is no longer assigned available Tune to another station If this station was one of the presets choose another station for that preset button No Info Artist Name Feature not No artist information is available at this time on this channel available The system is working properly No Info Song Program Title not No song title information is available at this time on this available channel The system is working properly 3 94 XM Radio Messages cont d Radio Display No Info Category Name not No category information is available at this time on this available channel The system is working properly No Info No Text Informational No text or informational messages are available at this time message available on this channel The system is working properly Not Found No channel available for There are no channel
280. is symbol indicates that the oil has been certified by the American Petroleum Institute API You should look for this information on the oil container SAE 5W 30 and use only those oils that are identified as meeting GM Standard GM6094M and have the starburst symbol on the front of the oil container COLD WEATHER DO NOT USE SAE 10W 40 SAE 20W 50 OR ANY OTHER VISCOSITY GRADE OIL NOT RECOMMENDED Notice Use only engine oil identified as meeting GM Standard GM6094M and showing the American Petroleum Institute Certified For Gasoline Engines starburst symbol Failure to use the recommended oil can result in engine damage not covered by your warranty GM Goodwrench oil meets all the requirements for your vehicle lf you are in an area of extreme cold where the temperature falls below 20 F 29 C it is recommended that you use either an SAE 5W 30 synthetic oil or an SAE OW 30 oil Both will provide easier cold starting and better protection for your engine at extremely low temperatures Engine Oil Additives Do not add anything to your oil The recommended oils with the starburst symbol that meet GM Standard GM6094M are all you will need for good performance and engine protection Engine Oil Life System When to Change Engine Oil Your vehicle has a computer system that lets you know when to change the engine oil and filter This is based on engine revolutions and engine temperature and not on mileage Based o
281. isplay To play a specific CD first press the CD AUX button then press the numbered pushbutton that corresponds to the CD A small bar will appear under the CD number that is playing and the track number will appear If an error appears on the display see CD Messages later in this section LOAD CD amp Eject Press the CD eject side of this button to eject a CD s You will hear a beep and the indicator light will flash to let you know when a CD is being ejected REMOVE CD will appear on the display The CD can be remove If the CD is not removed after 25 seconds the CD will be automatically pulled back into the player If the CD is pushed back into the player before the 25 second time period is complete the player will sense an error and will try to eject the CD several times before stopping Do not repeatedly press the CD eject button to eject a CD after trying to push it in manually The player s 25 second eject timer will reset at each press of eject causing the player to not eject the CD until the 25 second time period has elapsed Once the player stops and the CD is ejected remove the CD After removing the CD push the PWR knob off and then on again or wait for the system to reset This will clear the CD sensing feature and enable CDs to be loaded into the player again lt REV Reverse Press and hold this button to reverse quickly within a track You will hear sound at a reduced volume Release this
282. it After you move the shift lever into PARK P hold the regular brake pedal down Then see if you can move the shift lever away from PARK P without first pulling it toward you If you can it means that the shift lever was not fully locked into PARK P 2 27 Torque Lock If you are parking on a hill and you do not shift your vehicle into PARK P properly the weight of the vehicle may put too much force on the parking pawl in the transaxle You may find it difficult to pull the shift lever out of PARK P This is called torque lock To prevent torque lock set the parking brake and then shift into PARK P properly before you leave the driver s seat To find out how see Shifting Into Park P on page 2 27 When you are ready to drive move the shift lever out of PARK P before you release the parking brake If torque lock does occur you may need to have another vehicle push yours a little uphill to take some of the pressure from the parking pawl in the transaxle so you can pull the shift lever out of PARK P 2 28 Shifting Out of Park P Your vehicle has an automatic transaxle shift lock control system which locks the shift lever in PARK P when the ignition is in the OFF position In addition you must fully apply your regular brakes before you can shift from PARK P when the ignition is in the ON position See Automatic Transaxle Operation on page 2 23 If you cannot shift out of PARK P ease pressure on
283. it could move forward in a sudden stop or crash That could cause injury to the person sitting there Always press rearward on the seatback to be sure it is locked A seat that is not locked into place properly can move around in a collision or sudden stop People in the vehicle could be injured Be sure to lock the seat into place properly when installing it Make sure that the seatback is folded forward before beginning this procedure 1 Remove the nuts from the screws 2 Place the stowable seat on the vehicle floor so that the brackets are placed over the screws A safety belt that is improperly routed not properly attached or twisted will not provide the protection needed in a crash The person 3 Reinstall the nuts back onto the screws Torque to wearing the belt could be seriously injured approximately 18 Ib ft 25 Nem After installing the seat always check to be 4 Try to raise the seat to make sure that it is sure that the safety belts are properly routed locked down and attached and are not twisted 5 Raise the seatback to its upright position Push and pull on the seatback to make sure that it is locked into place Do not put the stowable seat in so that it faces rearward The stowable seat has to go in before the rear convenience center See Rear Convenience Center on page 2 44 for more information The stowable seat has seat position labels located on the back of the seat showing where the seat
284. ith aluminum or chrome plated wheels through an automatic car wash that uses silicone carbide tire cleaning brushes Do not take your vehicle through an automatic car wash that has silicone carbide tire cleaning brushes These brushes can also damage the surface of these wheels Tires To clean the tires use a stiff brush with tire cleaner Notice Using petroleum based tire dressing products on your vehicle may damage the paint finish and or tires When applying a tire dressing always wipe off any overspray from all painted surfaces on your vehicle Sheet Metal Damage lf the vehicle is damaged and requires sheet metal repair or replacement make sure the body repair shop applies anti corrosion material to parts repaired or replaced to restore corrosion protection Original manufacturer replacement parts will provide the corrosion protection while maintaining the warranty Finish Damage Any stone chips fractures or deep scratches in the finish should be repaired right away Bare metal will corrode quickly and may develop into major repair expense Minor chips and scratches can be repaired with touch up materials available from your GM dealer Larger areas of finish damage can be corrected in your GM dealer s body and paint shop Underbody Maintenance Chemicals used for ice and snow removal and dust control can collect on the underbody If these are not removed corrosion and rust can develop on the underbody parts suc
285. ith this The shoulder belt is worn under the arm It should be worn over the shoulder at all times You can be seriously injured if you wear the shoulder belt under your arm In a crash your body would move too far forward which would increase the chance of head and neck injury Also the belt would apply too much force to the ribs which are not as strong as shoulder bones You could also severely injure internal organs like your liver or spleen 1 31 Q What is wrong with this You can be seriously injured by a twisted belt In a crash you would not have the full width of the belt to spread impact forces If a belt is twisted make it straight so it can work properly or ask your dealer to fix it A The belt is twisted across the body 1 32 To unlatch the belt just push the button on the buckle The belt should go back out of the way Before you close the door be sure the belt is out of the way If you slam the door on it you can damage both the belt and your vehicle Shoulder Belt Height Adjustment Before you begin to drive move the shoulder belt adjuster to the height that is right for you To move it down push down on the button and move the height adjuster to the desired position You can move the adjuster up just by pushing up on the shoulder belt guide After you move the adjuster to where you want it try to move it down without pushing the butt
286. k for any opened or broken airbag covers and have them repaired or replaced The airbag system does not need regular maintenance Replacing Restraint System Parts After a Crash A crash can damage the restraint systems in your vehicle A damaged restraint system may not properly protect the person using it resulting in serious injury or even death in a crash To help make sure your restraint systems are working properly after a crash have them inspected and any necessary replacements made as soon as possible If you have had a crash do you need new belts or LATCH system parts After a very minor collision nothing may be necessary But if the belts were stretched as they would be if worn during a more severe crash then you need new parts 1 83 If the LATCH system was being used during a more severe crash you may need new LATCH system parts If belts are cut or damaged replace them Collision damage also may mean you will need to have LATCH system safety belt or seat parts repaired or replaced New parts and repairs may be necessary even if the belt or LATCH system was not being used at the time of the collision If an airbag inflates you will need to replace airbag system parts See the part on the airbag system earlier in this section If the frontal airbags inflate you will also need to replace the driver and front passenger s safety belt retractor assembly Be sure to do so Then the new retractor assemb
287. k properly You may have to replace the airbag module in the steering wheel both the airbag module and the instrument panel for the right front passenger s airbag or both the airbag module and seatback for the driver s and right front passenger s side impact airbag Do not open or break the airbag coverings Passenger Sensing System Your vehicle has a passenger sensing system The passenger airbag status indicator in the rearview mirror will be visible when you turn your ignition key to ON or START The words ON and OFF or the symbol for on and off will be visible during the system check When the system check is complete either the word ON or the word OFF or the symbol for on or the symbol for off will be visible See Passenger Airbag Status Indicator on page 3 42 PASSENGER AIR BAG ogame ON Passenger Airbag Status Indicator United States ib Rho Passenger Airbag Status Indicator Canada 1 77 The passenger sensing system will turn off the right front passenger s frontal airbag under certain conditions The driver s airbag and the side airbags are not part of the passenger sensing system The passenger sensing system works with sensors that are part of the right front passenger s seat and safety belt The sensors are designed to detect the presence of a properly seated occupant and determine if the passenger s frontal airbag should be enabled may inflate or not Accident statistics show that children
288. kes Both control systems steering and braking have to do their work where the tires meet the road Unless you have four wheel anti lock brakes adding the hard braking can demand too much of those places You can lose control The same thing can happen if you are steering through a sharp curve and you suddenly accelerate Those two control systems steering and acceleration can overwhelm those places where the tires meet the road and make you lose control See Traction Control System TCS on page 4 10 What should you do if this ever happens Ease up on the brake or accelerator pedal steer the vehicle the way you want it to go and slow down Speed limit signs near curves warn that you should adjust your speed Of course the posted speeds are based on good weather and road conditions Under less favorable conditions you will want to go slower If you need to reduce your speed as you approach a curve do it before you enter the curve while your front wheels are straight ahead Try to adjust your speed so you can drive through the curve Maintain a reasonable steady speed Wait to accelerate until you are out of the curve and then accelerate gently into the straightaway Steering in Emergencies There are times when steering can be more effective than braking For example you come over a hill and find a truck stopped in your lane or a car suddenly pulls out from nowhere or a child darts out from between
289. label Do not load your vehicle any heavier than the Gross Vehicle Weight Rating GVWR or either the maximum front or rear Gross Axle Weight Rating GAWR If you do parts on your vehicle can break and it can change the way your vehicle handles These could cause you to lose control and crash Also overloading can shorten the life of your vehicle 4 31 Tire and Loading Information Label SEATING CAPACITY TTOTAL FRONT GEN TOTAL SEATING CAPACITY T TOTAL FRONT GEN MANUAL FOR ADDITIONAL INFORMATION Example Label A vehicle specific Tire and Loading Information label is attached to the center pillar B pillar of your vehicle With the driver s door open you will find the label attached below the door lock post striker The tire and loading information label shows the number of occupant seating positions A and the maximum vehicle capacity weight B in kilograms and pounds 4 32 The Tire and Loading Information label also shows the size of the original equipment tires C and the recommended cold tire inflation pressures D For more information on tires and inflation see Tires on page 5 55 and Inflation Tire Pressure on page 5 61 There is also important loading information on the vehicle Certification Tire label It tells you the Gross Vehicle Weight Rating GVWR and the Gross Axle Weight Rating GAWR for the front and rear axle See Certification Tire Label later in this section Steps
290. ld be blown Do not hold a cigarette lighter in while it is heating Do not use anything other than the cigarette lighter in the heating element Notice If you put papers or other flammable items in the ashtray hot cigarettes or other smoking materials could ignite them and possibly damage your vehicle Never put flammable items in the ashtray 3 27 Climate Controls Climate Control System With this system you can control the heating cooling and ventilation for your vehicle Operation Turn the right knob clockwise or counterclockwise to direct the airflow inside your vehicle To change the current mode select one of the following zi Vent This mode directs air to the instrument panel outlets 3 28 Wi Bi Level This mode directs half of the air to the instrument panel outlets then directs the remaining air to the floor outlets Cooler air is directed to the upper outlets and warmer air to the floor outlets Wi Floor This mode directs most of the air to the floor outlets Use this mode to send air to the rear of the vehicle Keep the area under the front seats free of objects that could obstruct airflow to the rear of the vehicle The right knob can also be used to select defog or defrost mode For more information see Defogging and Defrosting later in this section Fan Turn the left knob clockwise or counterclockwise to increase or decrease the fan speed Turn the knob to 0
291. le have someone guide you Making Turns Notice Making very sharp turns while trailering could cause the trailer to come in contact with the vehicle Your vehicle could be damaged Avoid making very sharp turns while trailering When you are turning with a trailer make wider turns than normal Do this so your trailer will not strike soft shoulders curbs road signs trees or other objects Avoid jerky or sudden maneuvers Signal well in advance 4 43 Turn Signals When Towing a Trailer When you tow a trailer your vehicle has to have extra wiring The arrows on your instrument panel will flash whenever you signal a turn or lane change Properly hooked up the trailer lamps will also flash telling other drivers you are about to turn change lanes or stop When towing a trailer the arrows on your instrument panel will flash for turns even if the bulbs on the trailer are burned out Thus you may think drivers behind you are seeing your signal when they are not It is important to check occasionally to be sure the trailer bulbs are still working Driving On Grades Reduce speed and shift to a lower gear before you start down a long or steep downgrade If you do not shift down you might have to use your brakes so much that they would get hot and no longer work well If you are towing a trailer that weighs more than 1 000 Ibs 450 kg drive in AUTOMATIC OVERDRIVE D or as you need to a lower gear This will minimiz
292. le Arbitration Plan CAMVAP The BBB Auto Line Program is an out of court program administered by the Council of Better Business Bureaus to settle automotive disputes regarding vehicle repairs or the interpretation of the New Vehicle Limited Warranty Although you may be required to resort to this informal dispute resolution program prior to filing a court action use of the program is free of charge and your case will generally be heard within 40 days If you do not agree with the decision given in your case you may reject it and proceed with any other venue for relief available to you You may contact the BBB Auto Line Program using the toll free telephone number or write them at the following address BBB Auto Line Program Council of Better Business Bureaus Inc 4200 Wilson Boulevard Suite 800 Arlington VA 22203 1838 Telephone 1 800 955 5100 This program is available in all 50 states and the District of Columbia Eligibility is limited by vehicle age mileage and other factors General Motors reserves the right to change eligibility limitations and or discontinue its participation in this program Online Owner Center The Owner Center is a resource for your GM ownership needs Specific vehicle information can be found in one place The Online Owner Center allows you to Get e mail service reminders Access information about your specific vehicle including tips and videos and an electronic version of this owner
293. ler that appears later in this section But trailering is different than just driving your vehicle by itself Trailering means changes in handling acceleration braking durability and fuel economy Successful safe trailering takes correct equipment and it has to be used properly That is the reason for this section In it are many time tested important trailering tips and safety rules Many of these are important for your safety and that of your passengers So please read this section carefully before you pull a trailer Load pulling components such as the engine transaxle wheel assemblies and tires are forced to work harder against the drag of the added weight The engine is required to operate at relatively higher speeds and under greater loads generating extra heat The trailer also adds considerably to wind resistance increasing the pulling requirements If You Do Decide To Pull A Trailer If you do here are some important points There are many different laws including speed limit restrictions having to do with trailering Make sure your rig will be legal not only where you live but also where you will be driving A good source for this information can be state or provincial police Consider using a sway control See Hitches later in this section Do not tow a trailer at all during the first 500 miles 800 km your new vehicle is driven Your engine axle or other parts could be damaged During the
294. ll be set whenever a CD is played For more information on AUTO EQ see AUTO EQ listed previously in this section K SEEK gt I Press the left arrow to go to the start of the current track if more than ten seconds have played Press the right arrow to go to the next track If either arrow is held or pressed more than once the player will continue moving backward or forward through the CD K SCAN gt To scan one CD press and hold either SCAN arrow for more than two seconds until SCAN appears on the display and you hear a beep Use this feature to listen to 10 seconds of each track of the currently selected CD Press either SCAN arrow again to stop scanning To scan all loaded CDs press and hold either SCAN arrow for more than four seconds until CD SCAN appears on the display and you hear a beep Use this feature to listen to 10 seconds of the first track of each loaded CD Press either SCAN arrow again to stop scanning RCL Recall Press this knob to see how long the current track has been playing To change the default on the display track and elapsed time press the knob until you see the display you want then hold the knob until the display flashes The selected display will now be the default BAND Press this button to play the radio when a CD is playing The inactive CD s will remain safely inside the radio for future listening CD AUX Auxiliary Press this button to play a CD when listening to the radio
295. ll numeric inputs 3 Backlight Press this button to turn the remote control backlighting on 3 123 Main Menu Press this button to view the media menu The media menu is different on every disc Use the up down right and left arrow buttons to move the cursor around the media menu After making a selection press the enter button Enter Press this button to select the choice that is highlighted in any menu amp gt Return Press this button to go back one step in any menu Press this button to exit the current menu and to move to the previous menu This button will operate only when a DVD is playing and or a menu is active Ga Camera This button changes camera angles on DVDs that have this feature Press this button to display a menu that will operate only when a DVD is being played The format and content of this function will vary for each disc Subtitles This button turns on subtitles and moves through subtitle options English Spanish French etc if available Press this button to call up a menu that will operate only when a DVD is being played The format and content of this function will vary for each disc 3 124 Fast Forward Press this button to fast forward the DVD To stop fast forwarding press this button again This button may not work when the DVD is playing the copyright information or the previews gt Play Pause Press this button to start play of a DVD or CD
296. llision There is something else about drinking and driving that many people do not know Medical research shows that alcohol in a person s system can make crash injuries worse especially injuries to the brain spinal cord or heart This means that when anyone who has been drinking driver or passenger is in a crash that person s chance of being killed or permanently disabled is higher than if the person had not been drinking Drinking and then driving is very dangerous Your reflexes perceptions attentiveness and judgment can be affected by even a small amount of alcohol You can have a serious or even fatal collision if you drive after drinking Please do not drink and drive or ride with a driver who has been drinking Ride home in a cab or if you are with a group designate a driver who will not drink Control of a Vehicle You have three systems that make your vehicle go where you want it to go They are the brakes the steering and the accelerator All three systems have to do their work at the places where the tires meet the road Sometimes as when you are driving on snow or ice it is easy to ask more of those control systems than the tires and road can provide That means you can lose control of your vehicle See Traction Control System TCS on page 4 10 Braking Braking action involves perception time and reaction time First you have to decide to push on the brake pedal That is perceptio
297. loose after a time The wheel could come off and cause an accident When you change a wheel remove any rust or dirt from places where the wheel attaches to the vehicle In an emergency you can use a cloth or a paper towel to do this but be sure to use a scraper or wire brush later if you need to to get all the rust or dirt off See Changing a Flat Tire on page 5 72 When It Is Time for New Tires One way to tell when it s time for new tires is to check the treadwear indicators which will appear when your tires have only 1 16 inch 1 6 mm or less of tread remaining You need a new tire if any of the following statements are true You can see the indicators at three or more places around the tire You can see cord or fabric showing through the tire s rubber The tread or sidewall is cracked cut or snagged deep enough to show cord or fabric The tire has a bump bulge or split The tire has a puncture cut or other damage that can t be repaired well because of the size or location of the damage 5 65 Buying New Tires To find out what kind and size of tires your vehicle needs look at the tire and loading information label For more information about this label and its location on your vehicle see Loading Your Vehicle on page 4 31 The tires installed on your vehicle when it was new had a Tire Performance Criteria Specification TPC Spec number on each tire s sidewall When you get new tires GM
298. lowing conditions are met The ignition is turned to OFF The exterior lamp control is in the AUTO position UNLOCK is pressed on the remote keyless entry transmitter e It is dark enough outside After 25 seconds the headlamps and parking lamps will turn off The lamps will turn off before the 25 seconds if you do one of the following Turn the ignition to ON Turn the exterior lamp control out of the AUTO position If your vehicle is equipped with the Driver Information Center DIC you can program this feature on or off See Lock Feedback under DIC Vehicle Personalization on page 3 66 Front Reading Lamps There are two reading lamps located on the rearview mirror To turn either reading lamp on or off press the button located next to each lamp These lamps will come on each time you open the doors if the interior lamp control is in the ON or DOOR position Rear Reading Lamps There are two reading lamps with coat hooks above the rear doors To turn on or off either reading lamp press the lens of the lamp Cargo Lamp The cargo lamp is located in the rear of the vehicle above the liftgate opening It comes on automatically each time you open the doors if the interior lamp control is in the DOOR position There are two reading lamps located on the cargo lamp To turn either reading lamp on or off press the button located next to the lamp 3 19 Battery Run Down Protection Your vehicl
299. lowing steps 1 Turn the CD player on 2 Press the SONG LIST button to turn song list on S LIST will appear on the display 3 Press the SEEK SCAN arrows to select the desired track to be deleted 4 Press and hold the SONG LIST button for two seconds When SONG LIST is pressed one beep will be heard immediately After two seconds of continuously pressing the SONG LIST button two beeps will be heard to confirm that the track has been deleted After a track has been deleted the remaining tracks are moved up the list When another track is added to the song list the track will be added to the end of the list To delete the entire song list perform the following steps 1 Turn the CD player on 2 Press the SONG LIST button to turn song list on S LIST will appear on the display 3 Press and hold the SONG LIST button for more than four seconds One beep will be heard followed by two beeps after two seconds and a final beep will be heard after four seconds S LIST EMPTY will appear on the display indicating the song list has been deleted 3 114 If a CD is ejected and the song list contains saved tracks from that CD those tracks are automatically deleted from the song list Any tracks saved to the song list again are added to the bottom of the list To end song list mode press the SONG LIST button One beep will be heard and S LIST will be removed from the display CD Messages CHECK CD If this message appe
300. ly in OFF face noa E Contact your GM Goodwrench dealer if service is 2 Firmly apply the parking brake See Parking Brake required on page 2 26 if necessary Be ready to apply the regular brake immediately if the vehicle begins to move Parking Brake and Automatic Transaxle Park P Mechanism Check When you are doing this check your vehicle could begin to move You or others could be injured and property could be damaged Make sure there is room in front of your vehicle in case it begins to roll Be ready to apply the regular brake at once should the vehicle begin to move Park on a fairly steep hill with the vehicle facing downhill Keeping your foot on the regular brake set the parking brake To check the parking brake s holding ability With the engine running and transaxle in NEUTRAL N slowly remove foot pressure from the regular brake pedal Do this until the vehicle is held by the parking brake only To check the PARK P mechanism s holding ability With the engine running shift to PARK P Then release the parking brake followed by the regular brake Contact your GM Goodwrench dealer if service is required Underbody Flushing Service At least every spring use plain water to flush any corrosive materials from the underbody Take care to clean thoroughly any areas where mud and other debris can collect Recommended Fluids and Lubricants Fluids and lubricants identified below by name p
301. ly will be there to help protect you in a collision 1 84 After a crash you may need to replace the driver and front passenger s safety belt retractor assemblies even if the frontal airbags have not deployed The driver and front passenger s safety belt retractor assemblies contain the safety belt pretensioners Have your safety belt pretensioners checked if your vehicle has been in a collision or if your airbag readiness light stays on after you start your vehicle or while you are driving See Airbag Readiness Light on page 3 41 Section 2 Features and Controls KEVS ceca arrene a neger 2 3 Remote Keyless Entry System W dsseeeeree 2 5 Remote Keyless Entry System Operation 2 6 Doors and LOCKS scierie erent ee ENE 2 8 DOOR LOCKS aa sg Si eE eee EE 2 8 Power Door LOCKS ececeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeees 2 9 Delayed LOCKING 2e0s visesscednae ties ieeie seeatiecewsieyd 2 9 Programmable Automatic Door Locks 2 10 Rear Door Security Locks eeeeeeeeneee ees 2 10 Lockout Protection vic sever uno ates eedesevdenaatt 2 11 PMG ALG sas EE E E E T E EE E TEE BESES JE 2 11 WINGOW Stara Rest sea O OEN 2 13 Power Windows sssseeeeeeeee eee erne nerne 2 14 SUM VIS OS ernea rener reel 2 15 Theft Deterrent Systems sssseeeerereee 2 15 Content Theft Deterrent ssssseeeeeeree 2 15 PASS Key iis scctccootc tidus biore EES 2 17 PASS Key III Opera
302. m with a negative ground both vehicles can be damaged Only use vehicles with 12 volt systems with negative grounds to jump start your vehicle 2 Get the vehicles close enough so the jumper cables can reach but be sure the vehicles are not touching each other If they are it could cause a ground connection you do not want You would not be able to start your vehicle and the bad grounding could damage the electrical systems To avoid the possibility of the vehicles rolling set the parking brake firmly on both vehicles involved in the jump starting procedure Put an automatic transaxle in PARK P or a manual transaxle in NEUTRAL before setting the parking brake Notice If you leave your radio or other accessories on during the jump starting procedure they could be damaged The repairs would not be covered by your warranty Always turn off your radio and other accessories when jump starting your vehicle 3 Turn off the ignition on both vehicles Unplug unnecessary accessories plugged into the cigarette lighter or the accessory power outlet s Turn off the radios and all lamps that are not needed This will avoid sparks and help save both batteries And it could save the radio 4 Open the hood on the other vehicle and locate the positive and negative terminal locations on that vehicle You will not need to access your battery for jump starting Your vehicle has a remote positive jump starting terminal for that
303. may not be as good and your engine may not run as smoothly This could lead to costly repairs that may not be covered by your warranty Notice Modifications made to the engine transaxle exhaust intake or fuel system of your vehicle or the replacement of the original tires with other than those of the same Tire Performance Criteria TPC can affect your vehicle s emission controls and may cause this light to come on Modifications to these systems could lead to costly repairs not covered by your warranty This may also result in a failure to pass a required Emission Inspection Maintenance test This light should come on as a check to show you it is working when the ignition is on and the engine is not running If the light does not come on have it repaired This light will also come on during a malfunction in one of two ways Light Flashing A misfire condition has been detected A misfire increases vehicle emissions and may damage the emission control system on your vehicle Diagnosis and service may be required Light On Steady An emission control system malfunction has been detected on your vehicle Diagnosis and service may be required If the Light Is Flashing The following may prevent more serious damage to your vehicle e Reducing vehicle speed Avoiding hard accelerations Avoiding steep uphill grades e If you are towing a trailer reduce the amount of cargo being hauled as soon as it is possible
304. met A door is opened then closed The interior lamp control is in the DOOR position The ignition is in OFF After 25 seconds the interior lamps will fade out The lamps will fade out before the 25 seconds if you do one of the following Turn the ignition to ON Press LOCK on the remote keyless entry transmitter Press the front of the power door lock switch If your vehicle is equipped with the Driver Information Center DIC you can program this feature on or off See DIC Vehicle Personalization on page 3 66 Exit Lighting If your vehicle is equipped with exit lighting the interior lamps will come on for about 30 seconds whenever you remove the key from the ignition if the following conditions are met The vehicle is in PARK P The key is out of the ignition The interior lamp control is in the DOOR position All of the doors are closed After 30 seconds the interior lamps will fade out The interior lamps will fade out before 30 seconds if you do one of the following Turn the ignition to ON Press LOCK on the remote keyless entry transmitter Press the front of the power door lock switch If your vehicle is equipped with the Driver Information Center DIC you can program this feature on or off See DIC Vehicle Personalization on page 3 66 Perimeter Lighting If your vehicle has perimeter lighting it will turn on the headlamps and parking lamps for 25 seconds when the fol
305. mitter 2 35 Questions and Answers About Safety Belts 1 24 R Radiator Pressure Cap ceeceeeeeeeeeeeeeee eee ees 5 28 Radios iar Sic ncniat a i lene 3 75 Care of Your Cassette Tape Player 3 134 Care of Your CD and DVD Player 3 135 Care of Your CDs and DVDs o ae 3 135 Navigation Radio System 0 ceeeeeeeeeeeeees 3 130 Radio with Cassette and CD l 3 87 Radio with OD since ictctets canepoianaidgetaeseteiesnyacet 3 76 Radio with Six Disc CD cceeeeeeeeeee eee 3 100 Rear Seat Audio ceeeeeeeeee teense een eeaes 3 130 Setting the Time cceceeceeeeeeeeeeee eee ees 3 76 Theft DeterreRt 3 neuer rr ERE AE rnin 3 132 Understanding Reception cece 3 134 Rear Door Security LOCKS ceeceeeeeeeeeeeee ees 2 10 Rear Hatch Ajar Warning Message 655 3 56 11 Rear Reading Lamps e eeeeeceeeeeeeeeeeees 3 19 Rear Safety Belt Comfort Guides 5 1 40 Rear Seat Audio RSA ceceeeeeeeeeneeaeenes 3 130 Rear Seat Entertainment System 00 3 115 Rear Seat Operation ceceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeneeeeee 1 8 Rear Seat Passengers Safety Belts 1 34 Rear Storage Area ceeceeeeeeeeeeeeneee een eeeeeneees 2 40 Rearview Mirrors 0 0scececeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeaeaeaes 2 31 Reclining Seatbacks cceeeeeeeneeeeeeeeeeeneeeees 1 6 Re
306. more volume compensation at faster vehicle speeds To turn SCV off press the TUNE AUDIO knob repeatedly until SPEED VOL appears on the display Turn the TUNE AUDIO knob until OFF appears on the display Finding a Station BAND Press this button to switch between FM1 FM2 AM or XM1 or XM2 if equipped The display will show the selection TUNE Turn this knob to select radio stations K SEEK Press the right or the left arrow to go to the next or to the previous station and stay there To scan stations press and hold either SEEK arrow for two seconds until SCAN appears on the display The radio will go to a station play for a few seconds then go on to the next station Press either SEEK arrow again to stop scanning To scan preset stations press and hold either SEEK arrow for more than four seconds until SCAN and the preset number appear on the display and you hear a double beep The radio will go to the first preset station play for a few seconds then go on to the next preset station Press either SEEK arrow again to stop scanning presets The radio will only seek and scan stations with a strong signal that are in the selected band 3 89 Setting Preset Stations Up to 30 stations six FM1 six FM2 and six AM six XM1 and six XM2 if equipped can be programmed on the six numbered pushbuttons by performing the following steps 1 Turn the radio on 2 Press BAND to select FM1 FM2 AM or XM1 or XM2
307. mpatible with the accessory power outlet and could result in blown vehicle or adapter fuses If you experience a problem see your dealer for additional information on the accessory power outlets Notice Adding any electrical equipment to your vehicle may damage it or keep other components from working as they should The repairs would not be covered by your warranty Check with your dealer before adding electrical equipment When adding electrical equipment be sure to follow the proper installation instructions included with the equipment Notice Improper use of the power outlet can cause damage not covered by your warranty Do not hang any type of accessory or accessory bracket from the plug because the power outlets are designed for accessory power plugs only Ashtrays and Cigarette Lighter The ashtray is located on the floor console closest to the instrument panel Lift the lid to expose the ashtray To remove the ashtray lift it up The cigarette lighter is located on the floor console in the cell phone storage compartment closest to the driver s seat Lift the lid to expose the cigarette lighter To use the lighter push it in all the way and let go When it is ready it will pop back out by itself Notice Holding a cigarette lighter in while it is heating will not allow the lighter to back away from the heating element when it is hot Damage from overheating may occur to the lighter or heating element or a fuse cou
308. much heat e Tire overloading Premature or irregular wear Poor handling e Reduced fuel economy If your tires have too much air over inflation you can get the following Unusual wear Poor handling Rough ride Needless damage from road hazards A Tire and Loading Information label is attached to the vehicle s center pillar B pillar below the driver s door latch This label shows your vehicle s original equipment tires and the correct inflation pressures for your tires when they are cold The recommended cold tire inflation pressure shown on the label is the minimum amount of air pressure needed to support your vehicle s maximum load carrying capacity For additional information regarding how much weight your vehicle can carry and an example of the tire and loading information label see Loading Your Vehicle on page 4 31 How you load your vehicle affects vehicle handling and ride comfort never load your vehicle with more weight than it was designed to carry When to Check Check your tires once a month or more Do not forget to check the compact spare tire it should be at 60 psi 420 kPa For additional information regarding the compact spare tire see Compact Spare Tire on page 5 94 5 61 How to Check Use a good quality pocket type gage to check tire pressure You cannot tell if your tires are properly inflated simply by looking at them Radial tires may look properly inflated even whe
309. must go The seat must be placed in the proper location for the legs to attach correctly Safety Belts Safety Belts They Are for Everyone This part of the manual tells you how to use safety belts properly It also tells you some things you should not do with safety belts It is extremely dangerous to ride in a cargo area inside or outside of a vehicle In a collision people riding in these areas are more likely to be seriously injured or killed Do not allow people to ride in any area of your vehicle that is not equipped with seats and safety belts Be sure everyone in your vehicle is in a seat and using a safety belt properly Do not let anyone ride where he or she can not wear a safety belt properly If you are in a crash and you are not wearing a safety belt your injuries can be much worse You can hit things inside the vehicle or be ejected from it You can be seriously injured or killed In the same crash you might not be if you are buckled up Always fasten your safety belt and check that your passengers belts are fastened properly too 1 20 Your vehicle has a light that comes on as a reminder to buckle up See Safety Belt Reminder Light on page 3 41 In most states and in all Canadian provinces the law says to wear safety belts Here is why They work You never know if you will be in a crash If you do have a crash you do not know if it will be a bad one A few crashes are mild and s
310. n return to the DVD from the system menu sometimes it plays from the beginning and sometimes from where it left off The fast forward reverse previous and next functions do not work If the stop button was pressed once it resumes play from where it left off If the stop button was pressed twice it will start at the beginning of the DVD However if a change was made to the menu the DVD will start from where it left off even if the stop button was only pressed once Some commands that do one thing for DVDs will not always work or perform the same function for audio CDs or games These functions may also be disabled when the DVD is playing the copyright information or the previews 3 127 My disc is stuck in the player The eject button does not work I lost the remote control and or the headphones Sometimes the wireless headphone audio cuts out or buzzes for a moment then it comes back 3 128 Press the eject button on the DVD player Turn the power off then on again then press the eject button on the DVD player Do not attempt to force or remove the disc from the player If the problem persists return to your GM dealer for further assistance Contact your GM dealer for assistance This could be caused by interference from cell towers or by using the cellular telephone or other radio transmitter device in the vehicle DVD System inoperable The wireless headphones have aud
311. n also cause problems with bearing life brake cooling speedometer or odometer calibration headlamp aim bumper height vehicle ground clearance and tire or tire chain clearance to the body and chassis See Changing a Flat Tire on page 5 72 for more information Used Replacement Wheels Putting a used wheel on your vehicle is dangerous You can t know how it s been used or how far it s been driven It could fail suddenly and cause a crash If you have to replace a wheel use a new GM original equipment wheel 5 69 Tire Chains Don t use tire chains There s not enough clearance Tire chains used on a vehicle without the proper amount of clearance can cause damage to the brakes suspension or other vehicle parts The area damaged by the tire chains could cause you to lose control of your vehicle and you or others may be injured in a crash Use another type of traction device only if its manufacturer recommends it for use on your vehicle and tire size combination and road conditions Follow that manufacturer s instructions To help avoid damage to your vehicle drive slowly readjust or remove the device if it s contacting your vehicle and don t spin your wheels If you do find traction devices that will fit install them on the front tires for front wheel drive vehicles If your vehicle has all wheel drive install traction devices on either the front tires or all four tires but never on the rear tires only 5 7
312. n driving conditions the mileage at which an oil change will be indicated can vary considerably For the oil life system to work properly you must reset the system every time the oil is changed When the system has calculated that oil life has been diminished it will indicate that an oil change is necessary A CHANGE ENGINE OIL message will come on See Change Engine Oil Message on page 3 55 Change your oil as soon as possible within the next 600 miles 1 000 km It is possible that if you are driving under the best conditions the oil life system may not indicate that an oil change is necessary for over a year However your engine oil and filter must be changed at least once a year and at this time the system must be reset Your dealer has GM trained service people who will perform this work using genuine GM parts and reset the system It is also important to check your oil regularly and keep it at the proper level If the system is ever reset accidentally you must change your oil at 3 000 miles 5 000 km since your last oil change Remember to reset the oil life system whenever the oil is changed How to Reset the Engine Oil Life System The Engine Oil Life System calculates when to change your engine oil and filter based on vehicle use Anytime your oil is changed reset the system so it can calculate when the next oil change is required If a situation occurs where you change your oil prior to a CHANGE ENGINE OIL messag
313. n fuel from painted surfaces as soon as possible See Washing Your Vehicle on page 5 98 When replacing the fuel cap turn it to the right clockwise until it clicks Make sure the cap is fully installed The diagnostic system can determine if the fuel cap has been left off or improperly installed This would allow fuel to evaporate into the atmosphere See Malfunction Indicator Lamp on page 3 46 Your vehicle may also be equipped with a light that will come on in the message center to let you know your gas cap is open See Check Gas Cap Message on page 3 57 for more information If a fire starts while you are refueling do not remove the nozzle Shut off the flow of fuel by shutting off the pump or by notifying the station attendant Leave the area immediately Notice If you need a new fuel cap be sure to get the right type Your dealer can get one for you If you get the wrong type it may not fit properly This may cause your malfunction indicator lamp to light and may damage your fuel tank and emissions system See Malfunction Indicator Lamp on page 3 46 Filling a Portable Fuel Container Checking Things Under the Hood Never fill a portable fuel container while it is in your vehicle Static electricity discharge from the container can ignite the gasoline vapor You can be badly burned and your vehicle damaged if this occurs To help avoid injury to you and others Dispense gasoline only into approved contain
314. n of Airbag Deployment e Emergency Services Roadside Assistance Stolen Vehicle Tracking e AccidentAssist Remote Door Unlock Vehicle Alert Remote Diagnostics Online Concierge Directions and Connections Plan All Safe and Sound Plan Services Driving Directions RideAssist e Information and Convenience Services 2 33 OnStar Personal Calling As an OnStar subscriber the Personal Calling capability is available if your hand held cell phone is lost forgotten or has a low battery It is a hands free wireless phone that is integrated into the vehicle Calls can be placed nationwide using simple voice commands with no additional contracts and no additional roaming charges To find out more about OnStar Personal Calling refer to the OnStar user s guide in the vehicle s glove box or visit www onstar com or www onstarcanada com or speak with an OnStar advisor by pressing the OnStar button or by calling 1 888 4 ONSTAR 1 888 466 7827 OnStar Virtual Advisor Virtual Advisor is a feature of OnStar Personal Calling that uses minutes to access up to date weather and traffic reports for your area news and sports updates stock quotes entertainment and more You are also able to listen and reply to your E mail through your vehicle s audio system Customize your information profile at www myonstar com See the OnStar user s guide for more information 2 34 HomeLink Transmitter HomeLink a combi
315. n off is dangerous Your brakes will have to do all the work of slowing down They could get so hot that they would not work well You would then have poor braking or even none going down a hill You could crash Always have your engine running and your vehicle in gear when you go downhill Know how to go uphill You may want to shift down to a lower gear The lower gears help cool your engine and transaxle and you can climb the hill better Stay in your own lane when driving on two lane roads in hills or mountains Do not swing wide or cut across the center of the road Drive at speeds that let you stay in your own lane As you go over the top of a hill be alert There could be something in your lane like a stalled car or an accident You may see highway signs on mountains that warn of special problems Examples are long grades passing or no passing zones a falling rocks area or winding roads Be alert to these and take appropriate action 4 25 Winter Driving Here are some tips for winter driving Have your vehicle in good shape for winter You may want to put winter emergency supplies in your vehicle 4 26 Also see Tires on page 5 55 Include an ice scraper a small brush or broom a supply of windshield washer fluid a rag some winter outer clothing a small shovel a flashlight a red cloth and a couple of reflective warning triangles And if you will be driving under severe conditions include a
316. n the ground If you have a two wheel drive vehicle it can be towed with two of its wheels on the ground See Dolly Towing following If you have an all wheel drive vehicle it cannot be towed with any of its wheels on the ground It can be towed with car carrier equipment Notice Towing an all wheel drive vehicle with all four wheels on the ground or even with only two of its wheels on the ground will damage drivetrain components Do not tow an all wheel drive vehicle if any of its wheels will be on the ground Dolly Towing Two Wheel Drive Vehicles If you have a two wheel drive vehicle it can be towed with two of its wheels on the ground To dolly tow your vehicle do the following 1 Put the front wheels on a dolly 2 Put the vehicle in PARK P 3 Set the parking brake and then remove the key 4 Clamp the steering wheel in a straight ahead position with a clamping device designed for towing 5 Release the parking brake If you have an all wheel drive vehicle it cannot be towed with any of its wheels on the ground It can be towed with car carrier equipment Notice Towing an all wheel drive vehicle with all four wheels on the ground or even with only two of its wheels on the ground will damage drivetrain components Do not tow an all wheel drive vehicle if any of its wheels will be on the ground 4 37 Level Control On vehicles equipped with automatic level control the rear of the vehicle is au
317. n they are under inflated Check the tire s inflation pressure when the tires are cold Cold means your vehicle has been sitting for at least three hours or driven no more than 1 mile 1 6 km Remove the valve cap from the tire valve stem Press the tire gage firmly onto the valve to get a pressure measurement If the cold tire inflation pressure matches the recommended pressure on the Tire and Loading Information label no further adjustment is necessary If the inflation pressure is low add air until you reach the recommended amount If you overfill the tire release air by pushing on the metal stem in the center of the tire valve Re check the tire pressure with the tire gage Be sure to put the valve caps back on the valve stems They help prevent leaks by keeping out dirt and moisture 5 62 Check Tire Pressure System Your vehicle may have a check tire pressure system that can alert you to a large change in the pressure of one tire The system won t alert you before you drive that a tire is low or flat You must begin driving before the system will work properly The LOW TIRE PRESSURE HOLD SET TO RESET message will appear on the Driver Information Center DIC and the LOW TIRE PRESSURE message will come on the message center if pressure difference or low pressure is detected in one tire In the following conditions the LOW TIRE PRESSURE message may not come on even if the tire pressure is low or it may come on when
318. n time Then you have to bring up your foot and do it That is reaction time Average reaction time is about three fourths of a second But that is only an average It might be less with one driver and as long as two or three seconds or more with another Age physical condition alertness coordination and eyesight all play a part So do alcohol drugs and frustration But even in three fourths of a second a vehicle moving at 60 mph 100 km h travels 66 feet 20 m That could be a lot of distance in an emergency so keeping enough space between your vehicle and others is important And of course actual stopping distances vary greatly with the surface of the road whether it is pavement or gravel the condition of the road wet dry icy tire tread the condition of your brakes the weight of the vehicle and the amount of brake force applied Avoid needless heavy braking Some people drive in spurts heavy acceleration followed by heavy braking rather than keeping pace with traffic This is a mistake Your brakes may not have time to cool between hard stops Your brakes will wear out much faster if you do a lot of heavy braking If you keep pace with the traffic and allow realistic following distances you will eliminate a lot of unnecessary braking That means better braking and longer brake life lf your engine ever stops while you are driving brake normally but do not pump your brakes If you do the pedal may get h
319. n when the ignition is turned to ON or START and the liftgate is open Check Gas Cap Message S If your vehicle is equipped this message will come on when the ignition is turned to on or start and the gas cap is open PASS Key III Security Message SECURITY Canada United States If you are ever driving and this message comes on and stays on you will be able to restart your engine if you turn it off Your PASS Key III system however is not working properly and must be serviced by your dealer Your vehicle is not protected by the PASS Key III system at this time See PASS Key III on page 2 17 for more information All Wheel Drive Disable Warning Message Canada AWD DISABLE United States Your vehicle may have this message If it does it will come on when there is a spare tire on the vehicle or when the anti lock brake system warning light comes on or when the rear differential fluid is overheating This message will go out when the differential fluid cools The all wheel drive system will be disabled until the compact spare tire is replaced by a full size tire If the warning message is still on after putting on the full size tire you need to reset the warning message To reset the warning message turn the ignition off and then back on again If the message stays on see your dealer right away See All Wheel Drive AWD System on page 4 11 for more information 3 57 Low Washer Fluid W
320. nart 1 20 Safety Belts They Are for Everyone 1 20 Questions and Answers About Safety Belts 1 24 How to Wear Safety Belts Properly 1 25 Driver Position sas anger minenn iied ninan aaia 1 25 Shoulder Belt Height Adjustment 0 1 33 Safety Belt Use During Pregnancy 4 1 34 Right Front Passenger Position 00 1 34 Rear Seat Passengers csceeeeeeeeeeeeee erates 1 34 Center Rear Passenger Position 0 0 1 38 Rear Safety Belt Comfort Guides for Children and Small Adults eeeeeeeeeeeeeee renerne 1 40 Safety Belt Pretensioners 0cceeeeeeees 1 42 Safety Belt Extender cccceeceeeeeeeeeees 1 42 Child Restraints ccccceeeeeeeeeeneeeeeeeee ees 1 43 Older CHIlArET waceceswniccncsscc se aa e been 1 43 Infants and Young Children W ssscere 1 45 Child Restraint Systems ceeeeeeeeeee tenes 1 48 Where to Put the Restraint eee 1 52 TOD SAD aai en aaa EEE AS 1 53 Top Strap Anchor Location 2 1 54 Lower Anchorages and Top Tethers for Children LATCH System s 1 58 Securing a Child Restraint Designed for the LATCH SYSTEM 4c secasectsactiecsasametdedenarea nc arses 1 60 Securing a Child Restraint in a Rear Outside Seat POSINON 2 cccscsicisvereeeseteesinanyesesshivedien 1 60 Securing a Child Restraint in a Center Rear Seat Position
321. nd of oil you have and some other things Instead of trying to list everything here we ask that you contact your dealer in the area where you will be parking your vehicle The dealer can give you the best advice for that particular area Automatic Transaxle Operation Maximum engine speed is limited when you are in PARK P or NEUTRAL N to protect driveline components from improper operation There are several different positions for your shift lever PARK P This gear position locks your front wheels It is the best position to use when you start your engine because your vehicle cannot move easily Ensure the shift lever is fully in PARK P before starting the engine Your vehicle has an automatic transaxle shift lock control system You must fully apply your regular brakes before you can shift from PARK P when the ignition key is in ON As you step on the brake pedal while in PARK P you may hear a click from the solenoid of the system This ensures that the system is operating properly If you cannot shift out of PARK P ease pressure on the shift lever push the shift lever all the way into PARK P as you maintain brake application Then move the shift lever into the gear you wish See Shifting Out of Park P on page 2 28 for more information It is dangerous to get out of your vehicle if the shift lever is not fully in PARK P with the parking brake firmly set Your vehicle can roll Do not leave your v
322. ndards The restraint manufacturer s instructions that come with the restraint state the weight and height limitations for a particular child restraint In addition there are many kinds of restraints available for children with special needs Newborn infants need complete support including support for the head and neck This is necessary because a newborn infant s neck is weak and its head weighs so much compared with the rest of its body In a crash an infant in a rear facing seat settles into the restraint so the crash forces can be distributed across the strongest part of an infant s body the back and shoulders Infants always should be secured in appropriate infant restraints 1 47 Child Restraint Systems The body structure of a young child is quite unlike that of an adult or older child for whom the safety belts are designed A young child s hip bones are still so small that the vehicle s regular safety belt may not remain low on the hip bones as it should Instead it may settle up around the child s abdomen In a crash the belt would apply force on a body area that is unprotected by any bony structure This alone could cause serious or fatal injuries Young children always should be secured in appropriate child restraints An infant car bed A a special bed made for use ina motor vehicle is an infant restraint system designed to restrain or position a child on a continuous flat surface Make sure
323. nds If your vehicle has aluminum wheels remove the wheel nut caps using the wheel wrench 5 80 2 Loosen the wheel nuts but do not remove them using the folding wrench Turn the handle about 180 degrees then flip the handle back to the starting position This avoids taking the wrench off the lug nut for each turn For wheels with a wheel lock key use the wheel lock key between the lock nut and folding wrench The key is supplied in the front passenger door Notice If your vehicle has wheel locks and you use an impact wrench to remove the wheel nuts you could damage the lock nut or wheel lock key Do not use an impact wrench to remove the wheel nuts if your vehicle has wheel locks 3 Locate the notch A is 3 0 inches 7 5 cm from the front tire or B is 5 5 inches 14 0 cm from the rear tire The notch is located near each wheel in the vehicle s body Notice If you use a jack to raise the vehicle without positioning it correctly you could damage your vehicle When raising your vehicle on a jack avoid contact with the rear axle control arms Do not raise the vehicle yet Put the compact spare tire near you Getting under a vehicle when it is jacked up is dangerous If the vehicle slips off the jack you could be badly injured or killed Never get under a vehicle when it is supported only by a jack Raising your vehicle with the jack improperly positioned can damage the veh
324. ned universal transmitter and receiver provides a way to replace up to three hand held transmitters used to activate devices such as gate operators garage door openers entry door locks security systems and home lighting Additional HomeLink information can be found on the internet at www homelink com or by calling 1 800 355 3515 If your vehicle is equipped with the HomeLink transmitter it complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules Operation is subject to the following two conditions 1 This device may not cause harmful interference 2 This device must accept any interference received including interference that may cause undesired operation This device complies with RSS 210 of Industry Canada Operation is subject to the following two conditions 1 This device may not cause interference 2 This device must accept any interference received including interference that may cause undesired operation of the device Changes and modifications to this system by other than an authorized service facility could void authorization to use this equipment Programming the HomeLink Transmitter Do not use the HomeLink Transmitter with any garage door opener that does not have the stop and reverse feature This includes any garage door opener model manufactured before April 1 1982 If you have a newer garage door opener with rolling codes please be sure to follow steps 6 through 8 to complete the programming of your Hom
325. net should be in the upper left corner The convenience net has a maximum capacity of 100 Ibs 45 kg It is not designed to hold larger heavier loads Store such loads on the floor of your vehicle as far forward as you can When not in use it is recommended that you take down the rear convenience net to extend its life and retain its elasticity and to keep the rear exit clear Store the net in one of the storage compartments Cargo Cover If your vehicle has a cargo cover you can use it to cover items in the rear of the vehicle Remove the cover from its pouch and place the loops found on each corner of the cover over the four pegs in each corner of the rear if the vehicle When it is not in use fold up the cover and return it to the pouch 2 43 Rear Convenience Center If any removable convenience item is not secured properly it can move around in a collision or sudden stop People in the vehicle could be injured Be sure to secure any such item properly Your vehicle may have a rear convenience center The rear convenience center can be used to organize and store items in your vehicle The extended rear convenience center without the optional third row stowable seat has a forward bin and rear bin The rear convenience center with the optional third row stowable seat contains one storage bin To use the convenience center remove the carpeted mat and lift the handle s on the top of the lid to open the sto
326. nflator will automatically shut off after about 10 minutes The light in the switch will blink After about one minute you can use the system again Press the inflator switch and the indicator light will come on Notice If you run the accessory inflator longer than 30 minutes at a time you could damage the inflator The repairs would not be covered by your warranty Run the inflator for short periods of time only After running the accessory inflator for 30 minutes wait at least 10 minutes before restarting the accessory inflator To turn off the inflator do the following 1 Press the switch and detach the hose first from the inflated object then from the outlet 2 Put the protective cap back on 3 Place the inflator kit tools in the pouch and store in the glove box To put the cover back on line up the tabs at the back of the cover and put it in place Push down the tab to secure the cover 5 71 If a Tire Goes Flat It s unusual for a tire to blowout while you re driving especially if you maintain your tires properly If air goes out of a tire it s much more likely to leak out slowly But if you should ever have a blowout here are a few tips about what to expect and what to do If a front tire fails the flat tire will create a drag that pulls the vehicle toward that side Take your foot off the accelerator pedal and grip the steering wheel firmly Steer to maintain lane position and then gentl
327. ng it has been playing To change the default on the display track or elapsed time press this button until you see the display you want then hold the button until the display flashes The selected display will now be the default Ki SEEK M Press the left arrow to go to the start of the current track if more than eight seconds have played If either arrow is held or pressed more than once the player will continue moving backward through the CD Press the right arrow to go to the next track If either arrow is held or pressed more than once the player will continue moving forward through the CD To scan tracks press and hold either SEEK arrow for two seconds until SCAN appears on the display and you hear a beep The CD will go to the next track play for a few seconds then go on to the next track The sound will mute and SCAN and the track number will appear on the display The CD will only scan forward Press either SEEK arrow again to stop scanning BAND Press this button to listen to the radio when a cassette tape or CD is playing The inactive tape or CD will remain safely inside the radio for future listening CD TAPE Press this button to play a cassette tape or CD when listening to the radio The inactive tape or CD will remain safely inside the radio for future listening A Eject Press this button located next to the CD slot to eject a tape Eject may be activated with either the ignition or radio off CDs may be
328. ng it often with lukewarm or cold water Do not wash the vehicle in the direct rays of the sun Use a car washing soap Do not use strong soaps or chemical detergents Be sure to rinse the vehicle well removing all soap residue completely GM approved cleaning products can be obtained from your dealer See Vehicle Care Appearance Materials on page 5 102 Do not use cleaning agents that are petroleum based or that contain acid or abrasives All cleaning agents should be flushed promptly and not allowed to dry on the surface or they could stain Dry the finish with a soft clean chamois or an all cotton towel to avoid surface scratches and water spotting High pressure car washes may cause water to enter the vehicle Cleaning Exterior Lamps Lenses Use only lukewarm or cold water a soft cloth and a car washing soap to clean exterior lamps and lenses Follow instructions under Washing Your Vehicle on page 5 98 Finish Care Occasional waxing or mild polishing of the vehicle by hand may be necessary to remove residue from the paint finish GM approved cleaning products can be obtained from your dealer See Vehicle Care Appearance Materials on page 5 102 The vehicle has a basecoat clearcoat paint finish The clearcoat gives more depth and gloss to the colored basecoat Always use waxes and polishes that are non abrasive and made for a basecoat clearcoat paint finish Notice Machine compounding or aggressive polishing on
329. ng the announcement Alert announcements cannot be turned off ALERT will not be affected by tests of the emergency broadcast system This feature is not supported by all RDS stations INFO Information If the current station has a message INFO will appear on the display Press this button to see the message The message may display the artist song title call in phone numbers etc If the entire message is not displayed parts of the message will appear every three seconds To scroll through the message press the INFO button A new group of words will appear on the display after every press of this button Once the complete message has been displayed INFO will disappear from the display until another new message is received The last message can be displayed by pressing the INFO button You can view the last message until a new message is received or a different station is tuned to TRAF Traffic If TRAF appears on the display the tuned station broadcasts traffic announcements To receive the traffic announcement from the tuned station press this button Brackets will be displayed around TRAF and when a traffic announcement comes on the tuned radio station you will hear it lf the station does not broadcast traffic announcements press this button and the radio will seek to a station that does When a station that broadcasts traffic announcements is found the radio will stop seeking and brackets will be displayed around TR
330. nges Headphones The RSE system includes two sets of wireless headphones The wireless headphones have an ON OFF switch and a volume control To use the headphones turn the switch to ON An indicator light on the headphones will illuminate If the light does not illuminate the batteries may need to be replaced See Battery Replacement later in this section for more information Switch the headphones to OFF when not in use 3 116 The transmitters are located below the overhead RSE control panel The headphones will shut off automatically to save the battery power if the DVD system is shut off or if the headphones are out of range of the transmitters for more than three minutes If you move too far forward or step out of the vehicle the headphones will lose the audio signal To adjust the volume on the wireless headphones use the volume control You can listen to the RSE system through the wired headphone jacks on the Rear Seat Audio RSA system if equipped when the following occurs The RSA system is on A DVD or auxiliary device is playing e RSE is displayed on the front audio system by pressing the TAPE CD button on the RSA system See Rear Seat Audio RSA on page 3 130 for more information If the front seat passengers are listening to the RSE system through the vehicle s speakers and the rear seat passengers are using the wired headphones to listen to the RSA system the BAND button will not access XM
331. nition is OFF and retained accessory power RAP is active See Retained Accessory Power RAP on page 2 21 Notice Opening the sunroof when the luggage rack crossrails are not in the full rear position could cause damage to the sunroof or luggage rack Verify the luggage rack crossrails are in the full rear position before opening the sunroof Press the rear of the switch to open the sunroof to the vent position The sunshade must be opened by hand Press and release the rear of the switch a second time to express open the sunroof The sunshade will open with the sunroof Press the switch in either direction to stop it from moving If the rear of the switch is pressed and held the express open operation will be overridden To close the sunroof press and hold the front of the switch Vehicle Personalization Memory Seat If your vehicle has this feature the controls are located on the driver s door panel and are used to store and recall the driver s seat position and the outside rearview mirror position The settings for these features can be personalized for both driver 1 and driver 2 Driver 1 and driver 2 correspond to the memory buttons labeled 1 and 2 on the driver s door 2 47 To store the memory settings do the following 1 Adjust the driver s seat and the outside rearview mirrors to the position you would like for driving 2 Press and hold memory button 1 for more than three seconds A double
332. now and loose gravel to help maintain vehicle motion at lower speeds See Traction Control System TCS on page 4 10 If you do not have a traction system accelerate gently Try not to break the fragile traction If you accelerate too fast the drive wheels will spin and polish the surface under the tires even more Unless you have the anti lock braking system you will want to brake very gently too If you do have anti lock see Anti Lock Brake System ABS on page 4 7 This system improves your vehicle s stability when you make a hard stop on a slippery road Whether you have the anti lock braking system or not you will want to begin stopping sooner than you would on dry pavement Without anti lock brakes if you feel your vehicle begin to slide let up on the brakes a little Push the brake pedal down steadily to get the most traction you can 4 27 Remember unless you have anti lock if you brake so hard that your wheels stop rolling you will just slide Brake so your wheels always keep rolling and you can still steer Whatever your braking system allow greater following distance on any slippery road Watch for slippery spots The road might be fine until you hit a spot that is covered with ice On an otherwise clear road ice patches may appear in shaded areas where the sun cannot reach around clumps of trees behind buildings or under bridges Sometimes the surface of a curve or an overpass may remain icy when the s
333. ns that are programmed on the radio preset pushbuttons The radio will go to the first preset station stored play for a few seconds then go on to the next preset station Press this button again to stop scanning The radio will only scan preset stations with a strong signal that are in the selected band 3 133 Radio Reception AM The range for most AM stations is greater than for FM especially at night The longer range can cause station frequencies to interfere with each other Static can occur on AM stations caused by things like storms and power lines Try reducing the treble to reduce this noise FM Stereo FM stereo will give the best sound but FM signals will reach only about 10 to 40 miles 16 to 65 km Tall buildings or hills can interfere with FM signals causing the sound to fade in and out XM Satellite Radio Service XM Satellite Radio Service gives digital radio reception from coast to coast Just as with FM tall buildings or hills can interfere with satellite radio signals causing the sound to fade in and out The radio may display NO SIGNAL to indicate interference 3 134 Care of Your Cassette Tape Player A tape player that is not cleaned regularly can cause reduced sound quality ruined cassettes or a damaged mechanism Cassette tapes should be stored in their cases away from contaminants direct sunlight and extreme heat If they are not they may not operate properly or they may cause failur
334. nt Superlube Hinges Rear GM Part No U S 12346241 in Folding Seat Canada 10953474 Dielectric Silicone Grease GM Part Weatherstrip Conditioning NSSS 12345579 in Canada Normal Maintenance Replacement Parts Replacement parts identified below by name part number or specification can be obtained from your GM dealer Engine Air Cleaner Filter 25099149 A1208C Engine Oil Filter 3400 V6 25010792 3 6L V6 89017342 Passenger Compartment Air Filter Kit 52482929 PF 0 0 Spark Plugs 3400 V6 12568387 3 6L V6 12565996 Windshield Wiper Blades Hook Type Driver s Side 24 0 inches 60 0 cm 10413111 Passenger s Side 22 0 inches 55 0 cm 10317151 Maintenance Record After the scheduled services are performed record the date odometer reading who performed the service and the type of services performed in the boxes provided See Maintenance Requirements on page 6 2 in this section Any additional information from Owner Checks and Services on page 6 8 can be added on the following record pages Also you should retain all maintenance receipts Maintenance Record Odometer Maintenance I or i Reading Serviced By Maintenance II Services Performed Maintenance Record cont d Odometer i Maintenance I or Reading Serviced By Maintenance II Services Performed Maintenance Record cont d Odometer R Maintenance I or i Section 7 Customer Assistance and Information 7 2 C
335. ntacts the pavement edge Then turn your steering wheel to go straight down the roadway Passing The driver of a vehicle about to pass another on a two lane highway waits for just the right moment accelerates moves around the vehicle ahead then goes back into the right lane again A simple maneuver Not necessarily Passing another vehicle on a two lane highway is a potentially dangerous move since the passing vehicle occupies the same lane as oncoming traffic for several seconds A miscalculation an error in judgment or a brief surrender to frustration or anger can suddenly put the passing driver face to face with the worst of all traffic accidents the head on collision So here are some tips for passing Drive ahead Look down the road to the sides and to crossroads for situations that might affect your passing patterns If you have any doubt whatsoever about making a successful pass wait for a better time Watch for traffic signs pavement markings and lines If you can see a sign up ahead that might indicate a turn or an intersection delay your pass A broken center line usually indicates it is all right to pass providing the road ahead is clear Never cross a solid line on your side of the lane or a double solid line even if the road seems empty of approaching traffic Do not get too close to the vehicle you want to pass while you are awaiting an opportunity For one thing following too closely reduces you
336. ntenna 3 135 Interior Lamps ii aea E REDEE 3 16 Interior Lamps Control W u sssesererererennennee 3 16 J DUMP Staing sirak ae EE ei 5 42 K Keyless Entry System W u dssseeeeeere rer eee eee 2 5 Key anione naD EE Ea 2 3 L Labelling Tire Sidewall sssssseneeeerrrrer 5 56 Lamps Battery Run Down Protection 05 3 20 eNe O E EET 3 19 EXtENIOF 225 sr per See it poni 3 14 FOO repanse n E E i 3 15 Lamps cont Front Reading ace agree eres IMLONION ers ren se es REE a i Interior Control 2522 27 siste Rear Reading LATCH System Child Restraints siirre niena Securing a Child Restraint Designed for the LATCH System sssseeereeeeeere renerne nnne Level Control assess sacetascvedieeed deaciecssenieignsacemassetee LING ALG sais ERE EDEN Sethe a ea ancients Light Airbag Readiness cccceseeeeeeeneceeeeeerees Anti Lock Brake System Warning 6 Brake System Warning eeeeeeeeeeeeeeneees Highbeam On Malfunction Indicator 2232 raske renin Passenger Airbag Status Indicator Safety Belt Reminder eseeeeeeeneeeeeees TCS Warning Light ceeeeeeeeeneeeeeeeee ees Traction Control System TCS Warning Lighting Delayed Entry eoten E anatedevecsnl EEEE EY E E E E Perimeter 525 re ar EEEE EEE EE Lockout Protection e eeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeees 2 11 Locks Delayed LOCKING 2 i 0t
337. numbered pushbuttons by performing the following steps 1 Turn the radio on 2 Press BAND to select FM1 FM2 AM or XM1 or XM2 3 Tune in the desired station 4 Press AUTO EQ to select the equalization 5 Press and hold one of the six numbered pushbuttons until you hear a beep Whenever that numbered pushbutton is pressed the station that was set will return and the equalization that was selected will be stored for that pushbutton 6 Repeat the steps for each pushbutton Setting the Tone Bass Treble AUDIO Push the AUDIO knob until BASS MID or TREB appears on the display Turn the knob to increase or to decrease If a station is weak or noisy decrease the treble To adjust bass midrange or treble to the middle position select BASS MID or TREB and push and hold the AUDIO knob The display level will be adjusted to the middle position and you will hear a beep To adjust all tone and speaker controls to the middle position push and hold the AUDIO knob when no tone or speaker control is displayed CENTERED will appear on the display and you will hear one beep AUTO EQ Automatic Equalization Press this button to select customized equalization settings designed for country jazz talk pop rock and classical To return to the manual mode press the AUTO EQ button until CUSTOM appears on the display Then manually adjust the bass midrange and treble using the AUDIO knob 3 103 Adjusting the Speake
338. o Before you connect the cables here are some basic things you should know Positive will go to positive or to a remote positive terminal if the vehicle has one Negative will go to a heavy unpainted metal engine part or to a remote negative terminal if the vehicle has one Notice If you connect a negative cable to the ECM 8 ECM mounting bracket or any cables that attach to the ECM bracket you may damage the ECM Attach the negative cable to a heavy unpainted metal engine part other than the ECM ECM bracket or cables attached to the ECM bracket Now connect the black negative cable to the negative terminal of the good battery Use a remote negative terminal if the vehicle has one Do not let the other end touch anything until the next step The other end of the negative cable does not go to the dead battery It goes toa Do not connect positive to negative or you will get a short that would damage the battery and maybe other parts too And do not connect the negative cable to the negative terminal on heavy unpainted metal engine part or to a remote negative terminal on the vehicle with the dead battery 4 9 Connect the other end of the negative cable at the dead battery because this can cause sparks least 18 inches 45 cm away from the dead battery Connect the red positive cable to the positive but not near engine parts tha
339. o 780 s ig SOON Do mph rpm x 1000 20 40 km h 10 20 G x aC 180 110 United States up level shown United States base level and Canadian similar 3 38 Speedometer and Odometer Your speedometer lets you see your speed in both miles per hour mph and kilometers per hour km h Your odometer shows how far your vehicle has been driven in either miles used in the United States or kilometers used in Canada However a Canadian odometer will remain in metric units only Your vehicle has a tamper resistant odometer You may wonder what happens if your vehicle needs a new odometer installed If the new one can be set to the mileage total of the old odometer then that will be done If it cannot then it is set at zero and a label must be put on the driver s door to show the old mileage reading when the new odometer was installed If your vehicle is equipped with the Driver Information Center DIC you may toggle the odometer to display either miles available only in the United States or kilometers See Driver Information Center DIC on page 3 62 Trip Odometer In addition to the standard odometer the cluster can also display a trip odometer The display can be toggled between the odometer and the trip odometer by quickly pressing and releasing the trip reset button located to the right of the temperature gage The trip odometer will continue to keep track of miles or kilometers driven
340. o and air conditioner Reduced Engine Power Message REDUCED ENGINE POWER United States Canada If your vehicle has this feature this message will appear in the message center when a noticeable reduction in the vehicle s engine performance is detected This message will also appear when your vehicle is in overheated engine protection operating mode See Engine Overheating on page 5 28 for more information If this message comes on and stays on see your dealer 3 53 Low Oil Pressure Message LOW OIL PRESSURE United States Canada Your vehicle is equipped with a low oil pressure warning message Your oil pressure message lets you know when you may have a problem with your engine oil pressure When the engine is running and this message appears the engine oil level may be too low There may also be another problem causing low oil pressure 3 54 Do not keep driving if the oil pressure is low If you do your engine can become so hot that it catches fire You or others could be burned Check your oil as soon as possible and have your vehicle serviced Notice Lack of proper engine oil maintenance may damage the engine The repairs would not be covered by your warranty Always follow the maintenance schedule in this manual for changing engine oil Low Engine Oil Level Message Change Engine Oil Message CHANGE ENGINE OIL United States Canada United States Canada Your vehicle ma
341. of collisions including frontal or near frontal collisions rollovers and rear impacts primarily because an occupant s motion is not toward those airbags Airbags should never be regarded as anything more than a supplement to safety belts and then only in moderate to severe frontal or near frontal collisions for the driver s and right front passenger s frontal airbags and only in moderate to severe side collisions for vehicles with a driver s and right front passenger s side impact airbag 1 75 What Will You See After an Airbag Inflates After the airbag inflates it quickly deflates so quickly that some people may not even realize the airbag inflated Some components of the airbag module will be hot for a short time These components include the steering wheel hub for the driver s frontal airbag and the instrument panel for the right front passenger s frontal airbag For vehicles with side impact airbags the side of the seatback closest to the driver s and or right front passenger s door will be hot The parts of the bag that come into contact with you may be warm but not too hot to touch There will be some smoke and dust coming from the vents in the deflated airbags Airbag inflation does not prevent the driver from seeing or being able to steer the vehicle nor does it stop people from leaving the vehicle 1 76 When an airbag inflates there is dust in the air This dust could cause breathing problems for people with a hi
342. ol of the volume for each set of headphones 3 130 The front seat audio controls always have priority over the RSA controls If the front seat passengers switch the source for the main radio to a remote source the RSA will not be able to control the source You can operate the rear seat audio when the main radio is off lf your vehicle has the Rear Seat Entertainment RSE system and the system is on the rear seat passengers can listen to the DVDs through the wired headphone jacks on the RSA system The RSE system cannot be controlled with the RSA system If the front seat passengers are listening to the RSE system through the vehicle s speakers and the rear seat passengers are using the wired headphones to listen to the RSA system the BAND button will not access XM Satellite Radio Service Primary Radio Controls The following function is controlled by the main radio PWR Power Push this knob twice to turn RSA off Rear Seat Audio RSA Controls The following functions are controlled by the RSA system A SEEK V When listening to the radio press the up or the down arrow to go to the next or the previous station and stay there This function is inactive if the front seat passengers are listening to the radio To scan stations press and hold either SEEK arrow until the radio goes into scan mode The radio will go to a station play for a few seconds then go on to the next station Press either SEEK arrow aga
343. olutions per minute rpm Safety Belt Reminder Light When the key is turned to ON or START a chime will come on for several seconds to remind people to fasten their safety belts The safety belt light will also come on and stay on for several seconds If the driver s belt is already buckled neither the chime nor the light will come on LZ Airbag Readiness Light There is an airbag readiness light on the instrument panel which shows the airbag symbol The system checks the airbag s electrical system for malfunctions The light tells you if there is an electrical problem The system check includes the airbag sensor the airbag modules the wiring diagnostic module and safety belt pretensioners For more information on the airbag system see Airbag System on page 1 67 For more information on safety belt pretensioners see Safety Belt Pretensioners on page 1 42 This light will come on when you start your vehicle and it will flash for a few seconds Then the light should go out This means the system is ready e N 3 41 If the airbag readiness light stays on after you start the vehicle or comes on when you are driving your airbag system or safety belt pretensioners may not work properly Have your vehicle serviced right away If the airbag readiness light stays on after you start your vehicle it means the airbag system may not be working properly The airbags in your vehicle may not inflate in a cras
344. ome crashes can be so serious that even buckled up a person would not survive But most crashes are in between In many of them people who buckle up can survive and sometimes walk away Without belts they could have been badly hurt or killed After more than 30 years of safety belts in vehicles the facts are clear In most crashes buckling up does matter a lot Why Safety Belts Work When you ride in or on anything you go as fast as it goes Take the simplest vehicle Suppose it is just a seat on wheels 1 21 Put someone on it Get it up to speed Then stop the vehicle The rider does not stop 1 22 The person keeps going until stopped by something In or the instrument panel a real vehicle it could be the windshield Questions and Answers About Safety Belts Q Will I be trapped in the vehicle after an accident if am wearing a safety belt A You could be whether you are wearing a safety belt or not But you can unbuckle a safety belt even if you are upside down And your chance of being conscious during and after an accident so you can unbuckle and get out is much greater if you are belted Q If my vehicle has airbags why should I have to wear safety belts or the safety belts A Airbags are in many vehicles today and will be in most of them in the future But they are supplemental systems only so they work with safety belts not instead of them Every airbag system ever offe
345. omplete axle sets Brake Pedal Travel See your dealer if the brake pedal does not return to normal height or if there is a rapid increase in pedal travel This could be a sign of brake trouble Brake Adjustment Every time you apply the brakes with or without the vehicle moving your brakes adjust for wear Replacing Brake System Parts The braking system on a vehicle is complex Its many parts have to be of top quality and work well together if the vehicle is to have really good braking Your vehicle was designed and tested with top quality GM brake parts When you replace parts of your braking system for example when your brake linings wear down and you need new ones put in be sure you get new approved GM replacement parts If you do not your brakes may no longer work properly For example if someone puts in brake linings that are wrong for your vehicle the balance between your front and rear brakes can change for the worse The braking performance you have come to expect can change in many other ways if someone puts in the wrong replacement brake parts Battery Your vehicle has a maintenance free battery When it is time for a new battery get one that has the replacement number shown on the original battery s label We recommend an ACDelco replacement battery See Engine Compartment Overview on page 5 12 for battery location Warning Battery posts terminals and related accessories contain lead and le
346. ompression of air brakes on a very large truck If after cleaning the rear bumper and then driving forward at least 15 mph 25 km h the display continues to flash red see your dealer If a trailer was attached to your vehicle or a bicycle or an object was on the back of or hanging out of your liftgate during your last drive cycle the light may also flash red The light will continue to flash whenever in REVERSE R until your vehicle is driven forward at least 15 mph 25 km h without any obstructions behind the vehicle For cleaning instructions see Washing Your Vehicle on page 5 98 3 26 Accessory Power Outlets With accessory power outlets you can plug in electrical equipment such as a cellular telephone or CB radio There is one front power outlet cigarette lighter located on the floor console in the cell phone storage compartment There are also two rear power outlets One is located in the rear of the floor console below the vents The other is located in the rear of the vehicle on the driver s side behind the access door Pull the cover down to use an accessory power outlet When not in use always cover the accessory power outlets with the protective cap Notice Leaving electrical equipment on for extended periods will drain the battery Always turn off electrical equipment when not in use and do not plug in equipment that exceeds the maximum amperage rating Certain electrical accessories may not be co
347. on 15 Close the liftgate page 6 13 Here s how to replace the windshield wiper blades Replacement Bulbs a ara 1 Turn the wipers on to the lowest intermittent setting Exterior Lamp Bulb Number 2 Turn off the ignition while the wipers are at the Front Turn Signal Parking Lamps 3457K outer positions of the wipe pattern The blades Headlamps are more accessible for removal replacement while High beam 9005 in this position Low beam 9006 3 Pull the windshield wiper arm away from the Liftgate Mounted windshield Back Up Lamps Taillamps Rear Outboard Stop Tail Turn Sidemarker Lamps For replacement bulbs not listed here contact your dealer 5 53 4 Pull up the release clip located at the connecting point of the blade and the arm Then pull the blade assembly down toward the glass to remove it from the wiper arm Push the new wiper blade securely on the wiper arm until you hear the release clip click into place Push the release clip from Step 4 down to secure the wiper blade into place 5 54 To replace the backglass mounted wiper blade do the following 1 Turn the rear wiper off 2 Pull the wiper away from the backglass 3 Pull up the release clip located at the connecting point of the blade and the arm Then pull the blade assembly down toward the glass to remove it from the wiper arm 4 Push the new wiper blade securely on the wiper arm until you hear the release clip click into place
348. on down to make sure it has locked into position Adjust the height so that the shoulder portion of the belt is centered on your shoulder The belt should be away from your face and neck but not falling off your shoulder 1 33 Safety Belt Use During Pregnancy Safety belts work for everyone including pregnant women Like all occupants they are more likely to be seriously injured if they do not wear safety belts A pregnant woman should wear a lap shoulder belt and the lap portion should be worn as low as possible below the rounding throughout the pregnancy The best way to protect the fetus is to protect the mother When a safety belt is worn properly it is more likely that the fetus will not be hurt in a crash For pregnant women as for anyone the key to making safety belts effective is wearing them properly 1 34 Right Front Passenger Position To learn how to wear the right front passenger s safety belt properly see Driver Position on page 1 25 The right front passenger s safety belt works the same way as the driver s safety belt except for one thing If you ever pull the shoulder portion of the belt out all the way you will engage the child restraint locking feature If this happens just let the belt go back all the way and start again Rear Seat Passengers It is very important for rear seat passengers to buckle up Accident statistics show that unbelted people in the rear seat are hurt more oft
349. on page 5 41 Remote Positive Terminal See Jump Starting on page 5 42 Radiator Pressure Cap See Radiator Pressure Cap on page 5 28 Power Steering Fluid Reservoir See Power Steering Fluid on page 5 36 Engine Oil Fill Cap See When to Add Engine Oil under Engine Oil on page 5 16 Engine Oil Dipstick See Checking Engine Oil under Engine Oil on page 5 16 Brake Master Cylinder See Brake Fluid under Brakes on page 5 38 Automatic Transaxle Fluid Dipstick See Checking the Fluid Level under Automatic Transaxle Fluid on page 5 22 Engine Air Cleaner Filter See Engine Air Cleaner Filter on page 5 21 Coolant Recovery Tank See Engine Coolant on page 5 25 Engine Oil Checking Engine Oil It is a good idea to check your engine oil every time you get fuel In order to get an accurate reading the oil must be warm and the vehicle must be on level ground The engine oil dipstick handle is a yellow loop See Engine Compartment Overview on page 5 12 for the location of the engine oil dipstick 1 Turn off the engine and give the oil several minutes to drain back into the oil pan If you do not do this the oil dipstick might not show the actual level 2 Pull out the dipstick and clean it with a paper towel or cloth then push it back in all the way Remove it again keeping the tip down and check the level m r XX me x A DS 3400 V6 Engine 3 6L V6 Engine
350. ontact the owner of the dealership or the general manager STEP TWO If after contacting a member of dealership management it appears your concern cannot be resolved by the dealership without further help contact the Buick Customer Assistance Center by calling 1 800 521 7300 In Canada contact GM of Canada Customer Communication Centre by calling 1 800 263 3777 English or 1 800 263 7854 French 7 2 We encourage you to call the toll free number in order to give your inquiry prompt attention Please have the following information available to give the Customer Assistance Representative Vehicle Identification Number This is available from the vehicle registration or title or the plate at the top left of the instrument panel Dealership name and location Vehicle delivery date and present mileage When contacting Buick please remember that your concern will likely be resolved at a dealer s facility That is why we suggest you follow Step One first if you have a concern STEP THREE Both General Motors and your dealer are committed to making sure you are completely satisfied with your new vehicle However if you continue to remain unsatisfied after following the procedure outlined in Steps One and Two you should file with the BBB Auto Line Program to enforce any additional rights you may have Canadian owners refer to your Warranty and Owner Assistance Information booklet for information on the Canadian Motor Vehic
351. or Remote Positive and Remote Negative Terminals C Dead Battery or Remote Positive Terminal 5 46 All Wheel Drive If you have an all wheel drive vehicle be sure to perform the lubricant checks described in this section All wheel drive vehicles have two additional systems that need lubrication Transfer Case Power Transfer Unit When to Check Lubricant Refer to the Maintenance Schedule to determine how often to check the lubricant See Scheduled Maintenance on page 6 4 How to Check Lubricant To get an accurate reading the vehicle should be on a level surface If the level is below the bottom of the filler plug hole you will need to add some lubricant Add enough lubricant to raise the level to the bottom of the filler plug hole What to Use Refer to the Maintenance Schedule to determine what kind of lubricant to use See Recommended Fluids and Lubricants on page 6 12 Carrier Assembly Differential Rear Drive Module When to Check and Change Lubricant Refer to the Maintenance Schedule to determine how often to check the lubricant and when to change it See Scheduled Maintenance on page 6 4 How to Check Lubricant To get an accurate reading the vehicle should be on a level surface 5 48 If the level is below the bottom of the filler plug hole you will need to add some lubricant Add enough lubricant to raise the level to the bottom of the filler plug hole A fluid loss could ind
352. or more information How to Check Automatic Transaxle Fluid Because this operation can be a little difficult you may choose to have this done at the dealership service department lf you do it yourself be sure to follow all the instructions here or you could get a false reading on the dipstick Notice Too much or too little fluid can damage the transaxle Too much can mean that some of the fluid could come out and fall on hot engine or exhaust system parts starting a fire Too little fluid could cause the transaxle to overheat Be sure to get an accurate reading if you check the transaxle fluid Wait at least 30 minutes before checking the transaxle fluid level if you have been driving e When outside temperatures are above 90 F 32 C At high speed for quite a while In heavy traffic especially in hot weather To get the right reading the fluid should be at normal operating temperature which is 180 F to 200 F 82 C to 93 C Get the vehicle warmed up by driving about 15 miles 24 km when outside temperatures are above 50 F 10 C If it is colder than 50 F 10 C you may have to drive longer Checking the Fluid Level To prepare your vehicle do the following 1 Park your vehicle on a level place and keep the engine running 2 With the parking brake applied place the shift lever in PARK P 3 With your foot on the brake pedal move the shift lever through each gear range pausing for
353. otor vehicles To enhance your ownership experience we and our participating dealers are proud to offer Courtesy Transportation a customer support program for new vehicles The Courtesy Transportation program is offered to retail purchase lease customers in conjunction with the Bumper to Bumper coverage provided by the New Vehicle Limited Warranty Several transportation options are available when warranty repairs are required This will reduce your inconvenience during warranty repairs Scheduling Service Appointments When your vehicle requires warranty service you should contact your dealer and request an appointment By scheduling a service appointment and advising your service consultant of your transportation needs your dealer can help minimize your inconvenience If your vehicle cannot be scheduled into the service department immediately keep driving it until it can be scheduled for service unless of course the problem is safety related If it is please call your dealership let them know this and ask for instructions If the dealer requests that you simply drop the vehicle off for service you are urged to do so as early in the work day as possible to allow for same day repair Transportation Options Warranty service can generally be completed while you wait However if you are unable to wait Buick helps minimize your inconvenience by providing several transportation options Depending on the circumstances your de
354. otting ceeeeeeeeeeeees 5 101 Vehicle Care Appearance Materials 5 102 Vehicle Identification eee 5 103 Vehicle Identification Number VIN 5 103 Service Parts Identification Label 5 103 Electrical System ceeeeeeeeeeeee eee renee 5 104 Add On Electrical Equipment 0 eeeee 5 104 Headlamp Wiring 0 eeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeereeees 5 104 Windshield Wiper Fuses ccce 5 104 Power Windows and Other Power Options 5 104 Fuses and Circuit Breakers seere 5 105 Floor Console Fuse Block 5 105 Underhood Fuse Block asss 5 107 Capacities and Specifications 5 112 Service Your dealer knows your vehicle best and wants you to be happy with it We hope you will go to your dealer for all your service needs You will get genuine GM parts and GM trained and supported service people We hope you will want to keep your GM vehicle all GM Genuine GM parts have one of these marks ACVelco E parts GM Goodwrench E Accessories California Proposition 65 Warning Most motor vehicles including this one contain and or emit chemicals known to the State of California to cause cancer and birth defects or other reproductive harm Engine exhaust many parts and systems including some inside the vehicle many fluids and some component wear by products contain and or emit these chemicals
355. our cruise control on when you are not using cruise you might hit a button and go into cruise when you do not want to You could be startled and even lose control Keep the cruise control switch off until you want to use cruise control 1 Move the cruise control switch located on the turn signal multifunction lever to ON 2 Get up to the speed you want 3 Press the SET button at the end of the lever and release it 4 Take your foot off the accelerator pedal Resuming a Set Speed Suppose you set your cruise control at a desired speed and then you apply the brake This of course shuts off the cruise control But you do not need to reset it Once you are going about 25 mph 40 km h or more you can move the cruise control switch from ON to Resume Accelerate R A briefly You will go right back up to your chosen speed and stay there If you hold the switch at R A the vehicle will keep going faster until you release the switch or apply the brake So unless you want to go faster do not hold the switch at R A Increasing Speed While Using Cruise Control There are two ways to increase speed while using cruise control Use the accelerator pedal to get to the higher speed Press the SET button at the end of the lever then release the button and the accelerator pedal You will now cruise at the higher speed Move the cruise switch from ON to R A Hold it there until you get up to the speed you want and t
356. our wheels can destroy parts of your vehicle as well as the tires If you spin the wheels too fast while shifting your transaxle back and forth you can destroy your transaxle See Rocking Your Vehicle to Get It Out on page 4 31 For information about using tire chains on your vehicle see Tire Chains on page 5 70 Rocking Your Vehicle to Get It Out First turn your steering wheel left and right That will clear the area around your front wheels If your vehicle has traction control you should turn your traction control system off See Traction Control System TCS on page 4 10 Then shift back and forth between REVERSE R and a forward gear spinning the wheels as little as possible Release the accelerator pedal while you shift and press lightly on the accelerator pedal when the transaxle is in gear By slowly spinning your wheels in the forward and reverse directions you will cause a rocking motion that may free your vehicle If that does not get you out after a few tries you may need to be towed out If you do need to be towed out see Towing Your Vehicle on page 4 36 Loading Your Vehicle It is very important to know how much weight your vehicle can carry This weight is called the vehicle capacity weight and includes the weight of all occupants cargo and all nonfactory installed options Two labels on your vehicle show how much weight it may properly carry the Tire and Loading Information label and the Certification Tire
357. overed by your warranty Be sure the engine is not racing when shifting your vehicle AUTOMATIC OVERDRIVE D This position is for normal driving If you need more power for passing and you are Going less than 35 mph 55 km h push your accelerator pedal about halfway down Going about 35 mph 55 km h or more push the accelerator all the way down You will shift down to the next gear and have more power Notice If your vehicle seems to start up rather slowly or not shift gears when you go faster and you continue to drive your vehicle that way you could damage the transaxle Have your vehicle serviced right away You can drive in SECOND 2 when you are driving less than 35 mph 55 km h and AUTOMATIC OVERDRIVE D for higher speeds until then Warm Up Shift Your vehicle has a computer controlled transaxle designed to warm up the engine faster when the outside temperature is 35 F 2 C or colder You may notice that the transaxle will shift at a higher vehicle speed until the engine is warmed up This is a normal condition designed to provide heat to the passenger compartment and defrost the windows more quickly THIRD 3 This position is also used for normal driving but it offers more power and lower fuel economy than AUTOMATIC OVERDRIVE D Here are some times you might choose THIRD 3 instead of AUTOMATIC OVERDRIVE D When driving on hilly winding roads e When towing a trailer so there is le
358. p Lamps This procedure is for the liftgate mounted taillamps and back up lamps 1 Open the liftgate See Liftgate on page 2 11 for more information 2 Remove the panel inside the liftgate by lifting the tabs and pulling the panel off 3 Remove the seven wing nuts and the four outboard nuts two at each end 4 Gently lower the liftgate 5 Pull the lamp assembly directly rearward from the vehicle 5 52 Outboard Taillamp Center Taillamp Inboard Back Up Lamp Turn the bulb socket one quarter of a turn counterclockwise Pull the bulb assembly out from the lamp housing Pull the bulb out of the base Install the new bulb into the electrical connector Push the bulb firmly enough so that the tabs hook over the tab on the bulb 10 Put the bulb assembly back into the lamp housing Windshield Wiper Blade and turn the bulb socket one quarter of a turn clockwise Replacement 11 Replace the applique on the lifigate Windshield wiper blades should be inspected at least 12 Gently lift the liftgate twice a year for wear or cracking See Wiper Blade 13 Reinstall the seven wing nuts and the four Check under Owner Checks and Services on page 6 8 outboard nuts for more information 14 Reinstall the panel inside the liftgate by connecting Replacement blades come in different types and are the tabs removed in different ways For proper type and length i see Normal Maintenance Replacement Parts
359. pear on the display The radio will play the traffic announcement if the volume is low The radio will interrupt the play of a CD if the last tuned station broadcasts traffic announcements and the brackets are displayed This function does not apply to XM Satellite Radio Service Radio Messages CAL ERR Calibration Error The audio system has been calibrated for your vehicle from the factory If CAL ERR appears on the display it means that the radio has not been configured properly for the vehicle and it must be returned to the dealer for service LOCKED This message is displayed when the THEFTLOCK system has locked up Take your vehicle to the dealer for service If any error occurs repeatedly or if an error cannot be corrected contact your dealer 3 107 XMIM Radio Messages Radio Display sk XL Explicit Language XL on the radio display These channels or any others can be blocked at a Channels after the channel name customer s request by calling 1 800 852 XMXM 9696 indicates content with explicit language Updating Updating encryption The encryption code in the receiver is being updated and code no action is required This process should take no longer than 30 seconds No Signal Loss of signal The system is functioning correctly but the vehicle is ina location that is blocking the XM signal When the vehicle is moved into an open area the signal should return Loading XM Acquiring channel au
360. pear when the traction control system is limiting wheel spin You may feel or hear the system working but this is normal Slippery road conditions may exist if this message appears so adjust your driving accordingly The message will stay on for a few seconds after the traction control system stops limiting wheel spin 3 52 Engine Coolant Temperature Warning Message Canada United States This message will come on when your engine gets too hot If this message comes on it means that your engine coolant has overheated If you have been operating your vehicle under normal driving conditions you should pull off the road stop your vehicle and turn off the engine as soon as possible See Engine Overheating on page 5 28 Charging System Indicator Message The charging system battery symbol will come on in the message center when you turn on the ignition as a check to show you it is working It will remain on as long as the engine is not running It should go out once the engine is running If it stays on or comes on while you are driving you may have a problem with the charging system It could indicate that you have problems with a generator drive belt or another electrical problem Have it checked right away Driving while this indicator appears in the message center could drain your battery If you must drive a short distance with the message on be certain to turn off all your accessories such as the radi
361. play go back to Step 1 If both PTY and TRAF are on the radio will search for the selected PTY and traffic announcements 3 91 SCAN Scan the stations within a PTY by performing the following 1 Press P TYP to activate program type select mode P TYPE will appear on the display 2 Turn the AUDIO knob to select a PTY 3 Once the desired PTY is displayed press and hold either SEEK arrow and the radio will begin scanning the stations in the PTY 4 Press and hold either SEEK arrow to stop at a station lf both PTY and TRAF are on the radio will scan for the selected PTY and traffic announcements BAND Alternate Frequency Alternate frequency allows the radio to switch to a stronger station with the same program type To turn alternate frequency on press and hold BAND for two seconds AF ON will appear on the display The radio may switch to stations with a stronger frequency To turn alternate frequency off press and hold BAND again for two seconds AF OFF will appear on the display The radio will not switch to other stations This function does not apply to XM Satellite Radio Service 3 92 RDS Messages ALERT Alert warns of local or national emergencies When an alert announcement comes on the current radio station ALERT will appear on the display You will hear the announcement even if the volume is low or a cassette tape or CD is playing If a cassette tape or CD is playing play will stop duri
362. play mode and dynamic range compression The dynamic range compression feature can be used to reduce loud audio and increase low audio produced by some DVDs d Sound Press this button to move to the next language or commentary Press this button to call up a menu that will operate only when a DVD is playing The format and content of this function will vary for each disc 4d Rewind Press this button to reverse the DVD To stop reversing press this button again This button may not work when the DVD is playing the copyright information or the previews SRCE Source Press this button to switch the system between the DVD player and an auxiliary source E Stop Press this button to stop playing rewinding or fast forwarding a DVD or CD Press this button twice to return to the beginning of the DVD a Prior Chapter Track Press this button to go to the beginning of the current chapter or track Press this button again to return to the previous chapter or track This button may not work when the DVD is playing the copyright information or previews 1 through 0 Numeric Keypad The numeric keypad provides the capability of direct chapter title and track number selection 10 Double Digit Entries Press this button to select chapter title and track numbers greater than 9 Press this button before inputting the number RS Clear Press this button within three seconds after inputting a numeric selection to clear a
363. ple Treadwear 200 Traction AA Temperature A The following information relates to the system developed by the United States National Highway Traffic Safety Administration which grades tires by treadwear traction and temperature performance This applies only to vehicles sold in the United States The grades are molded on the sidewalls of most passenger car tires The Uniform Tire Quality Grading system does not apply to deep tread winter type snow tires space saver or temporary use spare tires tires with nominal rim diameters of 10 to 12 inches 25 to 30 cm or to some limited production tires While the tires available on General Motors passenger cars and light trucks may vary with respect to these grades they must also conform to federal safety requirements and additional General Motors Tire Performance Criteria TPC standards Treadwear The treadwear grade is a comparative rating based on the wear rate of the tire when tested under controlled conditions on a specified government test course For example a tire graded 150 would wear one and a half 1 5 times as well on the government course as a tire graded 100 The relative performance of tires depends upon the actual conditions of their use however and may depart significantly from the norm due to variations in driving habits service practices and differences in road characteristics and climate Traction AA A B C The traction grades from highest to lowes
364. ponder value of a new or replacement key Up to 10 additional keys may be programmed for the vehicle This procedure is for programming additional keys only If all the currently programmed keys are lost or do not operate you must see your dealer or a locksmith who can service PASS Key III to have keys made and programmed to the system See your dealer who can service PASS Key III to get a new key blank that is a cut exactly as the ignition key that operates the system Canadian Owners If you lose or damage your keys only a GM dealer can service PASS Key III to have new keys made To program additional keys you will need two current driver s keys black in color You must add a step to the following procedure After Step 3 repeat Steps 1 through 3 with the second current driver s key Then continue with Step 4 To program the new PK3 key do the following 1 Verify the new key has PK3 stamped on it 2 Insert the original key in the ignition and start the engine If the engine will not start see your dealer for service 3 After the engine has started turn the key to OFF and remove the key 4 Insert the key to be programmed and turn it to ON within 10 seconds of removing the previous key 5 The SECURITY message will turn off once the key has been programmed It may not be apparent that the SECURITY message went on due to how quickly the key is programmed 6 Repeat Steps 1 through 4 if additional keys are to
365. press and hold the eject button for five seconds to reset the CLEAN PLAYER indicator The radio will display to show the indicator was reset Cassettes are subject to wear and the sound quality may degrade over time Always make sure the cassette tape is in good condition before the tape player is serviced Care of Your CDs and DVDs Handle discs carefully Store them in their original cases or other protective cases and away from direct sunlight and dust If the surface of a disc is soiled dampen a clean soft cloth in a mild neutral detergent solution and clean it wiping from the center to the edge Be sure never to touch the side without writing when handling discs Pick up discs by grasping the outer edges or the edge of the hole and the outer edge Care of Your CD and DVD Player The use of CD lens cleaners for CDs is not advised due to the risk of contaminating the lens of the CD optics with lubricants internal to the CD mechanism Integrated Windshield Antenna The antenna in your vehicle is a very thin metal layer in the windshield The outline of the antenna can be seen near the edges of the windshield The connector is at the top of the windshield where the headliner ends If difficulty with remote transmitters is experienced such as a garage door opener try pointing the device through the very top of the windshield XM Satellite Radio Antenna System The XM Satellite Radio antenna is located on the
366. press the eject or DISP button When a CD is inserted the CD symbol will appear on the display As each new track starts to play the track number will appear on the display If the ignition or radio is turned off with a CD in the player it will stay in the player When the ignition or radio is turned on the CD will start playing where it stopped if it was the last selected audio source The CD player can play the smaller 3 inch 8 cm single CDs with an adapter ring Full size CDs and the smaller CDs are loaded in the same manner If playing a CD R the sound quality may be reduced due to CD R quality the method of recording the quality of the music that has been recorded and the way the CD R has been handled There may be an increase in skipping difficulty in finding tracks and or difficulty in loading and ejecting If these problems occur try a known good CD Do not add paper labels to CDs they could get caught in the CD player If an error appears on the display see CD Messages later in this section 144 Reverse Press and hold this pushbutton to reverse quickly within a track You will hear sound at a reduced volume Release this pushbutton to play the passage The elapsed time of the track will appear on the display 2 gt Forward Press and hold this pushbutton to advance quickly within a track You will hear sound at a reduced volume Release this pushbutton to play the passage The elapsed time of t
367. programmed to 3 Press the MODE button until UNLOCK FEEDBACK appears on the DIC 4 Press the SET button until the arrow is before LIGHTS or OFF 5 Press the MODE button until you have determined which mode you prefer to follow with the personalization The mode you selected is now set You can either exit programming mode by following the instructions later in this section or program the next feature available on your vehicle Lock Feedback The lock feedback feature can be programmed to one of the following modes OFF When LOCK is pressed on the remote keyless entry transmitter the headlamps and parking lamps will not flash and the horn will not sound LIGHTS When LOCK is pressed on the remote keyless entry transmitter the headlamps and parking lamps will flash briefly LIGHTS and HORN When LOCK is pressed a second time on the remote keyless entry transmitter within five seconds the headlamps and parking lamps will flash briefly and the horn will sound Your vehicle was originally programmed to LIGHTS and HORN The mode may have been changed since then To determine the current mode or to change the mode do the following 1 Follow the instructions for Entering Programming Mode listed previously 2 Press the MODE button until LOCK FEEDBACK appears on the DIC 3 Press the SET button until the arrow is before OFF LIGHTS or LIGHTS and HORN The mode you selected is now set You can either exit
368. quest of police or similar government office as part of GM s defense of litigation through the discovery process or e as required by law In addition once GM collects or receives data GM may e use the data for GM research needs make it available for research where appropriate confidentiality is to be maintained and need is shown or share summary data which is not tied to a specific vehicle with non GM organizations for research purposes Others such as law enforcement may have access to the special equipment that can read the information if they have access to the vehicle or the device that stores the data If your vehicle is equipped with OnStar please check the OnStar subscription service agreement or manual for information on its operations and data collection Reporting Safety Defects Reporting Safety Defects to the United States Government If you believe that your vehicle has a defect which could cause a crash or could cause injury or death you should immediately inform the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration NHTSA in addition to notifying General Motors If NHTSA receives similar complaints it may open an investigation and if it finds that a safety defect exists in a group of vehicles it may order a recall and remedy campaign However NHTSA cannot become involved in individual problems between you your dealer or General Motors To contact NHTSA you may either call t
369. r area of vision especially if you are following a larger vehicle Also you will not have adequate space if the vehicle ahead suddenly slows or stops Keep back a reasonable distance When it looks like a chance to pass is coming up start to accelerate but stay in the right lane and do not get too close Time your move so you will be increasing speed as the time comes to move into the other lane If the way is clear to pass you will have a running start that more than makes up for the distance you would lose by dropping back And if something happens to cause you to cancel your pass you need only slow down and drop back again and wait for another opportunity If other vehicles are lined up to pass a slow vehicle wait your turn But take care that someone is not trying to pass you as you pull out to pass the slow vehicle Remember to glance over your shoulder and check the blind spot Check your mirrors glance over your shoulder and start your left lane change signal before moving out of the right lane to pass When you are far enough ahead of the passed vehicle to see its front in your inside mirror activate your right lane change signal and move back into the right lane Remember that your right outside mirror is convex The vehicle you just passed may seem to be farther away from you than it really is Try not to pass more than one vehicle at a time on two lane roads Reconsider before passing the next vehicle Do no
370. r child restraint has one Be sure to follow the instructions that came with the child restraint Secure the child in the child restraint when and as the instructions say 1 Your vehicle has a right front passenger s frontal airbag See Passenger Sensing System on page 1 77 General Motors recommends that rear facing child restraints be secured in a rear seat even if the airbag is off If your child restraint is forward facing move the seat as far back as it will go before securing the child restraint in this seat See Manual Passenger Seat on page 1 3 or Six Way Power Seats on page 1 4 When the passenger sensing system has turned off the right front passenger s frontal airbag the off indicator in the passenger airbag status indicator should light and stay lit when you turn the ignition to ON or START See Passenger Airbag Status Indicator on page 3 42 2 Put the child restraint on the seat 3 Pick up the latch plate and run the lap and shoulder portions of the vehicle s safety belt through or around the restraint The child restraint instructions will show you how 4 Buckle the belt Make sure the release button is positioned so you would be able to unbuckle the safety belt quickly if you ever had to 1 65 5 To tighten the belt push down on the child restraint pull the shoulder portion of the belt to tighten the lap portion of the belt and feed the shoulder belt back into the retractor If you are using a fo
371. r salsa enes 5 98 Windshield Backglass and Wiper Blades 5 99 Climate Control System ceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeee tenes 3 28 DNU FRE SE SE ARD ED ERE E Ses REE SEER 3 30 Dual AUtOMAtG 2 scecc ciieecerisceendiacanamegienzemeny 3 33 Outlet Adjustment 2 2 2 0 ceeeeeeeeeeeeneee een eeeeenes 3 36 Comfort Guides Rear Safety Belt 0 1 40 Compact Spare Tire ceeeeeeeeeeeeeneee eee eeeeenes 5 94 Content Theft Deterrent ceceeeeeeeeeeeeeeenee 2 15 Control of a Vehicle cceceeeeeeeeeeeee eee eeeeeneees 4 6 Convenience Center Rear cceseeeeeeeeeee tenes 2 44 Convenience Net ccceeeeneeeeeeeaeeaeeaeeaeeaes 2 43 Coolant Engine Temperature Gage eceeeeeeeeeee ees 3 46 Engine Temperature Warning Message 3 52 Heater ENGINE cesteccactsgaesieia rodede tale 2 22 SGCM Surge Tank Pressure Cap 66 5 3 51 Cooling SySteM cceceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeaeeaeeneeaeeaes 5 30 Cruise Control Lever cccceeeeeeeeeeeeeeaeeaeenes 3 10 CUPNOIGEN S soon areeni ren Ra paR 2 39 Customer Assistance Information Courtesy Transportation sssssevererereree 7 7 Customer Assistance Information cont Customer Assistance for Text Telephone TTY USES xx Er eena en EEE REE 7 4 Customer Assistance Offices eeeeeeeeees 7 4 Customer Satisfaction Procedure 0008 7 2 GM Mobility Reimbursement Program
372. rage bin The extended rear convenience center has a maximum weight capacity of 400 Ibs 181 6 kg on top The shorter rear convenience center that comes with the optional third row stowable seat has a maximum weight capacity of 100 Ibs 45 4 kg on top 2 44 Removing the Extended Rear Convenience Center Make sure that all items have been removed from the top and the inside of the rear convenience center Remove the carpeted mat from the vehicle Lift the handle s on the top of the lid to open the rear storage bin The center lid will also need to be opened Remove the two nuts from inside the rear storage bin The nuts are located in the bottom of the bin Lift the rear storage bin and remove it from the rear of the vehicle Remove the two nuts inside the forward storage bin These nuts are located along the bottom of the center divider wall Lift the forward storage bin and remove it from the rear of the vehicle Reinstalling the Extended Rear Convenience Center 1 Make sure that all items have been removed from the rear of the vehicle 2 Remove the carpeted mat from the vehicle 5 Lift the rear bin into the back of the vehicle Place the rear bin over the center T shaped wall on the forward bin Push down to secure Align the rear bin over the rear mounting bolts 6 Put the nuts back onto the mounting bolts and tighten 3 Lift the forward bin into the back of the vehi
373. ram type select mode lf PTY times out and is no longer on the display go back to Step 1 lf both P TYPE and TRAF are on the radio will search for stations with the selected PTY and traffic announcements To use the PTY interrupt feature press and hold the P TYPE button until you hear a beep on the PTY you want to interrupt with When selected an asterisk will appear beside that PTY on the display You may select multiple interrupts if desired When you are listening to a CD the last selected DS station will interrupt play if that selected program type format is broadcast SCAN Scan the stations within a PTY by performing the following 1 Press the P TYPE button to activate program type select mode P TYPE and the last selected PTY will appear on the display 2 Turn the P TYPE knob to select a PTY 3 Once the desired PTY is displayed press and hold either SCAN arrow and the radio will begin scanning the stations in the PTY 4 Press either SCAN arrow to stop at a station lf both P TYPE and TRAF are on the radio will scan for stations with the selected PTY and traffic announcements BAND Alternate Frequency Alternate frequency allows the radio to switch to a stronger station with the same program type To turn alternate frequency on press and hold BAND for two seconds AF ON will appear on the display The radio may switch to stations with a stronger frequency To turn alternate frequency off press and
374. rcome by the extreme heat and suffer permanent injuries or even death from heat stroke Never leave a child a helpless adult or a pet alone in a vehicle especially with the windows closed in warm or hot weather Power Windows Switches on the driver s door armrest control each of the windows when the ignition is in ON ACCESSORY or when Retained Accessory Power RAP is active See Retained Accessory Power RAP on page 2 21 for more information In addition each passenger s door has a window switch The driver s power window switch has two down positions Push the rear of the switch to the first position to lower the window normally Press the rear of any passenger window switch and that window will open Press the front of any switch to close the window Express Down Window The driver s window switch also has an express down feature This switch is labeled AUTO To activate the express down feature push the rear of the driver s window switch to the second position then release it The window will lower completely To stop the window while it is lowering press the front of the switch To raise the window press and hold the front of the switch Window Lock Out The driver s window controls also include a lock out switch Press the right side of the WDO LOCK switch to stop rear passengers from lowering their window The driver can still control all of the windows with the lock on Press the other side of
375. re some things to know It can be dangerous to get out of your vehicle if the shift lever is not fully in PARK P with the parking brake firmly set Your vehicle can roll Do not leave your vehicle when the engine is running unless you have to If you have left the engine running the vehicle can move suddenly You or others could be injured To be sure your vehicle will not move even when you are on fairly level ground always set your parking brake and move the shift lever to PARK P Idling the engine with the climate control system off could allow dangerous exhaust into your vehicle See the earlier caution under Engine Exhaust on page 2 29 Also idling in a closed in place can let deadly carbon monoxide CO into your vehicle even if the climate control fan is at the highest setting One place this can happen is a garage Exhaust with CO can come in easily If you are pulling a trailer see Towing a Trailer on Follow the proper steps to be sure your vehicle will not move See Shifting Into Park P on page 2 27 NEVER park in a garage with the engine page 4 38 running Another closed in place can be a blizzard See Winter Driving on page 4 26 2 30 Mirrors Manual Rearview Mirror The vehicle may have a rearview mirror that can be adjusted for day or night driving Push or pull the tab at the bottom of the mirror to adjust it for day or night conditions The mirror s two outer buttons operate
376. re the 30 seconds if the following conditions are met The ignition is turned to ON The exterior lamp control is turned out of the AUTO position If your vehicle is equipped with the Driver Information Center DIC see DIC Vehicle Personalization on page 3 66 to program the headlamp exit delay feature Entry Lighting If your vehicle has entry lighting the interior of your vehicle will illuminate for 25 seconds so you can see inside your vehicle before you enter To activate entry lighting do one of the following Unlock a door using the key when the interior lamp control is in the DOOR position and when the ignition is in OFF Press UNLOCK on the remote keyless entry transmitter when the interior lamp control is in the DOOR position and when the ignition is in OFF After 25 seconds the interior lamps will fade out The lamps will turn off before 25 seconds if you do one of the following Press LOCK on the remote keyless entry transmitter Press the front of the power door lock switch Turn the ignition to ON When any door is opened entry lighting is cancelled The interior lamps will stay on while any door or the liftgate is open and fade out when all the doors are closed 3 17 Delayed Lighting If your vehicle has delayed lighting it will continue to illuminate the interior for 25 seconds after all doors have been closed The lamps will continue to illuminate when the following conditions are
377. re tire has not lowered tighten the cable all the way and then loosen it at least two times If the spare tire did lower to the ground continue with Step 4 under Removing the Spare Tire Vehicles without the Rear Convenience Center listed previously If you still cannot lower the spare tire to the ground see Secondary Latch System on page 5 84 Removing the Spare Tire Vehicles with a Rear Convenience Center The compact spare tire is located under the vehicle ahead of the rear bumper See Compact Spare Tire on page 5 94 for more information about the compact spare A Rear Convenience Hoist Shaft D Center E Compact Spare Tire B Folding Wrench F Retainer C Storage G Hoist Shaft Compartment Assembly Cap Hole 5 77 1 Open the storage compartment door of the convenience center that is nearest the liftgate and remove the cap on the bottom of the storage compartment 2 Flip the cut out carpet that is located through the hole of the storage compartment 3 Attach the folding wrench into the hoist shaft 4 Turn the folding wrench counterclockwise to lower the spare tire to the ground Continue turning the wrench until the spare tire can be pulled out from under the vehicle 5 Tilt the retainer and slip it through the wheel opening to remove the spare tire from the cable 6 Turn the wrench clockwise to raise the cable back up after removing the spare tire Do not store a full size or a flat ro
378. recommends that you get tires with that same TPC Spec number That way your vehicle will continue to have tires that are designed to give proper endurance handling speed rating load range traction ride and other things during normal service on your vehicle If your tires have an all season tread design the TPC number will be followed by an MS for mud and snow If you ever replace your tires with those not having a TPC Spec number make sure they are the same size load range speed rating and construction type bias bias belted or radial as your original tires 5 66 Mixing tires could cause you to lose control while driving If you mix tires of different sizes or types radial and bias belted tires the vehicle may not handle properly and you could have a crash Using tires of different sizes may also cause damage to your vehicle Be sure to use the same size and type tires on all wheels It s all right to drive with your compact spare temporarily it was developed for use on your vehicle See Compact Spare Tire on page 5 94 If you use bias ply tires on your vehicle the wheel rim flanges could develop cracks after many miles of driving A tire and or wheel could fail suddenly causing a crash Use only radial ply tires with the wheels on your vehicle Uniform Tire Quality Grading Quality grades can be found where applicable on the tire sidewall between tread shoulder and maximum section width For exam
379. red for sale has required the use of safety belts Even if you are in a vehicle that has airbags you still have to buckle up to get the most protection That is true not only in frontal collisions but especially in side and other collisions With safety belts you slow down as the vehicle does You get more time to stop You stop over more distance and your strongest bones take the forces That is why safety belts make such good sense 1 24 Q If I am a good driver and never drive far from home why should I wear safety belts A You may be an excellent driver but if you are in an accident even one that is not your fault you and your passengers can be hurt Being a good driver does not protect you from things beyond your control such as bad drivers Most accidents occur within 25 miles 40 km of home And the greatest number of serious injuries and deaths occur at speeds of less than 40 mph 65 km h Safety belts are for everyone How to Wear Safety Belts Properly This part is only for people of adult size Be aware that there are special things to know about safety belts and children And there are different rules for smaller children and babies If a child will be riding in your vehicle see Older Children on page 1 43 or Infants and Young Children on page 1 45 Follow those rules for everyone s protection First you will want to know which restraint systems your vehicle has We will start with the
380. rent Feature eeeeeeeeeeeeeees 3 132 Audio Steering Wheel Controls 0055 3 133 Radio Reception asirieni eataa 3 134 Care of Your Cassette Tape Player 3 134 Care of Your CDs and DVDS eeeeeees 3 135 Care of Your CD and DVD Player 3 135 Integrated Windshield Antenna 3 135 XM Satellite Radio Antenna System 3 135 NOTES 3 3 Instrument Panel Overview The main components of the instrument panel are the following A B Exterior Interior Lamps Control See Exterior Lamps on page 3 14 and Interior Lamps on page 3 16 Turn Signal Multifunction Lever See Turn Signal Multifunction Lever on page 3 7 Hazard Warning Flasher Button See Hazard Warning Flashers on page 3 6 Instrument Panel Cluster See Instrument Panel Cluster on page 3 38 Shift Lever See Automatic Transaxle Operation on page 2 23 Instrument Panel Outlets See Outlet Adjustment on page 3 36 Audio System See Audio System s on page 3 75 Audio Steering Wheel Controls See Audio Steering Wheel Controls on page 3 133 Head Up Display Switch and Driver Information Center DIC Controls If Equipped See Head Up Display HUD on page 3 21 and DIC Controls and Displays on page 3 64 Hood Release See Hood Release on page 5 11 Ignition Switch See Ignition Positions on page 2
381. retensiOnerS sernesta cece bobler 1 42 Reminder Light eisern sa innse monos anaras 3 41 Safety Belts Gare OF HERRER ESSEN RES panee e ET SEERE REE SEER 5 98 Center Rear Passenger Position 1 38 Driver POSION saae esa oscaniciasantncs 1 25 How to Wear Safety Belts Properly 1 25 Questions and Answers About Safety Belts 1 24 Safety Belts cont Rear Safety Belt Comfort Guides for Children and Small AdSense 1 40 Rear Seat Passengers ceeeeeeeeeeeeeeee ees 1 34 Right Front Passenger Position 0 1 34 Safety Belt Extender cc eeeeeeeeeeeeee tees 1 42 Safety Belt Use During Pregnancy 1 34 Safety Belts Are for Everyone eeeeeeee 1 20 Shoulder Belt Height Adjuster 1 33 Safety Warnings and Symbols eceeeeeeeeeeees iii Scheduled Maintenance ecceeeeeeeeeeeeeeee ees 6 4 Seats Captain Chait ssccss ssscreaciinviesnstets ghivisas dave 1 13 Four Way Manual Driver Seat c eeeeeee ee 1 3 Head Restraints ceceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeseeees 1 7 Heated Seats 0 2 0 cecececeeeeeeeeceeeeeeeeeeeseeeeneee 1 5 Manual Lumbar ssni monano 1 5 Manual Passenger 1 W G sssseseeer serene ener een rene 1 3 MEmMOTY arannana a role rekte 2 47 Rear Seat Operation W sssseeereeereeeere nerne 1 8 Reclining Seatbacks u dsseeeeeeerererer ere rernee 1 6 Six Way Power Seats
382. revent most deposit related problems Gasolines containing oxygenates such as ethers and ethanol and reformulated gasolines may be available in your area to contribute to clean air General Motors recommends that you use these gasolines particularly if they comply with the specifications described earlier Notice Your vehicle was not designed for fuel that contains methanol Do not use fuel containing methanol It can corrode metal parts in your fuel system and also damage the plastic and rubber parts That damage would not be covered under your warranty Some gasolines that are not reformulated for low emissions may contain an octane enhancing additive called methylcyclopentadienyl manganese tricarbonyl MMT ask the attendant where you buy gasoline whether the fuel contains MMT General Motors does not recommend the use of such gasolines Fuels containing MMT can reduce the life of spark plugs and the performance of the emission control system may be affected The malfunction indicator lamp may turn on If this occurs return to your authorized GM dealer for service Fuels in Foreign Countries If you plan on driving in another country outside the United States or Canada the proper fuel may be hard to find Never use leaded gasoline or any other fuel not recommended in the previous text on fuel Costly repairs caused by use of improper fuel would not be covered by your warranty To check the fuel availability ask an auto clu
383. rheated Engine Protection Operating Mode on page 5 30 for information on driving to a safe place in an emergency If No Steam Is Coming From Your Engine If you get an engine overheat warning but see or hear no steam the problem may not be too serious Sometimes the engine can get a little too hot when you Climb a long hill on a hot day Stop after high speed driving Idle for long periods in traffic Tow a trailer If you get the overheat warning with no sign of steam try this for a minute or so 1 If your air conditioner is on turn it off 2 Turn on your heater to full hot at the highest fan speed and open the windows as necessary 3 If you are in a traffic jam shift to NEUTRAL N otherwise shift to the highest gear while driving AUTOMATIC OVERDRIVE D If you no longer have the overheat warning you can drive Just to be safe drive slower for about 10 minutes If the warning does not come back on you can drive normally If the warning continues pull over stop and park your vehicle right away If there is still no sign of steam idle the engine for three minutes while you are parked If you still have the warning turn off the engine and get everyone out of the vehicle until it cools down Also see Overheated Engine Protection Operating Mode later in this section You may decide not to lift the hood but to get service help right away 5 29 Overheated Engine Protection Operatin
384. river s temperature knob is pressed to select AUTO and the temperature is set the system will automatically control the inside temperature the air delivery and the fan speed AUTO will also appear on the display Your vehicle may have the dual automatic climate control system With this system you can control the heating cooling and ventilation for your vehicle To place the entire system in automatic mode do the following SERNEENEN 1 Press the driver s temperature knob to turn the system on 2 Adjust the temperature to a comfortable setting ESE ro Choosing the coldest or warmest temperature will pie move not cause the system to heat or cool any faster In cold weather the system will start at reduced fan speeds to avoid blowing cold air into your vehicle until warmer air is available Then as the air warms it will be delivered through the instrument panel outlets The length of time needed for warm up will depend on the outside temperature and the length of time that has elapsed since your vehicle was last driven 3 Wait for the system to regulate This may take from 10 to 30 minutes Then adjust the temperature as necessary 4 To turn the system off press the passenger s knob 3 33 Manual Operation MODE Press this button to manually change the direction of airflow in your vehicle keep pressing the button until the desired mode appears on the display To change the current mode
385. rming grid to remove fog from the rear window GW REAR Press this button to turn the rear window defogger on or off An indicator light in the button will come on to let you know that the rear window defogger is activated The rear window defogger will turn off approximately 10 minutes after the button is pressed If turned on again the defogger will only run for approximately five minutes before turning off The defogger can also be turned off by pressing the button again or by turning off the engine Notice Don t use anything sharp on the inside of the rear window If you do you could cut or damage the warming grid and the repairs wouldn t be covered by your warranty Do not attach a temporary vehicle license tape a decal or anything similar to the defogger grid 3 30 Dual Climate Control System Your vehicle may have a dual climate control system With this system you can control the heating cooling and ventilation for your vehicle a Of 8 a Tm 9 FEAR GE Operation Turn the right knob clockwise or counterclockwise to direct the airflow inside your vehicle To change the current mode select one of the following pe Vent This mode directs air to the instrument panel outlets YA Bi Level This mode directs half of the air to the instrument panel outlets then directs the remaining air to the floor outlets Cooler air is direct
386. rning lights and gages could also save you or others from injury Warning lights come on when there may be or is a problem with one of your vehicle s functions As you will see in the details on the next few pages some warning lights come on briefly when you start the engine just to let you know they re working If you are familiar with this section you should not be alarmed when this happens Gages can indicate when there may be or is a problem with one of your vehicle s functions Often gages and warning lights work together to let you know when there s a problem with your vehicle When one of the warning lights comes on and stays on when you are driving or when one of the gages shows there may be a problem check the section that tells you what to do about it Please follow this manual s advice Waiting to do repairs can be costly and even dangerous So please get to know your warning lights and gages They re a big help Your vehicle also has a message center that works along with the warning lights and gages See Message Center on page 3 51 3 37 Instrument Panel Cluster Your instrument panel cluster is designed to let you know at a glance how your vehicle is running You ll know how fast you re going how much fuel you re using and many other things you ll need to drive safely and economically The indicator warning lights and gages are explained on the following pages 4 2 Xv r A SN SERVICE Za08 A oro
387. roof of your vehicle Keep this antenna clear of snow and ice build up for clear radio reception The performance of the XM system may be affected if the sunroof is open Loading items onto the roof of your vehicle can interfere with the performance of the XM system Make sure that the XM satellite antenna is not obstructed 3 135 4 NOTES 3 136 Section 4 Your Driving the Road and Your Vehicle 4 2 Driver Behavior sss 5 bende ti osoita 4 2 Driving Environment seeeeeeeee reenter eee ees 4 2 Vehicle Desig wisi decccvtadewedetandane tet nancnasewedes naa 4 2 Defensive Driving c ccceeeeeeeeeeeeenereeeeeeeees 4 3 Drunken DIVING lt cccnsicetunewienn riae r ae EO i 4 3 Control of a Vehicle cceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeee een eeee 4 6 Braking saanen eine ea ae d aE dub Sie HORDE EDEN 4 6 Anti Lock Brake System ABS o ae 4 7 Braking in Emergencies u sssseserereesersekene 4 9 Traction Control System TCS aaee 4 10 All Wheel Drive AWD System eeeeeeee 4 11 HIGENN saeic taaevanxaidtwisad aka a deena aneeactaee BEN KEE 4 12 Off Road Recovery cceceeeeeeeeeeeeeeee eee eee tenes 4 14 PASSING sssteestieaieteciuce tigen ed ister eameceeacasy 4 14 LOSS Of GOMOD 2 once cect che nnceuiiensceneenedececcingts 4 15 Driving Your Vehicle DrivingatiNiQht aars ener delen 4 17 Driving in Rain and on Wet Roads 4 18 CV DIVING aeniea aen E ER
388. rs Balance Fade AUDIO To adjust the balance between the right and the left speakers push the AUDIO knob until BAL appears on the display Turn the knob to move the sound toward the right or the left speakers To adjust the fade between the front and rear speakers push and hold the AUDIO knob until FAD appears on the display Turn the knob to move the sound toward the front or the rear speakers To adjust the balance and the fade to the middle position select balance or fade and push and hold the AUDIO knob The display level will be adjusted to the middle position and you will hear a beep To adjust all tone and speaker controls to the middle position push and hold the AUDIO knob when no tone or speaker controls are displayed CENTERED will appear on the display and you will hear one beep 3 104 Finding a Program Type PTY Station RDS and XM To select and find a desired PTY perform the following 1 Press the P TYPE button to activate program type select mode P TYPE and the last selected PTY will appear on the display 2 Turn the P TYPE knob to select a PTY 3 Once the desired PTY is displayed press either SEEK arrow to select and to take you to the PTY s first station 4 Togo to another station within that PTY and the PTY is displayed press either SEEK arrow once If the PTY is not displayed press either SEEK arrow twice to display the PTY and then to go to another station 5 Press P TYPE to exit prog
389. rt while the vehicle is raised Do not allow passengers to remain in the vehicle To be even more certain the vehicle will not move you should put blocks at the front and rear of the tire farthest away from the one being changed That would be the tire on the other side at the opposite end of the vehicle When you have a flat tire use the following example as a guide to assist you in the placement of wheel blocks FS The following information will tell you next how to use the jack and change a tire 5 73 Removing the Spare Tire and Tools The equipment you will need is located in the storage compartment on the passenger s side at the rear of the vehicle 1 Open the jack storage compartment by lifting up the tab and pulling the cover off 5 74 A B C Jack D Folding Wrench Wing Bolt E Wing Nut Jacking Instructions F J Hook Remove the jack and jacking tools by turning the wing bolt counterclockwise Lift up slightly on the jack to remove it from the bracket Then take it out of the storage compartment Separate the jack and remove the folding wrench from the jack The tools you will be using include the jack A folding wrench B wing nut C and J hook D Removing the Spare Tire Vehicles without a Rear Convenience Center The compact spare tire is located under the vehicle behind the rear bumper Use the spare tire hoist to raise lower and store the comp
390. rtesy rental Additional Program Information Courtesy Transportation is available during the Bumper to Bumper warranty coverage period but it is not part of the New Vehicle Limited Warranty A separate booklet entitled Warranty and Owner Assistance Information furnished with each new vehicle provides detailed warranty coverage information Courtesy Transportation is available only at participating dealers and all program options such as shuttle service may not be available at every dealer Please contact your dealer for specific information about availability All Courtesy Transportation arrangements will be administered by appropriate dealer personnel Canadian Vehicles For warranty repairs during the Complete Vehicle Coverage period of the General Motors of Canada New Vehicle Limited Warranty alternative transportation may be available under the Courtesy Transportation Program Please consult your dealer for details General Motors reserves the right to unilaterally modify change or discontinue Courtesy Transportation at any time and to resolve all questions of claim eligibility pursuant to the terms and conditions described herein at its sole discretion Vehicle Data Collection and Event Data Recorders Your vehicle like other modern motor vehicles has a number of sophisticated computer systems that monitor and control several aspects of the vehicle s performance Your vehicle uses on board vehicle computers to monitor
391. rward facing child restraint you may find it helpful to use your knee to push down on the child restraint as you tighten the belt You should not be able to pull more of the belt from the retractor once the lock has been set 6 Push and pull the child restraint in different directions to be sure it is secure 1 66 7 If your vehicle has the passenger sensing system and the airbag is off the off indicator will be lit and stay lit in the inside rearview mirror when the key is turned to ON or START If a child restraint has been installed and the on indicator is lit turn the vehicle off Remove the child restraint from the vehicle and reinstall the child restraint If after reinstalling the child restraint and restarting the vehicle the on indicator is still lit check to make sure that the vehicle s seatback is not pressing the child restraint into the seat cushion If this happens slightly recline the vehicle s seatback and adjust the seat cushion if possible Also make sure the child restraint is not trapped under the vehicle head restraint If this happens adjust the head restraint If the on indicator is still lit secure the child in the child restraint in a rear seat position in the vehicle and check with your dealer To remove the child restraint just unbuckle the vehicle s safety belt and let it go back all the way The safety belt will move freely again and be ready to work for an adult or larger child passeng
392. s u dsseeeerre 3 16 Nee ee ight SE SE SS a 3 41 terior Lampe COMMON nn Passenger Airbag Status indicator 0 3 42 Entry Lighting n 3 47 Brake System Warning Light 1 2 3 44 Delayed Lighting cccccssseseseseseseseseeeeeeees 3 18 Anti Lock Brake System Warning Light 3 45 Exit Lighting ccm enceeereeerrreerrr ere rrrr 3 18 Traction Control System TCS Warning Light 3 45 Perimeter Lighting oc mor see painea 3 19 Engine Coolant Temperature Gage 3 46 Front Reading L 3 19 Malfunction Indicator Lamp eeeeeeeeeeee 3 46 ling LAMPS cs eesteeeeee tee eet eteees Hiahbeam On Light 3 49 Rear Reading Lamps cccccccccesseeeeesseees 3 19 i a GIN shnsemncaataincnnnetiiieadesansensea tte ea Cargo Lampisen a E EE 3 19 Ver AJE i aaae a ER SEE 7 Section 3 Message Center 0 eerren reee 3 51 Passenger Seatbelt Reminder Message 3 51 Service Traction System Warning Message 3 51 Traction Active Message eeeeeeeeneeeee tees 3 52 Engine Coolant Temperature Warning Message scat iva dcoecnncenthongdiaveastanransmeaientawnane 3 52 Charging System Indicator Message 3 53 Reduced Engine Power Message 0655 3 53 Low Oil Pressure Message 6 ceeeeeeeeee ees 3 54 Low Engine Oil Level Message 0eeee 3 55 Change Engine Oil Message eeeeeeeeeee 3 55 Low Tire Message cseeeeeeeeee
393. s available for the selected category the chosen category The system is working properly XM Locked Theft lock active The XM receiver in the vehicle may have previously been in another vehicle For security purposes XM receivers cannot be swapped between vehicles If this message is received after having your vehicle serviced check with your GM dealer Radio ID Radio ID label If tuned to channel 0 this message will alternate with the channel 0 XM Radio 8 digit radio ID label This label is needed to activate the service Unknown Radio ID not known If this message is received when tuned to channel 0 there should only be if may be a receiver fault Consult with your GM dealer hardware failure Chk XMRevr Hardware failure If this message does not clear within a short period of time the receiver may have a fault Consult with your GM dealer 3 95 Playing a Cassette Tape The tape player is built to work best with tapes that are up to 30 to 45 minutes long on each side Tapes longer than that are so thin they may not work well in this player The longer side with the tape visible should face to the right If you hear nothing or hear a garbled sound the tape may not be in squarely Press the eject button to remove the tape and start over If the ignition and radio are off press the eject or the DISP button to insert and to begin play of a tape If the ignition is on and the radio is off the tape can be inserted and will begin
394. s cle esi eaten eaten 2 9 DOOM serrera asians cain eer ET ethene 2 8 Lockout Protection 0 c eeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeees 2 11 Power Door wi cs rn rarere ote 2 9 Programmable Automatic Door Locks 2 10 Rear Door Security LOCKS c eeeeeeeeee ees 2 10 Loss Of CONO saas are ER ienei 4 15 Low Brake Fluid Warning Message 655 3 59 Low Engine Oil Level Message 0 0eeeeees 3 55 Low Fuel Warning Message 0 eeeeeeee eens 3 58 Low Oil Pressure Message eeeeeeeeeeee ees 3 54 Low Tire Message cceceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeereeene 3 56 Low Washer Fluid Warning Message 3 58 Lumbar Manual Controls senner seian 1 5 Maintenance Schedule Additional Required Services 1 6 6 At Each Fuel Fill srein e 6 8 At Least Once a Month cccccc cece ee eee ees 6 9 At Least Once a Year ccc ccccccc cece ee eeeeeeeees 6 9 Maintenance Schedule cont INTPOQUCTIONN cds maa rear nr naaa 6 2 Maintenance Footnotes sssscserereeerseseernene 6 7 Maintenance Record eceeeeeeeeeeee eee eee es 6 14 Maintenance Requirements eccerre 6 2 Normal Maintenance Replacement Parts 6 13 Owner Checks and Services 0 eeeeeeeeeee 6 8 Recommended Fluids and Lubricants 6 12 Scheduled Maintenance ceeeeeeeeeeneee ees 6 4 USING VOUT ss ceetcisceeesacakstdansaceadesatyecudyeahauneeias 6 2
395. s used properly There are two modes to clear fog or frost from your windshield Use the defog mode to clear the windows of fog or moisture and warm the passengers Use the defrost mode to remove fog or frost from the windshield more quickly Use the MODE button to select the defog mode 5 Defog This mode directs air to the windshield and the floor outlets When you select this mode the system turns off recirculation and runs the air conditioning compressor unless the outside temperature is at or below freezing The recirculation mode cannot be selected while in the defog mode Press the defrost button to select defrost W Defrost Pressing this button directs most of the air to the windshield and the side window outlets with some air directed to the floor outlets In this mode the system will automatically turns off recirculation and run the air conditioning compressor unless the outside temperature is at or below freezing Recirculation cannot be selected while in the defrost mode Do not drive the vehicle until all the windows are clear 3 35 Rear Window Defogger The rear window defogger uses a warming grid to remove fog from the rear window GW REAR Press this button to turn the rear window defogger on or off An indicator light in the button will come on to let you know that the rear window defogger is activated The rear window defogger will turn off approximately 10 minutes after the button is pressed If t
396. saves fuel When you run the engine make it go a little faster than just idle That is push the accelerator slightly This uses less fuel for the heat that you get and it Keeps the battery charged You will need a well charged battery to restart the vehicle and possibly for signaling later on with your headlamps Let the heater run for a while You can run the engine to keep warm but be careful 4 29 Then shut the engine off and close the window almost all the way to preserve the heat Start the engine again and repeat this only when you feel really uncomfortable from the cold But do it as little as possible Preserve the fuel as long as you can To help keep warm you can get out of the vehicle and do some fairly vigorous exercises every half hour or so until help comes If You Are Stuck In Sand Mud Ice or Snow In order to free your vehicle when it is stuck you will need to spin the wheels but you do not want to spin your wheels too fast The method known as rocking can help you get out when you are stuck but you must use caution 4 30 If you let your tires spin at high speed they can explode and you or others could be injured And the transaxle or other parts of the vehicle can overheat That could cause an engine compartment fire or other damage When you are stuck spin the wheels as little as possible Do not spin the wheels above 35 mph 55 km h as shown on the speedometer Notice Spinning y
397. sh down the tabs on the cover so that it rests in the groove This secures the cover in place 5 89 Storing the Flat Tire Vehicles with a Stowable Seat A Rear Convenience D Stowable Seat Strap Center E Cargo Net Hook B Full Size Tire F J Hook C D Ring G Wing Nut 1 If the seatback is not in an upright position move it to an upright position 2 There is a strap attached to each side of the stowable seat Hook the straps to the cargo net hook in the rear of the vehicle 5 90 Flip the D ring so it is pointing outward Open the convenience center cover Stand the full size tire up in the tray against the back of the seat with the valve stem pointing out Remove the J hook and the wing nut from the back of the jack access door Assemble the wing nut and the J hook Install the wing nut and the J hook to the D ring through the center hole of the tire Tighten the wing nut to secure the tire to the seatback Push and pull on the tire to make sure the tire is secure and does not move Put back all tools as they were stored in the jack storage compartment and put the compartment cover back on Slip the tabs on the side of the compartment cover into the cover opening Push the cover in place and push down the tabs on the cover so that it rests in the groove This secures the cover in place Storing the Flat Tire Vehicles with a Stowable Seatback Folded Flat A Stowable Se
398. smitter will not unlock your vehicle Each vehicle can have a maximum of four transmitters matched to it See your dealer to match transmitters to another vehicle Battery Replacement Under normal use the battery in your remote keyless entry transmitter should last about three years KEY FOB BATTERY LOW United States Canada You can tell the battery is weak if the KEY FOB BATTERY LOW message appears in the message center If you get this message the battery in the key fob needs to be replaced Notice When replacing the battery use care not to touch any of the circuitry Static from your body transferred to these surfaces may damage the transmitter 1 Insert a flat object such as a coin into the slot on the side of the transmitter and twist to separate the halves 2 Gently pry the battery out of the transmitter Do not use the metal flanges to remove the battery 3 Replace the battery 4 Reassemble the transmitter Make sure the halves are snapped together tightly so water will not get in 5 Press and hold the LOCK and UNLOCK buttons for seven seconds to synchronize the transmitter 6 Check the transmitter operation Doors and Locks There are several ways to lock and unlock your vehicle From the outside use your key or the remote keyless entry transmitter Door Locks To unlock the driver s door from the outside with the key insert the key and turn it toward the front of the ve
399. ss shifting between gears e When going down a steep hill SECOND 2 This position gives you more power but lower fuel economy than THIRD 8 You can use SECOND 2 on hills It can help control your speed as you go down steep mountain roads but then you would also want to use your brakes off and on Notice Driving in SECOND 2 for more than 25 miles 40 km or at speeds over 55 mph 90 km h may damage the transaxle Also shifting into SECOND 2 at speeds above 65 mph 105 km h can cause damage Drive in THIRD 3 or AUTOMATIC OVERDRIVE D instead of SECOND 2 Notice If your vehicle seems to start up rather slowly or if it seems not to shift gears as you go faster something may be wrong with a transaxle system sensor If you drive very far that way your vehicle can be damaged So if this happens have your vehicle serviced right away Until then you can use SECOND 2 when you are driving less than 35 mph 55 km h and THIRD 3 for higher speeds FIRST 1 This position gives you even more power but lower fuel economy than SECOND 2 You can use it on very steep hills or in deep snow or mud If the shift lever is put in FIRST 1 the transaxle will not downshift into first gear until the vehicle is going slow enough Notice Spinning the tires or holding the vehicle in one place on a hill using only the accelerator pedal may damage the transaxle If you are stuck do not spin the tires When stopping on a
400. ssemblies secondary latches pivots spring anchor and release pawl hood and door hinges rear folding seats and liftgate hinges More frequent lubrication may be required when exposed to a corrosive environment Applying silicone grease on weatherstrips with a clean cloth will make them last longer seal better and not stick or squeak g Check system for interference or binding and for damaged or missing parts Replace parts as needed Replace any components that have high effort or excessive wear Do not lubricate accelerator or cruise control cables h Change automatic transaxle fluid and filter if the vehicle is mainly driven under one or more of these conditions In heavy city traffic where the outside temperature regularly reaches 90 F 32 or higher In hilly or mountainous terrain When doing frequent trailer towing Uses such as found in taxi police or delivery service i Drain flush and refill cooling system See Engine Coolant on page 5 25 for what to use Inspect hoses Clean radiator condenser pressure cap and filler neck Pressure test the cooling system and pressure cap k f you drive regularly under dusty conditions the filter may require replacement more often I If you drive regularly under dusty conditions inspect the filter at each engine oil change Owner Checks and Services These owner checks and services should be performed at the intervals specified to help ensure the
401. ssembly back into the lamp housing and turn the bulb socket one quarter of a turn counterclockwise 11 Align the retaining clips on the back of the headlamp with the rectangular holes in the mounting panel 7 Pull the bulb assembly out from the lamp housing 12 Push firmly on both ends of the headlamp to snap it into position 13 Push the retaining clip down to its original position 14 Reinstall the wing stud 5 50 Front Turn Signal Sidemarker and Parking Lamps To replace the front turn signal parking or sidemarker lamp bulbs follow the headlamp bulb replacement procedure and replace the appropriate bulb Taillamps Turn Signal and Stoplamps 1 Open the liftgate See Liftgate on page 2 11 for more information 2 Remove the two screws on the inboard taillamp panel v 10 11 Pull the lamp directly rearward from the vehicle Turn the bulb socket one quarter of a turn counterclockwise Pull the bulb assembly out from the lamp housing Unhook the electrical connector by lifting up the tabs and separate the connector from the bulb base Install the new bulb into the electrical connector Push the bulb firmly enough so that the tabs hook over the tab on the bulb Reverse the steps to reinstall Reinstall the lamp to its pocket by lining up the mounting pin and pushing forward to set the position Reinstall the screws removed in Step 2 Close the liftgate 5 51 Taillamps and Back U
402. sted prices are quoted in U S funds Canadian residents are to make checks payable in U S funds 4 NOTES 7 14 A All Wheel Drive AWD System n se 2 26 All Wheel Drive Disable Warning Message 3 57 About Driving Your Vehicle ccceeeeeee nese eee eeees ii All Wheel Drive AWD System 000eeee 4 11 Accessory IMATAN itane aeeai oaair 5 70 Antenna Integrated Windshield 3 135 Accessory Power Outlets ssseseeeeereeee erne 3 26 Antenna XMIM Satellite Radio Adding Equipment to Your Airbag Equipped Antenna System ssssseseeeeeeenrke rr knnrer 3 135 VENICE 2209 erne sk ena aa 1 82 Anti Lock Brake System ABS cdcsseeeeeeee 4 7 Additives FUS 522 ciiid cad eka btneinnena iaenins cinene nis 5 6 Anti Lock Brake System Warning Light 3 45 Add On Electrical Equipment ceee 5 104 Appearance Care see drseg ete Se sere dercaduesseuseusecus 5 95 Air Cleaner Filter Engine c eceeeeeeeeeeees 5 21 Aluminum or Chrome Plated Wheels 5 100 Ait Conditioning 1 3 28 3 30 3 33 Care of Safety Belts scener 5 98 Airbag Chemical Paint Spotting 0 c ee 5 101 Passenger Status Indicator cee 3 42 Cleaning Exterior Lamps Lenses 5 5 99 Readiness Light eeeeeeeteeeteererreeeey 3 41 Fabric Catpet passion monroe nene eiaa raa naaa RA 5 95 Airbag Sensing and Diagnostic Module SDM
403. stem If it is you should have your brake system fixed since a leak means that sooner or later your brakes will not work well or will not work at all So it is not a good idea to top off your brake fluid Adding brake fluid will not correct a leak If you add fluid when your linings are worn then you will have too much fluid when you get new brake linings You should add or remove brake fluid as necessary only when work is done on the brake hydraulic system If you have too much brake fluid it can spill on the engine The fluid will burn if the engine is hot enough You or others could be burned and your vehicle could be damaged Add brake fluid only when work is done on the brake hydraulic system When your brake fluid falls to a low level your brake warning light will come on See Brake System Warning Light on page 3 44 What to Add When you do need brake fluid use only DOT 3 brake fluid Use new brake fluid from a sealed container only See Recommended Fluids and Lubricants on page 6 12 Always clean the brake fluid reservoir cap and the area around the cap before removing it This will help keep dirt from entering the reservoir With the wrong kind of fluid in your brake system your brakes may not work well or they may not even work at all This could cause a crash Always use the proper brake fluid Notice Using the wrong fluid can badly damage brake system parts For example just a few drops o
404. story of asthma or other breathing trouble To avoid this everyone in the vehicle should get out as soon as it is safe to do so If you have breathing problems but can not get out of the vehicle after an airbag inflates then get fresh air by opening a window or a door If you experience breathing problems following an airbag deployment you should seek medical attention In many crashes severe enough to inflate an airbag windshields are broken by vehicle deformation Additional windshield breakage may also occur from the right front passenger airbag Airbags are designed to inflate only once After an airbag inflates you will need some new parts for your airbag system If you do not get them the air bag system will not be there to help you in another crash A new system will include airbag modules and possibly other parts The service manual for your vehicle covers the need to replace other parts Your vehicle is equipped with a crash sensing and diagnostic module which records information after a crash See Vehicle Data Collection and Event Data Recorders on page 7 10 Let only qualified technicians work on your airbag system Improper service can mean that an airbag system will not work properly See your dealer for service Notice If you damage the covering for the driver s or the right front passenger s airbag or the airbag covering on the driver s and right front passenger s seatback the airbag may not wor
405. strument panel switchbank This feature will quickly heat the seat cushions and lower back of the driver s and front passenger s seat The left switch is for the driver s seat and the right switch is for the front passenger s seat Press the top of the switch to turn the heater on Press the bottom of the switch to turn the heater off The heated seat switch will turn off when the ignition is turned to OFF and will resume operation when the ignition is turned to ON unless the switch is turned off Reclining Seatbacks To adjust a seatback pull up on the lever located on a Sy the outboard side of the driver s or front passenger s But don t have a seatback reclined if your vehicle is seats Release the lever to lock the seatback where you moving want it Push and pull on the seat to make sure it s locked into position Pull up on the lever and the seat will go to its original upright position Sitting in a reclined position when your vehicle is in motion can be dangerous Even if you buckle up your safety belts can not do their job when you are reclined like this The shoulder belt can not do its job because it will not be against your body Instead it will be in front of you In a crash you could go into it receiving neck or other injuries The lap belt can not do its job either In a crash the belt could go up over your abdomen The belt forces would be there not at your pelvic bones This could cause serio
406. t are AA A B and C Those grades represent the tire s ability to stop on wet pavement as measured under controlled conditions on specified government test surfaces of asphalt and concrete A tire marked C may have poor traction performance Warning The traction grade assigned to this tire is based on straight ahead braking traction tests and does not include acceleration cornering hydroplaning or peak traction characteristics 5 67 Temperature A B C The temperature grades are A the highest B and C representing the tire s resistance to the generation of heat and its ability to dissipate heat when tested under controlled conditions on a specified indoor laboratory test wheel Sustained high temperature can cause the material of the tire to degenerate and reduce tire life and excessive temperature can lead to sudden tire failure The grade C corresponds to a level of performance which all passenger car tires must meet under the Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standard No 109 Grades B and A represent higher levels of performance on the laboratory test wheel than the minimum required by law Warning The temperature grade for this tire is established for a tire that is properly inflated and not overloaded Excessive speed underinflation or excessive loading either separately or in combination can cause heat buildup and possible tire failure 5 68 Wheel Alignment and Tire Balance The wheels on your vehicle w
407. t most serious injuries and fatalities to unbelted occupants can be reduced or prevented by the use of safety belts Ina rollover crash an unbelted person is significantly more likely to die than a person wearing a seat belt In addition avoiding excessive speed sudden or abrupt turns and drunken or aggressive driving can help make trips safer and avoid the possibility of a crash especially a rollover crash This section provides many useful tips to help you drive more safely 4 2 Driving Environment You can also help avoid a rollover or other type of crash by being prepared for driving in inclement weather at night or during other times where visibility or traction may be limited such as on curves slippery roads or hilly terrain Unfamiliar surroundings can also have hidden hazards To help you learn more about driving in different conditions this section contains information about city freeway and off road driving as well as other hints for driving in various weather conditions Vehicle Design According to the U S Department of Transportation utility vehicles have a significantly higher rollover rate than other types of vehicles Utility vehicles do have higher ground clearance and a narrower track or shorter wheelbase than passenger cars to make them more capable for off road driving Specific design characteristics like these give the driver a better view of the road but also give utility vehicles a higher c
408. t move The electrical terminal of the dead battery Use a remote connection is just as good there and the chance positive terminal if the vehicle has one of sparks getting back to the battery is much less Do not let the other end touch metal Connect it to 10 Now start the vehicle with the good battery and run the positive terminal of the good battery Use a remote positive terminal if the vehicle has one 11 the engine for a while Try to start the vehicle that had the dead battery If it will not start after a few tries it probably needs service 5 45 Notice If the jumper cables are removed in the To disconnect the jumper cables from both vehicles do wrong order electrical shorting may occur and the following damage the vehicle The repairs would not be 1 Disconnect the black negative cable from the covered by your warranty Remove the jumper vehicle that had the dead battery cables in the correct order making sure that the cables do not touch each other or other metal 2 Disconnect the black negative cable from the vehicle with the good battery 3 Disconnect the red positive cable from the vehicle with the good battery 4 Disconnect the red positive cable from the other vehicle 5 Return the remote positive terminal cover to its original position Jumper Cable Removal A Heavy Unpainted Metal Engine Part or Remote Negative Terminal B Good Battery
409. t must be placed in the proper location for the legs to attach correctly 1 Squeeze the angled latch release bar toward the straight crossbar while placing the front hooks of the bench seat onto the front two floor pins 2 Make sure that the bench seat is angled so that the front hooks clear the floor pins If the front legs are not attached correctly the rear legs will not attach to the rear set of floor pins Firmly push the rear hooks onto the rear floor pins by pushing down on the rear of the seat Try to raise the seat to check that it is locked down Lift the seatback recliner lever and raise the seatback until it locks upright Push and pull on the seatback to check that it is locked upright Attach the lap belt Captain Chairs If your vehicle has captain s chairs the chairs and seatbacks can be adjusted forward or rearward Adjusting the Captain s Chairs Second Row To adjust the second row captain s chairs use the adjustment bar located below the front of each seat Lift up the lever to slide the seat forward or rearward Release the lever Push and pull on the seat to make sure it is locked into place Folding or Reclining the Seatbacks If the seatback is not locked it could move forward in a sudden stop or crash That could cause injury to the person sitting there Always press rearward on the seatback to be sure it is locked To recline the seatback li
410. t overtake a slowly moving vehicle too rapidly Even though the brake lamps are not flashing it may be slowing down or starting to turn e If you are being passed make it easy for the following driver to get ahead of you Perhaps you can ease alittle to the right Loss of Control Let us review what driving experts say about what happens when the three control systems brakes steering and acceleration do not have enough friction where the tires meet the road to do what the driver has asked In any emergency do not give up Keep trying to steer and constantly seek an escape route or area of less danger Skidding In a skid a driver can lose control of the vehicle Defensive drivers avoid most skids by taking reasonable care suited to existing conditions and by not overdriving those conditions But skids are always possible The three types of skids correspond to your vehicle s three control systems In the braking skid your wheels are not rolling In the steering or cornering skid too much speed or steering in a curve causes tires to slip and lose cornering force And in the acceleration skid too much throttle causes the driving wheels to spin A cornering skid is best handled by easing your foot off the accelerator pedal If you have the Traction Control System remember It helps avoid only the acceleration skid If you do not have this system or if the system is off then an acceleration skid is also best h
411. tandard and optional equipment including the maximum capacity of fuel oil and coolant but without passengers and cargo DOT Markings A code molded into the sidewall of a tire signifying that the tire is in compliance with the U S Department of Transportation DOT motor vehicle safety standards The DOT code includes the Tire Identification Number TIN an alphanumeric designator which can also identify the tire manufacturer production plant brand and date of production GVWR Gross Vehicle Weight Rating see Loading Your Vehicle on page 4 31 GAWR FRT Gross Axle Weight Rating for the front axle see Loading Your Vehicle on page 4 31 GAWR RR Gross Axle Weight Rating for the rear axle see Loading Your Vehicle on page 4 31 Intended Outboard Sidewall The side of an asymmetrical tire that must always face outward when mounted on a vehicle KiloPascal kPa The metric unit for air pressure Light Truck LT Metric Tire A tire used on light duty trucks and some multipurpose passenger vehicles Load Index An assigned number ranging from 1 to 279 that corresponds to the load carrying capacity of a tire Maximum Inflation Pressure The maximum air pressure to which a cold tire may be inflated The maximum air pressure is molded onto the sidewall Maximum Load Rating The load rating for a tire at the maximum permissible inflation pressure for that tire Maximum Loaded Vehicle Weight The sum of curb weight accessory
412. tape selections press and hold either SEEK arrow for two seconds until SCN appears on the display and you hear a beep The tape will go to the next selection play for a few seconds then go on to the next selection The cassette tape will only scan forward Press either SEEK arrow again to stop scanning BAND Press this button to listen to the radio when a cassette tape or CD is playing The inactive tape or CD will remain safely inside the radio for future listening CD TAPE Press this button to play a cassette tape or a CD when listening to the radio The inactive tape or CD will remain safely inside the radio for future listening A Eject Press this button located next to the cassette tape slot to eject a tape Eject may be activated with either the ignition or radio off Cassette tapes may be loaded with the ignition and radio off if this button is pressed first Cassette Tape Messages If an error message appears on the display it could be for one of the following reasons TIGHT TAPE This message is displayed when the tape is tight and the player cannot turn the tape hubs Remove the tape Hold the tape with the open end down and try to turn the right hub counterclockwise with a pencil Turn the tape over and repeat If the hubs do not turn easily the tape may be damaged and should not be used in the player Try a new tape to make sure the player is working properly BROKEN TAPE This message is displayed when the tap
413. ted Make sure that the seatback is in the folded forward position and that the safety belts are on the correct side of the chair A seat that is not locked into place properly bare An es i ie tace rediwarg can move around in a collision or sudden stop People in the vehicle could be injured Be sure to lock the seat into place properly when installing it The captain s chairs have seat position labels located on the back of each section showing where the section must go The seat must be placed in the proper location for the legs to attach correctly 1 Hook the front latches over the front floor pins 2 Push the rear of the seat down to lock the rear latches onto the rear set of floor pins 3 Push and pull on the seat to check that it is properly attached To fold the seatback down pull up on the lever located on the back of the seat Push down on the seatback until it is locked into place Stowable Seat The stowable seat is a two passenger bench seat and comes with the rear convenience center See Rear Convenience Center on page 2 44 for more information The stowable seat can be removed and replaced or with the seatback folded it can lie flat with the convenience center Folding the Seatback Push and pull on the seatback to make sure that it is If the seatback is not locked it could move locked into place forward in a sudden stop or crash That could cause injury to the person sitting
414. telephone call reading or reaching for something on the floor makes proper defensive driving more difficult and can even cause a collision with resulting injury Ask a passenger to help do things like this or pull off the road in a safe place to do them yourself These simple defensive driving techniques could save your life Drunken Driving Death and injury associated with drinking and driving is a national tragedy It is the number one contributor to the highway death toll claiming thousands of victims every year Alcohol affects four things that anyone needs to drive a vehicle Judgment Muscular Coordination Vision Attentiveness Police records show that almost half of all motor vehicle related deaths involve alcohol In most cases these deaths are the result of someone who was drinking and driving In recent years more than 16 000 annual motor vehicle related deaths have been associated with the use of alcohol with more than 300 000 people injured Many adults by some estimates nearly half the adult population choose never to drink alcohol so they never drive after drinking For persons under 21 it is against the law in every U S state to drink alcohol There are good medical psychological and developmental reasons for these laws The obvious way to eliminate the leading highway safety problem is for people never to drink alcohol and then drive But what if people do How much is too much
415. th Do not apply spray directly to the 1 For liquids blot with a clean soft white cloth For fabric solids remove as much as possible and then 4 Start cleaning from the seams into the stain to vacuum or brush avoid a ring effect 2 Apply club soda water to a clean soft white cloth 5 Continue cleaning using a clean area of the cloth Do not over saturate the cloth should not drip each time it becomes soiled water 6 When the stain is removed blot the cleaned area 3 Clean the entire area Avoid getting the fabric with another dry clean soft white cloth too wet 7 If the cleaner leaves a ring effect follow up with the 4 Start cleaning from the seams into the stain to club soda water instructions given earlier in this avoid a ring effect section 5 Continue cleaning using a clean area of the cloth Special Fabric Cleaning Problems each time it becomes soiled 6 When the stain is removed blot the cleaned area with another dry clean soft white cloth Stains caused by such things as catsup black coffee egg fruit fruit juice milk soft drinks vomit urine and blood can be removed using the club soda water Using Cleaner on Fabric instructions given earlier in this section If an odor lingers i i i after cleaning vomit or urine treat the area with a 1 First try the cleaner on an area of the fabric that is water and baking soda solution 1 teaspoon 5 ml of not easily seen to make sure the cleaner does not baking so
416. that a small child is present in a forward facing child restraint e the system determines that a small child is present in a booster seat e aright front passenger takes his her weight off of the seat for a period of time e the right front passenger seat is occupied by a smaller person such as a child who has outgrown child restraints or if there is a critical problem with the airbag system or the passenger sensing system When the passenger sensing system has turned off the passenger s frontal air bag the off indicator will light and stay lit to remind you that the airbag is off If a child restraint has been installed and the on indicator is lit turn the vehicle off Remove the child restraint from the vehicle and reinstall the child restraint following the child restraint manufacturer s directions and refer to Securing a Child Restraint in the Right Front Seat Position on page 1 64 If after reinstalling the child restraint and restarting the vehicle the on indicator is still lit check to make sure that the vehicle s seatback is not pressing the child restraint into the seat cushion If this happens slightly recline the vehicle s seatback and adjust the seat cushion if possible Also make sure the child restraint is not trapped under the vehicle head restraint If this happens adjust the head restraint If the on indicator is still lit secure the child in the child restraint in a rear seat position in the vehi
417. that your vehicle can travel on the remaining fuel The fuel economy used to calculate the range is based on your driving history since the last reset of the average speed FUEL USED The fuel used display will show you how much fuel has been used since the last time it was reset To reset the fuel used to zero press and hold the SET button while the fuel used is displayed on the DIC and until the display goes to zero AVG SPEED Average Speed The average speed display will show your average speed from when you first started your vehicle To reset the average speed press and hold the SET button while the average speed is displayed on the DIC and until the speed resets to your current speed OIL LIFE LEFT HOLD SET TO RESET This message displays the current percentage of the oil life by the engine oil life system Be careful not to reset this display other than when the oil has been changed See How to Reset the Engine Oil Life System under Engine Oil Life System on page 5 19 for more information In addition to the engine oil life system monitoring the oil life additional maintenance is recommended in the Maintenance Schedule in this manual See Scheduled Maintenance on page 6 4 and Engine Oil on page 5 16 TIRE PRESSURE The check tire pressure system can alert you to a large change in the pressure of one tire If the tire pressure is normal TIRE PRESSURE NORMAL will display If the tire pressure is low LOW TIRE PRESSU
418. the shoulder belt still is on the child s shoulder so that in a crash the child s upper body would have the restraint that belts provide If the child is sitting in a rear seat see Rear Safety Belt Comfort Guides for Children and Small Adults on page 1 40 Never do this Here a child is sitting in a seat that has a lap shoulder belt but the shoulder part is behind the child If the child wears the belt in this way in a crash the child might slide under the belt The belt s force would then be applied right on the child s abdomen That could cause serious or fatal injuries The lap portion of the belt should be worn low and snug on the hips just touching the child s thighs This applies belt force to the child s pelvic bones in a crash Infants and Young Children Everyone in a vehicle needs protection This includes infants and all other children Neither the distance traveled nor the age and size of the traveler changes the need for everyone to use safety restraints In fact the law in every state in the United States and in every Canadian province says children up to some age must be restrained while in a vehicle Every time infants and young children ride in vehicles they should have the protection provided by appropriate restraints Young children should not use the vehicle s adult safety belts alone unless there is no other choice Instead they need to use a child restraint 1 45 People sho
419. the right or the left speakers A bar graph with indicators will appear on the display To adjust the fade between the front and the rear speakers push and release AUDIO until FADE appears on the display Then turn the AUDIO knob to move the sound toward the front or the rear speakers A bar graph with indicators will appear on the display To adjust balance or fade to the middle position select BAL or FADE Then push and hold AUDIO for more than two seconds until you hear a beep The indicator will be centered on the display To adjust both tone controls and both speaker controls to the middle position end out of audio mode by waiting five seconds without making any changes Then push and hold AUDIO for more than two seconds until you hear a beep ALL CENTERED will appear on the display Finding a Program Type PTY Station To select and find a desired PTY perform the following 1 Press P TYP to activate program type select mode P TYPE will appear on the display 2 Turn the AUDIO knob to select a PTY 3 Once the desired PTY is displayed press either SEEK arrow to select the PTY and to take you to the PTY s first station 4 Togo to another station within that PTY and the PTY is displayed press either SEEK arrow once If the PTY is not displayed press either SEEK arrow twice to display the PTY and then to go to another station 5 Press P TYP to exit program type select mode If PTY times out and is no longer on the dis
420. the tire pressure is actually normal More than one tire is low Only one tire is replaced with a new tire during service The vehicle is moving faster than 70 mph 113 km h The system is not yet calibrated The tire treadwear is uneven The compact spare tire is installed Tire chains are being used The vehicle is being driven on a rough or frozen road lf the anti lock brake system warning light comes on the check tire pressure system may not be working properly See your dealer for service Also see Anti Lock Brake System Warning Light on page 3 45 The check tire pressure system detects differences in tire rotation speeds that are caused by changes in tire pressure The system can alert you about a low tire but it does not replace normal tire maintenance See Tires on page 5 55 When the LOW TIRE PRESSURE HOLD SET TO RESET message appears on the Driver Information Center and the LOW TIRE PRESSURE message comes on the message center you should stop as soon as you can and check all your tires for damage If a tire is flat see f a Tire Goes Flat on page 5 72 Also check the tire pressure in all four tires as soon as you can See Inflation Tire Pressure on page 5 61 Any time you adjust a tire s pressure or have one or more tires repaired or replaced you ll need to reset or calibrate the check tire pressure system You ll also need to reset the system whenever you rotate the tires buy new tires
421. the top tether from the top tether anchorage and then disconnect the LATCH attachments from the LATCH anchorages 1 60 Securing a Child Restraint in a Rear Outside Seat Position If your child restraint is equipped with the LATCH system see Lower Anchorages and Top Tethers for Children LATCH System on page 1 58 See Top Strap on page 1 53 if the child restraint has one If your child restraint does not have the LATCH system you will be using the lap shoulder belt to secure the child restraint in this position Be sure to follow the instructions that came with the child restraint Secure the child in the child restraint when and as the instructions say 1 Put the child restraint on the seat 2 Pick up the latch plate and run the lap and shoulder portions of the vehicle s safety belt through or around the restraint The child restraint instructions will show you how Tilt the latch plate to adjust the belt if needed 3 Buckle the belt Make sure the release button is positioned so you would be able to unbuckle the safety belt quickly if you ever had to 4 To tighten the belt push down on the child restraint pull the shoulder portion of the belt to tighten the lap portion of the belt and feed the shoulder belt back into the retractor If you are using a forward facing child restraint you may find it helpful to use your knee to push down on the child restraint as you tighten the belt 5 Push and pull the c
422. there Always press rearward on the seatback to be sure it is From the rear of the vehicle pull up on the lever to locked release the seatback Then pull the strap located on the right side of the seat to pull the seatback up The seatback has a pocket to stow the strap on the side of the seatback when not in use or To raise the seatback do one of the following from the passenger s side door pull up on the lever to release the seatback Then push up on the seatback to raise the seat Push and pull on the seatback to make sure that it is locked into the upright position Removing the Stowable Seat 1 Remove the convenience center if it is in the vehicle See Rear Convenience Center on page 2 44 for more information Make sure all items are off the stowable seat If the seatback is down put the seatback in its upright position before removing the seat See Folding the Seatback listed previously From the front of the bench seat remove the two nuts from the brackets located on the floor on each side From behind the bench seat fold the seatback down Remove the rear nuts located on the floor on each side Remove the seat by rocking it slightly toward the rear of the vehicle and then pulling it out through the rear of the vehicle This should be done in one motion Put the nuts back onto the screws so the nuts do not get misplaced Replacing the Stowable Seat If the seatback is not locked
423. this button to start play of a DVD or CD Press this button while a DVD or CD is playing to pause it Press it again to continue play of a DVD or CD Main Menu Press this button to view the media menu The media menu is different on every DVD Use the up down right and left arrow buttons to move the cursor around the media menu After making a selection press enter This button only operates when using a DVD __ Display Control Button Press this button to adjust the color tint brightness contrast display mode and dynamic range compression The dynamic range compression feature can be used to reduce loud audio and increase low audio produced by some DVDs To change a feature back to the factory default setting press this button to display the feature then press and hold this button The default setting will appear on the display While playing an Audio or DVD disc press and hold this button to display and to remove the track and time information A P vid lt 4 gt Directional Control Circle Press these buttons to move through menu choices or to move forward or back in a movie These controls can be used to move forward or backward through a CD 4 Enter Press this button to select choices highlighted in any menu Playing a Disc To play a disc gently insert the disc label side up into the loading slot The DVD player will continue loading the disc and the player will automat
424. tion 2 2 18 Starting and Operating Your Vehicle 2 19 New Vehicle Break In cccceeeeeee tees eeeees 2 19 IGNITION POSITIONS siccese decieseexckoredis serene beg 2 20 Retained Accessory Power RAP 606 2 21 Starting Your Engine cccceeeeeeeeeeeeeeee tenes 2 21 Engine Coolant Heater cceeeeeeeeeeeeeee ees 2 22 Automatic Transaxle Operation ee 2 23 All Wheel Drive ccececeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeees 2 26 Parking Brake siiccs iisaccesicentesasctcacsesieasanesstean 2 26 Shifting Into Park P ccceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeenee 2 27 Shifting Out of Park P c eeeeeeeeeeeeeeee eee 2 28 Parking Over Things That Burn a se 2 29 Engine EXxnaust irienna ensena 2 29 Running Your Engine While You Are Parked 2 30 MIOS oi otc 84 canRoadavbtenesstanerdennduense pea 2 31 Manual Rearview Mirror eccere 2 31 Outside Power Mirror eeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeees 2 31 Outside Curb View Assist Mirror 2 32 Outside Convex Mirror cceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeees 2 32 Outside Heated Mirrors c ceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeees 2 32 OnStar System 0c eneen ennnen nrnna 2 33 HomeLink Transmitter 2 34 Programming the HomeLink Transmitter 2 35 Storage Areas 0 0 2 0 ccc cce eee neste renerne rene 2 38 Glove BOX Ed seere 2 38 Cupholder S cceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeaeeeeeneeeeenes 2 39 Cell Phone Storage Area
425. tions for Entering Programming Mode listed previously 2 Press the MODE button until REMOTE DOOR UNLOCK appears on the DIC 3 Press the SET button until the arrow is before DRIVER ALL or ALL The mode you selected is now set You can either exit programming mode by following the instructions later in this section or program the next feature available on your vehicle 3 71 Unlock Feedback The unlock feedback feature can be programmed to one of the following modes LIGHTS This mode does the following During the day when the ignition is in OFF and UNLOCK on the remote keyless entry transmitter is pressed the headlamps and parking lamps will flash During the night when the ignition is in OFF the headlamps and parking lamps will be activated for 30 seconds when UNLOCK is pressed on the remote keyless entry transmitter If you would like to change the amount of time the lamps stay on change the headlamp exit delay feature OFF The headlamps and parking lamps will not flash when UNLOCK is pressed on the remote keyless entry transmitter 3 72 Your vehicle was originally programmed to LIGHTS The mode may have been changed since then To determine the current mode or to change the mode do the following 1 Follow the instructions for Entering Programming Mode listed previously 2 Follow the instructions for programming HEADLMP EXIT DELAY earlier in this section to make sure which mode it is
426. to coast channels including music news sports talk and children s programming XM provides digital quality audio and text information that includes song title and artist name A service fee is required in order to receive the XM service For more information contact XM at www xmradio com or call 1 800 852 XMXM 9696 Playing the Radio PWR Power Push this knob to turn the system on and off VOL Volume Turn this knob to increase or to decrease the volume SCV Speed Compensated Volume With SCV your audio system adjusts automatically to make up for road and wind noise as you drive To get to SCV push the TUNE AUDIO knob repeatedly until SPEED VOL appears on the display Turn the TUNE AUDIO knob to select MIN MED or MAX Each higher setting allows for more volume compensation at faster vehicle speeds Then as you drive SCV automatically increases the volume as necessary to overcome noise at any speed The volume level should always sound the same to you as you drive To turn SCV off press SCV until OFF appears on the display 3 77 DISP Display Press this button to switch the display between the radio station frequency and the time Press this button to display the time when the ignition is turned off For RDS press the DISP button to change what appears on the display while using RDS The display options are station RDS station frequency PTY and the name of the program if available For
427. to the radio When the RSE system is turned off the radio will display RSE OFF and the radio will return to the last radio source that you were listening to 3 100 Radio with Six Disc CD Radio Data System RDS The audio system has a Radio Data System RDS RDS features are available for use only on FM stations that broadcast RDS information With RDS the radio can do the following Seek to stations broadcasting the selected type of programming e Receive announcements concerning local and national emergencies Display messages from radio stations Seek to stations with traffic announcements This system relies upon receiving specific information from these stations and will only work when the information is available In rare cases a radio station may broadcast incorrect information that will cause the radio features to work improperly If this happens contact the radio station While the radio is tuned to an DS station the station name or call letters will appear on the display instead of the frequency RDS stations may also provide the time of day a program type PTY for current programming and the name of the program being broadcast XMIM Satellite Radio Service XMIM is a satellite radio service that is based in the 48 contiguous United States XM offers 100 coast to coast channels including music news sports talk and children s programming XM provides digital quality audio and text in
428. to turn off the fan The fan must be turned on for the air conditioning compressor to operate lt amp Recirculation This mode keeps outside air from coming in the vehicle It can be used to prevent outside air and odors from entering your vehicle or help heat or cool the air inside your vehicle more quickly Press this button to turn the recirculation mode on or off When the button is pressed an indicator light will come on The air conditioning compressor also comes on The recirculation mode can be used with vent and bi level modes but it cannot be used with floor defog defrost or outside air modes Temperature Control Turn the center knob clockwise or counterclockwise to increase or decrease the air temperature inside your vehicle x AIC Air Conditioning Press this button to turn the air conditioning system on or off When A C is pressed an indicator light in the button will come on to let you know that air conditioning is activated You may notice a slight change in engine performance when the air conditioning compressor shuts off and turns on again This is normal The system is designed to make adjustments to help with fuel economy while still maintaining the selected temperature On hot days open the windows to let hot inside air escape then close them This helps to reduce the time it takes for your vehicle to cool down It also helps the system to operate more efficiently The air conditioning system removes
429. tomatically kept level as you load or unload your vehicle However you should still not exceed the GVWR or the GAWR See Loading Your Vehicle on page 4 31 You may hear the compressor operating when you load or unload your vehicle and periodically as the system self adjusts This is normal The compressor should operate for brief periods of time If the sound continues for an extended period of time your vehicle needs service Using heavier suspension components to get added durability might not change your weight ratings Ask your dealer to help you load your vehicle the right way 4 38 Towing a Trailer If you do not use the correct equipment and drive properly you can lose control when you pull a trailer For example if the trailer is too heavy the brakes may not work well or even at all You and your passengers could be seriously injured Pull a trailer only if you have followed all the steps in this section Ask your dealer for advice and information about towing a trailer with your vehicle Notice Pulling a trailer improperly can damage your vehicle and result in costly repairs that would not be covered by your warranty Always follow the instructions in this section and check with your dealer for more information about towing a trailer with your vehicle Your vehicle can tow a trailer To identify what the vehicle trailering capacity is for your vehicle you should read the information in Weight of the Trai
430. trument Cluster Air Conditioning and Body Computer Diode for Air Conditioning 0 Compressor Clutch 71 Diode for Ignition Relay Uss o Congnsa 5 111 Capacities and Specifications The following approximate capacities are given in English and metric conversions See Recommended Fluids and Lubricants on page 6 12 for more information Application English Metric Air Conditioning Refrigerant R134a 1 7 Ibs 0 8 kg Automatic Transaxle Front Wheel Drive Pan Removal and Replacement 7 4 quarts 7 0L Complete Overhaul 10 0 quarts 9 5L Automatic Transaxle 3400 V6 AWD Pan Removal and Replacement 8 7 quarts 8 3 L Complete Overhaul 10 8 quarts 10 3 L Automatic Transaxle 3 6L V6 AWD Pan Removal and Replacement 7 8 quarts 7 4L Complete Overhaul 10 4 quarts 9 9 L Gooling System 5 112 Application English Metric Engine Oil with Filter 3400 V6 Engine 3 8L 3 6L V6 Engine 5 2L 290 ml 140 Nem Engine Specifications VIN Code Spark Plug Gap 3400 V6 0 060 inches 152 mm 36L VE 0 044 inches 1 1 mm 5 113 4 NOTES 5 114 Section 6 Maintenance Schedule Maintenance Schedule 0eeeeeeeees 6 2 Owner Checks and Services 0 0c0eeeeeeees 6 8 INTRODUCTION 2 Sends dccucindaxatedtoamdlaelactianes den heks hehe 6 2 At Each Fuel Ril SL cccnctssieoteaneddereapicaecsenciend 6 8 Maintenance Requirements eseeeeeeee 6 2 At Least
431. ttery has run down The diagnostic system is designed to evaluate critical emission control systems during normal driving This may take several days of routine driving If you have done this and your vehicle still does not pass the inspection for lack of OBD system readiness your GM dealer can prepare the vehicle for inspection Highbeam On Light This light will illuminate when the headlamp high beams are in use See Headlamp High Low Beam Changer on page 3 8 3 49 Fuel Gage Canada United States When the indicator nears empty you still have a little fuel left but you should get more soon If your fuel is low the warning message in the message center will come on See Low Fuel Warning Message on page 3 58 Your fuel gage tells you about how much fuel you have left when the ignition is on 3 50 Here are four things that some owners ask about All these things are normal and do not indicate that anything is wrong with the fuel gage At the gas station the gas pump shuts off before the gage reads full It takes a little more or less fuel to fill up than the gage reads For example the gage reads half full but it took more or less than half of the tank s capacity to fill it The gage pointer may move while cornering braking or speeding up The gage may not indicate empty when the ignition is turned off Message Center The message center is located at the top of the instrument panel
432. uironenvidacnaiiaaastanehbes 5 6 Filling a Portable Fuel Container 5 10 Filling Your Tank sasirnane 5 8 Fuels in Foreign Countries ceeeeeeeeeeeee 5 7 Gager a a E A 3 50 Gasoline Octane scrii deres enkes sinira iek 5 5 Gasoline Specifications W ssssesereeereerereree 5 5 Low Warning Message ccecce 3 58 Fuses Floor Console Fuse Block naasen 5 105 Fuses and Circuit Breakers 5 105 Underhood Fuse Block eeeeeeeneeee rene 5 107 Windshield Wiper 22 sene beer 5 104 Gage Engine Coolant Temperature 3 46 FUGI tics cents bomoa sineto read 3 50 Speedometer cceceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeaeeaeeaeeeeeaes 3 39 Tachometer merser aa 3 40 Garage Door Opener cece 2 34 Gasoline OCIANG E E E E 5 5 SPeCHICAtIONS ss morerei gin E ki 5 5 Glove BOX sirarna ia a 2 38 GM Mobility Reimbursement Program W W 1 1 1 7 5 H Hatch Ajar Warning Message seeeeeeeeeee 3 56 Hazard Warning Flashers scce 3 6 Head Restraints 0 csceedcctsssseedsseneanenneeceneeeneed 1 7 Headlamp Wiring eeeeeeeeeeeeceeeeeeeeeees 5 104 Headlamps Automatic Headlamp System eeeeeeee 3 15 Bulb Replacement cceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeneeeee 5 49 Daytime Running Lamps e eeeeeeeeeee es 3 14 Exit Delay aars bes isen ia n 3 17 Flash to PASS i sisectasasncesscectaccdtenasswesatamsence 3 8 Front Turn Signal Sidemarker
433. uld never hold a baby in their arms while riding in a vehicle A baby does not weigh much until a crash During a crash a baby will become so heavy it is not possible to hold it For example in a crash at only 25 mph 40 km h a 12 Ib 5 5 kg baby will suddenly become a 240 Ib 110 kg force ona person s arms A baby should be secured in an appropriate restraint 1 46 Children who are up against or very close to any airbag when it inflates can be seriously injured or killed Airbags plus lap shoulder belts offer protection for adults and older children but not for young children and infants Neither the vehicle s safety belt system nor its airbag system is designed for them Young children and infants need the protection that a child restraint system can provide Q What are the different types of add on child A restraints Add on child restraints which are purchased by the vehicle s owner are available in four basic types Selection of a particular restraint should take into consideration not only the child s weight height and age but also whether or not the restraint will be compatible with the motor vehicle in which it will be used For most basic types of child restraints there are many different models available When purchasing a child restraint be sure it is designed to be used in a motor vehicle If it is the restraint will have a label saying that it meets federal motor vehicle safety sta
434. ults To reset HomeLink to default settings do the following 1 Hold down the two outside buttons for about 20 seconds until the indicator light begins to flash 2 Continue to hold both buttons until the HomeLink indicator light turns off 3 Release both buttons For questions or comments contact HomeLink at 1 800 355 3515 or on the internet at www homelink com Storage Areas Glove Box If the glove box has a lock put your key into the lock and turn the key counterclockwise To open the glove box pull the latch release The glove box door has a detent to prevent the door from lowering too far Open the glove box until the door is partway open then pull the door down if you need it fully opened To close the glove box the door must be pushed up past the detent To lock the glove box put your key into the lock and turn the key clockwise Cupholder s There are two cupholders located in the floor console The cupholders have liners that remove for larger beverage items Remove the liners by lifting them out Your vehicle has cupholders located in the rear seat armrests if it has a split folding rear seat If your vehicle has captain s chairs there are cupholders on the sides of the seats If your vehicle has a stowable seat there are cupholders in the center of the seat Cell Phone Storage Area Your vehicle has a cell phone storage compartment located on the floor console storage closest to the
435. unication Centre 163 005 1908 Colonel Sam Drive Oshawa Ontario L1H 8P7 1 800 263 3777 English 1 800 263 7854 French 1 800 263 3830 For Text Telephone devices TTYs Roadside Assistance 1 800 268 6800 Overseas Customer Assistance Please contact the local General Motors Business Unit Mexico Central America and Caribbean Islands Countries Except Puerto Rico and U S Virgin Islands Customer Assistance General Motors de Mexico S de R L de C V Customer Assistance Center Paseo de la Reforma 2740 Col Lomas de Bezares C P 11910 Mexico D F 01 800 508 0000 Long Distance 011 52 53 29 0 800 GM Mobility Reimbursement Program This program available to qualified applicants can reimburse you up to 1 000 toward eligible aftermarket driver s or passenger s adaptive equipment you may require for your vehicle such as hand controls and wheelchair scooter lifts The offer is available for a limited period of time from the date of vehicle purchase lease For more details or to determine your vehicle s eligibility visit gmmobility com or call the GM Mobility Assistance Center at 1 800 323 9935 Text telephone TTY users call 1 800 833 9935 GM of Canada also has a Mobility Program Call 1 800 GM DRIVE 463 7483 for details TTY users call 1 800 263 3830 Roadside Assistance Program Call 1 800 252 1112 for Buick Roadside Assistance As the proud owner of a new Buick vehicle you are a
436. urned on again the defogger will only run for approximately five minutes before turning off The defogger can also be turned off by pressing the button again or by turning off the engine If your vehicle has heated outside rearview mirrors the mirrors will heat to help clear fog or frost from the surface of the mirror when the rear window defog button is pressed Notice Don t use anything sharp on the inside of the rear window If you do you could cut or damage the warming grid and the repairs wouldn t be covered by your warranty Do not attach a temporary vehicle license tape a decal or anything similar to the defogger grid 3 36 Outlet Adjustment Use the louvers located on the air outlets to change the direction of the airflow Operation Tips Clear away any ice snow or leaves from the air inlets at the base of the vehicle that may block the flow of air into your vehicle Use of non GM approved hood deflectors may adversely affect the performance of the system Keep the path under the front seats clear of objects to help circulate the air inside of your vehicle more effectively Warning Lights Gages and Indicators This part describes the warning lights and gages that may be on your vehicle The pictures will help you locate them Warning lights and gages can signal that something is wrong before it becomes serious enough to cause an expensive repair or replacement Paying attention to your wa
437. urrounding roads are clear If you see a patch of ice ahead of you brake before you are on it Try not to brake while you are actually on the ice and avoid sudden steering maneuvers 4 28 If You Are Caught in a Blizzard If you are stopped by heavy snow you could be in a serious situation You should probably stay with your vehicle unless you know for sure that you are near help and you can hike through the snow Here are some things to do to summon help and keep yourself and your passengers safe Turn on your hazard flashers Tie a red cloth to your vehicle to alert police that you have been stopped by the snow Put on extra clothing or wrap a blanket around you If you have no blankets or extra clothing make body insulators from newspapers burlap bags rags floor mats anything you can wrap around yourself or tuck under your clothing to keep warm Snow can trap exhaust gases under your vehicle This can cause deadly CO carbon monoxide gas to get inside CO could overcome you and kill you You cannot see it or smell it so you might not know it is in your vehicle Clear away snow from around the base of your vehicle especially any that is blocking your exhaust pipe And check around again from time to time to be sure snow does not collect there Open a window just a little on the side of the vehicle that is away from the wind This will help keep CO out Run your engine only as long as you must This
438. us internal injuries For proper protection when the vehicle is in motion have the seatback upright Then sit well back in the seat and wear your safety belt properly Head Restraints Adjust your head restraint so that the top of the restraint is closest to the top of your head This position reduces the chance of a neck injury in a crash The front seat head restraints are adjustable Slide the head restraint up or down to adjust it The rear seat head restraints in your vehicle may be adjustable They work the same as the front seat head restraints Rear Seats Rear Seat Operation The rear seats in your vehicle have seat operating features to adjust fold remove and reinstall the seats By using the seat operating procedures in the correct order you can easily remove the seats from your vehicle When you put the seats back in the vehicle be sure to follow the label on the back of the seat for proper location Split Bench Seats If your vehicle has the split bench seat the seatbacks can be folded forward or reclined individually and the sections can be flipped forward or removed individually 1 8 Folding or Reclining the Seatbacks If the seatback is not locked it could move forward in a sudden stop or crash That could cause injury to the person sitting there Always press rearward on the seatback to be sure it is locked To recline the seatback on base level split bench seats lift up
439. ustomer Satisfaction Procedure 000005 7 2 Online Owner Center ccccecceeeeeeeeeeeeeees 7 3 Customer Assistance for Text Telephone TTY USERS oiriin ene AI E REISE erne 7 4 Customer Assistance Offices cccceeeeeee 7 4 GM Mobility Reimbursement Program 7 5 Roadside Assistance Program ccce 7 6 Courtesy Transportation 0cceceeeeeeee eee ees 7 7 Vehicle Data Collection and Event Data ie 0 0 40 ne 7 10 Customer Assistance and Information Reporting Safety Defects Reporting Safety Defects to the United States Government Reporting Safety Defects to the Canadian Government Reporting Safety Defects to General Motors Service Publications Ordering Information Customer Assistance and Information Customer Satisfaction Procedure Your satisfaction and goodwill are important to your dealer and to Buick Normally any concerns with the sales transaction or the operation of your vehicle will be resolved by your GM dealer s sales or service departments Sometimes however despite the best intentions of all concerned misunderstandings can occur If your concern has not been resolved to your satisfaction the following steps should be taken STEP ONE Discuss your concern with a member of dealership management Normally concerns can be quickly resolved at that level If the matter has already been reviewed with the sales service or parts manager c
440. ut Canada sets the legal limit at 0 08 percent In some other countries the limit is even lower For example it is 0 05 percent in both France and Germany The BAC limit for all commercial drivers in the United States is 0 04 percent The BAC will be over 0 10 percent after three to six drinks in one hour Of course as we have seen it depends on how much alcohol is in the drinks and how quickly the person drinks them But the ability to drive is affected well below a BAC of 0 10 percent Research shows that the driving skills of many people are impaired at a BAC approaching 0 05 percent and that the effects are worse at night All drivers are impaired at BAC levels above 0 05 percent Statistics show that the chance of being in a collision increases sharply for drivers who have a BAC of 0 05 percent or above A driver with a BAC level of 0 06 percent has doubled his or her chance of having a collision At a BAC level of 0 10 percent the chance of this driver having a collision is 12 times greater at a level of 0 15 percent the chance is 25 times greater The body takes about an hour to rid itself of the alcohol in one drink No amount of coffee or number of cold showers will speed that up I will be careful is not the right answer What if there is an emergency a need to take sudden action as when a child darts into the street A person with even a moderate BAC might not be able to react quickly enough to avoid the co
441. utomatically enrolled in the Buick Roadside Assistance program This value added service is intended to provide you with peace of mind as you drive in the city or travel the open road Call Buick s Roadside Assistance toll free number at 1 800 252 1112 to speak with a Buick Roadside Assistance representative 24 hours a day 365 days a year We will provide the following services during the Bumper to Bumper warranty period at no expense to you Fuel Delivery Delivery of enough fuel 5 maximum for the customer to get to the nearest service station Lock out Service identification required Replacement keys or locksmith service will be covered at no charge if you are unable to gain entry into your vehicle Delivery of the replacement key will be covered within 10 miles Emergency Tow Tow to the nearest dealership for warranty service or in the event of a vehicle disabling accident Assistance when the vehicle is mired in sand mud or snow Flat Tire Change Installation of a spare tire will be covered at no charge The customer is responsible for the repair or replacement of the tire if not covered by a warrantable failure Jump Start No start occurrences which require a battery jump start will be covered at no charge Dealer Locator Service In many instances mechanical failures are covered under Buick s Bumper to Bumper warranty However when other services are utilized our Roadside Assistance Represent
442. ve just enough slack so you can turn with your rig Never allow safety chains to drag on the ground Trailer Brakes If your trailer weighs more than 1 000 Ibs 450 kg loaded then it needs its own brakes and they must be adequate Be sure to read and follow the instructions for the trailer brakes so you will be able to install adjust and maintain them properly Because your vehicle may have anti lock brakes do not try to tap into your vehicle s brake system If you do both brake systems will not work well or at all 4 42 Driving with a Trailer If you have a rear most window open and you pull a trailer with your vehicle carbon monoxide CO could come into your vehicle You cannot see or smell CO It can cause unconsciousness or death See Engine Exhaust on page 2 29 To maximize your safety when towing a trailer Have your exhaust system inspected for leaks and make necessary repairs before starting on your trip Keep the rear most windows closed If exhaust does come into your vehicle through a window in the rear or another opening drive with your front main heating or cooling system on and with the fan on any speed This will bring fresh outside air into your vehicle Do not use the climate control setting for maximum air because it only recirculates the air inside your vehicle See Climate Control System on page 3 28 Towing a trailer requires a certain amount of experience Before setting out for the
443. wer Options Circuit breakers in the floor console fuse block protect the power windows and other power accessories When the current load is too heavy the circuit breaker opens and closes protecting the circuit until the problem is fixed Fuses and Circuit Breakers The wiring circuits in your vehicle are protected from short circuits by a combination of fuses circuit breakers and fusible thermal links Look at the silver colored band inside the fuse If the band is broken or melted replace the fuse Be sure you replace a bad fuse with a new one of the identical size and rating If you ever have a problem on the road and do not have a spare fuse you can borrow one that has the same amperage Just pick a feature of your vehicle that you can get along without like the radio or cigarette lighter and use its fuse if it is the right amperage Replace it as soon as you can There are two fuse blocks in your vehicle the floor console fuse block and the underhood fuse and relay center Floor Console Fuse Block The floor console fuse block is located to the left of the glove box near the floor Pull the door open to access the fuse block 5 105 Steering Wheel Radio Controls Power Door Locks 12 Electronic Level Control ELC Compressor Liftgate and Endgate Rear Auxiliary Power Outlet Electronic Level Control ELC 15 Compressor Relay and Height Sensor Heated Mirrors Pow
444. where it stopped if it was the last selected audio source When a CD is inserted the CD symbol will appear on the display As each new track starts to play the track number will appear on the display The CD player can play the smaller 3 inch 8 cm single CDs with an adapter ring Full size CDs and the smaller CDs are loaded in the same manner If playing a CD R the sound quality may be reduced due to CD R quality the method of recording the quality of the music that has been recorded and the way the CD R has been handled There may be an increase in skipping difficulty in finding tracks and or difficulty in loading and ejecting If these problems occur try a known good CD 3 98 Do not add paper labels to CDs they could get caught in the CD player If an error appears on the display see CD Messages later in this section 144 Reverse Press and hold this pushbutton to reverse quickly within a track You will hear sound at a reduced volume Release this pushbutton to play the passage 2 gt Forward Press and hold this pushbutton to advance quickly within a track You will hear sound at a reduced volume Release this pushbutton to play the passage 4 RDM Random Press this pushbutton to hear the tracks in random rather than sequential order Press RDM again to turn off random play DISP Display Press this button to see which track is playing Press it again within five seconds to see how lo
445. with the liftgate open because carbon monoxide CO gas can come into your vehicle You can t see or smell CO It can cause unconsciousness and even death If you must drive with the liftgate open or if electrical wiring or other cable connections must pass through the seal between the body and the liftgate e Make sure all other windows are shut Turn the fan on your heating or cooling system to its highest speed and select the control setting that will force outside air into your vehicle See Climate Control System on page 3 28 If you have air outlets on or under the instrument panel open them all the way See Engine Exhaust on page 2 29 Liftgate Release Liftgate Handle Your vehicle is equipped with a liftgate release touchpad located on the inner side of the liftgate handle To open the liftgate using the touchpad do the following 1 Put the vehicle in PARK P 2 Unlock all of the doors 3 Lift up on the liftgate handle If your vehicle has a remote keyless entry transmitter you may unlock the liftgate by pressing the REAR button on the transmitter then open the liftgate manually by lifting up on the liftgate handle Pressing REAR while the Content Theft Deterrent is active allows you to open the liftgate while all other doors remain locked See Content Theft Deterrent on page 2 15 Windows Leaving children helpless adults or pets in a vehicle with the windows closed is dangerous They can be ove
446. y 3 121 Remote Control To use the remote control aim it at the transmitter window below the video screen and press the desired button Direct sunlight or very bright light may affect the ability of the transmitter to receive signals from the remote control If the remote control does not seem to be working the batteries may need to be replaced See Battery Replacement later in this section Objects blocking the line of sight will affect the function of the remote control Notice Storing the remote control in a hot area or in direct sunlight may damage it and the repairs would not be covered by your warranty Keep the remote control stored in a cool dry place To extend the life of the batteries the remote control does not have a press and hold feature 3 122 Remote Control Buttons b Power Press this button to turn the DVD player on and off 2 Title Press this button to go back to the title screen if there is one A Vv lt 5 gt Directional Arrows Press these buttons to move through DVD menus The up arrow will skip to the next chapter or track the down arrow will take you to the beginning of the current chapter or track Press the down arrow twice to take you to the previous chapter or track The right arrow will fast forward and the left arrow will reverse through a chapter or track LJ Display Control Button Press this button to adjust the color tint brightness contrast dis
447. y brake to a stop well out of the traffic lane A rear blowout particularly on a curve acts much like a skid and may require the same correction you d use in a skid In any rear blowout remove your foot from the accelerator pedal Get the vehicle under control by steering the way you want the vehicle to go It may be very bumpy and noisy but you can still steer Gently brake to a stop well off the road if possible 5 72 Lifting a vehicle and getting under it to do maintenance or repairs is dangerous without the appropriate safety equipment and training The jack provided with your vehicle is designed only for changing a flat tire If it is used for anything else you or others could be badly injured or killed if the vehicle slips off the jack Use the jack provided with your vehicle only for changing a flat tire If a tire goes flat the next part shows how to use your jacking equipment to change a flat tire safely Changing a Flat Tire If a tire goes flat avoid further tire and wheel damage by driving slowly to a level place Turn on your hazard warning flashers Changing a tire can be dangerous The vehicle can slip off the jack and roll over or fall on you or other people You and they could be badly injured or even killed Find a level place to change your tire To help prevent the vehicle from moving Set the parking brake firmly Put the shift lever in PARK P Turn off the engine and do not resta
448. y have a low engine oil level message When this message comes on and stays on after you have started the engine it means that service is required for your vehicle See Scheduled Maintenance on page 6 4 and Engine Oil on page 5 16 for more information lf this message comes on it means your engine is low on oil You should check your oil level right away Have your vehicle serviced immediately See Engine Oil on page 5 16 for more information 3 55 Low Tire Message LOW TIRE D oq PRESSURE United States Canada Your vehicle may have the check tire pressure system which can alert you to a large change in the pressure of one tire After the system has been properly calibrated the low tire pressure message will come on and a chime will sound if a pressure difference or low pressure is detected in one tire The message will stay on until you turn off the ignition or reset calibrate the system See Check Tire Pressure System on page 5 62 If the anti lock brake system warning light comes on the check tire pressure system may not be working properly See your dealer for service Also see Anti Lock Brake System Warning Light on page 3 45 3 56 Door Ajar Warning Message DOOR AJAR D 4 United States Canada This message will come on when the ignition is turned to ON or START and the driver s or passenger s door is open Rear Hatch Ajar Warning Message United States Canada This message will come o
449. y to regularly check power steering fluid unless you suspect there is a leak in the system or you hear an unusual noise A fluid loss in this system could indicate a problem Have the system inspected and repaired How to Check Power Steering Fluid To check the power steering fluid do the following 1 Turn the key off and let the engine compartment cool down 2 Wipe the cap and the top of the reservoir clean 3 Unscrew the cap and wipe the dipstick with a clean rag 4 Replace the cap and completely tighten it 5 Remove the cap again and look at the fluid level on the dipstick When the engine compartment is hot the level for the 3400 V6 engine should be at the H hot mark and the level for the 3 6L V6 engine should be at the MAX mark When it is cold the level for the 3400 V6 engine should be at the C cold mark and the level for the 3 6L V6 engine should be at the MIN mark If the fluid is at the ADD mark on the 3400 V6 engine you should add fluid If the level falls below the MIN mark on the 3 6L V6 engine you should add fluid What Power Steering Fluid to Use To determine what kind of fluid to use see Recommended Fluids and Lubricants on page 6 12 Always use the proper fluid Failure to use the proper fluid can cause leaks and damage hoses and seals Windshield Washer Fluid What Washer Fluid to Use When you need windshield washer fluid be sure to read the manufacturer s instructions before use If
450. yless entry transmitter is being used and the driver s customization features The DIC controls are located to the left of the steering column on the instrument panel DRIVER INFORMATION CENTER MODE The DIC will be in the last mode displayed when the engine was turned off To select a different mode press MODE The display will cycle through its options at each press of MODE 3 64 MODE This button lets you cycle through the options on the display SET This button is used to select and set the options to your preference The DIC will always display the compass reading and the outside temperature If the temperature is below 38 F 3 C the temperature reading will toggle between displaying the temperature and the word ICE for two minutes AVG ECONOMY Average Economy Average fuel economy is viewed as a long term approximation of your overall driving conditions To learn the average fuel economy from a new starting point press and hold the SET button while the average fuel economy is displayed on the DIC The average fuel economy will set to zero INST ECONOMY Instant Economy Instant fuel economy reflects the fuel economy that the vehicle has right now Instant fuel economy varies with your driving conditions such as acceleration braking and the grade of the road being traveled Unlike average fuel economy instant fuel economy cannot be reset FUEL RANGE The fuel range is an estimated distance
451. z talk pop rock and classical 3 79 Adjusting the Speakers Balance Fade AUDIO To adjust the balance between the right and the left speakers push and release the AUDIO knob until BAL appears on the display Then turn the AUDIO knob to move the sound toward the right or the left speakers A bar graph with indicators will show how the sound is balanced To adjust the fade between the front and the rear speakers push and release the AUDIO knob until FADE appears on the display Then turn the AUDIO knob to move the sound toward the front or the rear speakers A bar graph with indicators will show how the sound is balanced To adjust balance or fade to the middle position select BAL or FADE Then push and hold the AUDIO knob for more than two seconds until you hear a beep The indicator will be centered on the display To adjust both tone controls and both speaker controls to the middle position first end out of audio mode by waiting five seconds without making any changes Then push and hold the AUDIO knob for more than two seconds until you hear a beep ALL CENTERED will appear on the display 3 80 Finding a Program Type PTY Station RDS and XM To select and find a desired PTY perform the following 1 Press P TYP to activate program type select mode The PTY symbol will appear on the display 2 Turn the AUDIO knob to select a PTY 3 Once the desired PTY is displayed press either SEEK arrow to select th
Download Pdf Manuals
Related Search
Related Contents
Dossier salon de l`Auto 2012 2.9MB arbre d`entraînement série 6Q – 175 – 250 Transmission Manual for Circular 10/457 - e JVC CS-V6934 car speaker 警 告 =下記項目内容を十分理解の上、 本書をお読みください Princess Family Fondue Set AP グルーガン - アストロプロダクツ 資料3 - 国土交通省 Tiger Series User Manual Copyright © All rights reserved.
Failed to retrieve file